Multitech MTCBA-C-U Specifications

Add to My manuals
197 Pages

advertisement

Multitech MTCBA-C-U Specifications | Manualzz

CDMA AT Commands

AT Commands

Reference Guide

Copyright and Technical Support

CDMA AT Commands

Reference Guide

This Command Set Applies to the Following Products:

SocketModem ® CDMA (MTSMC-C)

MultiModem ® CDMA (MTCBA-C)

MultiModem ® CDMA with USB (MTCBA-C-U)

MultiModem ® iCell (MTCMR-C)

MultiModem ® CDMA with Ethernet Interface (MTCBA-C-EN)

MMCModem ™ CDMA (MTMMC-C)

PN S000294K, Revision K

Copyright

This publication may not be reproduced, in whole or in part, without prior expressed written permission from Multi-Tech

Systems, Inc. All rights reserved. Copyright © 2004-2009, by Multi-Tech Systems, Inc.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. makes no representations or warranty with respect to the contents hereof and specifically disclaim any implied warranties of merchantability or fitness for any particular purpose. Furthermore, Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. reserves the right to revise this publication and to make changes from time to time in the content hereof without obligation of Multi-Tech

Systems, Inc. to notify any person or organization of such revisions or changes.

Revisions

Revision Level Date Description

A release.

B

C

D

E

F

G

03/23/04

04/22/04

09/30/04

08/25/05

11/09/05

01/26/06

Add Values to each command. Add new commands.

Fix headers and footers. Some formatting changes.

Minor spelling and formatting changes.

Changes for Wavecom Rev. 1.37. Changed the definition of MIN.

RUIM is covered in this document; this sentence has been removed: “This document is also intended for use in the North American market. SIM/RUIM and its related AT commands are not documented here.” R-UIM is now documented.

New cover includes product list and trademark/registered trademark symbols. Added

H

I

J

K

02/08/07

05/14/07

01/16/08

01/20/09

MTCBA-C-IP to products covered in this manual. Updated definitions of SIM and R-UIM in Chapter 1.

Added new model MTZPC-C.

Updated Technical Support contact list. Moved chapter covering Unsolicited Result

Codes to a later chapter (Chapter 21) in the manual instead of its previous position as

Chapter 3.

Updated Technical Support contact list again. Removed command +WMSN (Modem

Serial Number). Changed cover layout. Updated product name for ModemModule to

MMCModem.

Added the MultiModem ® iCell (MTCMR-C) to the list of products that use these commands. Removed fax commands. Changed the default value for &C "Data Carrier

Detect" to 2 in the values section. Removed MultiModem CDMA PCI as a product using this command set. Made minor editorial changes.

Trademarks

SocketModem, MultiModem, Multi-Tech, and the Multi-Tech logo are registered trademarks of Multi-Tech Systems, Inc.

MMCModem is a trademark of Multi-Tech Systems, Inc.

World Headquarters

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc.

2205 Woodale Drive

Mounds View, Minnesota 55112

Phone: 763-785-3500 or 800-328-9717

Fax: 763-785-9874

Internet Address: http://www.multitech.com

Technical Support

Country By Email By Phone

Europe, Middle East, Africa: [email protected] (44) 118 959 7774

U.S., Canada, all others: [email protected] (800) 972-2439 or 1-763-717-5863

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 2

Table of Contents

Contents

Chapter 1 – Introduction ................................................................................................................................................ 9

Scope of This Document ............................................................................................................................................ 9

Related References .................................................................................................................................................... 9

Terminology and Acronyms ...................................................................................................................................... 10

Chapter 2 – AT Command Features ........................................................................................................................... 13

Serial Interface Settings ........................................................................................................................................... 13

Command Line ......................................................................................................................................................... 13

Information Responses and Result Codes ............................................................................................................... 13

Chapter 3 - General Commands ................................................................................................................................. 14

Attention AT ........................................................................................................................................................... 14

Request Revision Identification +CGMR ................................................................................................................. 14

Electronic Serial Number +CGSN ........................................................................................................................... 14

Select TE Character Set +CSCS ............................................................................................................................. 15

Request IMSI +CIMI ................................................................................................................................................ 15

Capabilities List +GCAP .......................................................................................................................................... 15

Repeat Last Command A/ ....................................................................................................................................... 15

Phone Offline +CPOF ............................................................................................................................................. 16

Set Phone Functionality +CFUN ............................................................................................................................. 16

Phone Activity Status +CPAS .................................................................................................................................. 16

Report Mobile Equipment Errors +CMEE ................................................................................................................ 16

Keypad Control +CKPD .......................................................................................................................................... 17

Clock Management +CCLK ..................................................................................................................................... 17

Ring Melody Playback +CRMP ............................................................................................................................... 17

Ringer Sound Level +CRSL .................................................................................................................................... 18

Subscriber Number +CNUM .................................................................................................................................... 18

Select Type of Address +CSTA ............................................................................................................................... 18

View Modem Timers +WTMR ................................................................................................................................. 19

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands .......................................................................................................................... 20

Dial Command D ..................................................................................................................................................... 20

Hang-Up Command H ............................................................................................................................................. 21

Answer a Call A ....................................................................................................................................................... 22

Remote Disconnection ............................................................................................................................................. 22

Extended Error Report +CEER ............................................................................................................................... 22

DTMF Signals +VTD, +VTS ................................................................................................................................... 23

DTMF Start and Stop Continuous +WSDT, +WSDS .............................................................................................. 23

Redial Last Telephone Number DL ......................................................................................................................... 24

Automatic Dialing with DTR %Dn ............................................................................................................................ 24

Automatic Answer S0 .............................................................................................................................................. 24

Incoming Call Bearer +CICB ................................................................................................................................... 25

Single Numbering Scheme +CSNS ......................................................................................................................... 25

Microphone Gain +VGT........................................................................................................................................... 26

Volume Gain Control +VGR .................................................................................................................................... 26

Microphone Mute Control +CMUT ........................................................................................................................... 27

Speaker & Microphone Selection +SPEAKER ........................................................................................................ 27

Echo Cancellation +ECHO ...................................................................................................................................... 27

Side Tone Modification +SIDET .............................................................................................................................. 28

Initialize Voice Parameters +VIP ............................................................................................................................. 28

TTY Mode +WTTY .................................................................................................................................................. 28

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands .................................................................................................................. 29

Signal Quality +CSQ ............................................................................................................................................... 29

Mode Preference +COPS ........................................................................................................................................ 29

Band Preference +WBND ....................................................................................................................................... 30

Roam Preference +WRMP ...................................................................................................................................... 31

Network Registration & Roaming +CREG ............................................................................................................... 31

Change NAM Selection +WNAM ............................................................................................................................. 32

Read Current NAM +WCNM ................................................................................................................................... 32

Emergency Mode +WSOS ...................................................................................................................................... 33

Extended Roam Indication +WRMW ....................................................................................................................... 34

Chapter 6 – SIM Card Operational Commands .......................................................................................................... 35

Enter PIN +CPIN ..................................................................................................................................................... 35

Enter PIN2 +CPIN2 ................................................................................................................................................. 36

PIN Remaining Attempt Number +CPINC ............................................................................................................... 36

Facility Lock +CLCK ................................................................................................................................................ 37

Change Password +CPWD ..................................................................................................................................... 38

Card Identification +CCID........................................................................................................................................ 38

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 3

Table of Contents

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands................................................................................................................... 39

Parameters Definition ............................................................................................................................................... 39

Select Message Service +CSMS ............................................................................................................................ 40

New Message Acknowledgement +CNMA .............................................................................................................. 40

Preferred Message Storage +CPMS ....................................................................................................................... 41

Show Text Mode Parameters +CSDH ..................................................................................................................... 41

New Message Indication +CNMI ............................................................................................................................. 42

Read Message +CMGR .......................................................................................................................................... 43

List Message +CMGL .............................................................................................................................................. 44

Send Message +CMGS .......................................................................................................................................... 45

Write Message to Memory +CMGW ........................................................................................................................ 46

Send Message From Storage +CMSS .................................................................................................................... 47

Delete Message +CMGD ........................................................................................................................................ 47

Select Broadcast Messages +CSCB ....................................................................................................................... 48

Message Status Modification +WMSC .................................................................................................................... 48

Message Overwriting +WMGO ................................................................................................................................ 49

Change SMS Status +WUSS .................................................................................................................................. 49

Set SMS Compose Language and Encoding +WSCL ............................................................................................. 50

Set Timestamp of MT SMS +WSTM ....................................................................................................................... 50

Chapter 8 – Supplementary Services Commands .................................................................................................... 51

Call Forwarding +CCFC .......................................................................................................................................... 51

Calling Line Identification Restriction +CLIR ........................................................................................................... 52

Calling Line Identification Presentation +CLIP ........................................................................................................ 52

Send Flash to Base Station +WFSH ....................................................................................................................... 53

List Current Call State +CLCC ................................................................................................................................ 54

Chapter 9 – Data Commands ...................................................................................................................................... 55

Using AT Commands During a Data Connection ..................................................................................................... 55

Select Mode +FCLASS ........................................................................................................................................... 55

Cellular Result Codes +CRC ................................................................................................................................... 56

DTE-DCE Local Rate Reporting +ILRR .................................................................................................................. 56

V.42 bis Data Compression +DS ............................................................................................................................. 57

V.42 bis Data Compression Report +DR ................................................................................................................. 57

Chapter 10 – V.24-V.25 Commands ............................................................................................................................ 58

Fixed DTE Rate +IPR .............................................................................................................................................. 58

DTE-DCE Character Framing +ICF ......................................................................................................................... 58

DTE-DCE Local Flow Control +IFC ......................................................................................................................... 59

Set DCD Signal &C ................................................................................................................................................. 59

Set DTR Signal &D .................................................................................................................................................. 60

Set DSR Signal &S .................................................................................................................................................. 60

Back to Online Mode O ........................................................................................................................................... 60

Result Code Suppression Q .................................................................................................................................... 60

DCE Response Format V ........................................................................................................................................ 61

Audio Loopback &T ................................................................................................................................................. 61

Echo E 61

Display Configuration &V ........................................................................................................................................ 61

Request Identification Information I ......................................................................................................................... 62

Restore Factory Setting &F ..................................................................................................................................... 62

Save Configuration &W ........................................................................................................................................... 62

Chapter 11 – Phone Book Commands ....................................................................................................................... 63

Select Phonebook Memory Storage +CPBS ........................................................................................................... 63

Return Selected Phonebook Locations +CPBU ...................................................................................................... 64

Find Phonebook Entries +CPBF ............................................................................................................................. 64

Write Phonebook Entry +CPBW .............................................................................................................................. 65

Phonebook Read +CPBR........................................................................................................................................ 66

Phonebook Search +CPBP ..................................................................................................................................... 66

Avoid Phonebook Initialization +WAIP .................................................................................................................... 67

Delete Calls From Phonebook +WDCP .................................................................................................................. 67

Chapter 12 – Position Determination (GPS) Commands .......................................................................................... 68

Position Determination Session Type +WPDST ...................................................................................................... 68

Position Determination Operating Mode +WPDOM ................................................................................................ 69

Position Determination Data Download +WPDDD .................................................................................................. 69

Position Determination Fix Rate +WPDFR .............................................................................................................. 70

Position Determination Privacy Level +WPDPL ...................................................................................................... 70

Position Determination NV Privacy Level +WPPRV ................................................................................................ 70

Position Determination Transport Setting +WPTLM ................................................................................................ 71

Set Position Determination IP Address +WPDIP ..................................................................................................... 71

Set Position Determination Port ID +WPDPT .......................................................................................................... 71

Position Determination Start Session +WPDSS ...................................................................................................... 72

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 4

Table of Contents

Position Determination End Session +WPDES ....................................................................................................... 72

gpsOne Session Consent +WPDCT ........................................................................................................................ 73 gpsOne Session Prompt Input +WPDUC ................................................................................................................. 73

IP Server Address +WMPC ...................................................................................................................................... 73

Chapter 13 - Specific AT Commands ......................................................................................................................... 74

Manufacturer Identification +WGMI ......................................................................................................................... 74

Request Model Identification +WGMM .................................................................................................................... 74

Cell Environment and RxLev Indication +CCED ..................................................................................................... 75

Analog Digital Converters Measurements +ADC .................................................................................................... 77

Mobile Equipment Event Reporting +CMER ........................................................................................................... 77

Read GPIO Value +WIOR ....................................................................................................................................... 78

Write GPIO Value +WIOW ...................................................................................................................................... 78

Play Tone +WTONE ................................................................................................................................................ 78

Play DTMF Tone +WDTMF ..................................................................................................................................... 79

Hardware Version +WHWV ..................................................................................................................................... 79

Select Voice Gain +WSVG ...................................................................................................................................... 80

Status Request +WSTR .......................................................................................................................................... 80

Ring Indicator Mode +WRIM ................................................................................................................................... 81

32kHz Sleep Mode +W32K ..................................................................................................................................... 81

Change Default Melody +WCDM ............................................................................................................................ 82

Software Version +WSSW ...................................................................................................................................... 82

Custom Character Set Tables +WCCS ................................................................................................................... 83

CPHS Command +CPHS ........................................................................................................................................ 83

Change Default Player +WCDP .............................................................................................................................. 84

Reset +WRST ......................................................................................................................................................... 84

Set Standard Tone +WSST ..................................................................................................................................... 85

Set Voice Privacy Level +WPRV ............................................................................................................................. 85

Security PIN +WPIN ................................................................................................................................................ 86

Request PRL Version Information +WPRL.............................................................................................................. 86

Minute Alert +WMBP ............................................................................................................................................... 87

Configure LED Indicator +CLED ............................................................................................................................. 87

Keypad Enable/Disable +WPAD ............................................................................................................................. 88

Chapter 14 - SIM ToolKit for RUIM Software Version ............................................................................................... 89

Overview of SIM Application ToolKit ........................................................................................................................ 89

Messages Exchanged During a SIM ToolKit Operation ........................................................................................... 90

SIM ToolKit Set Facilities +STSF ............................................................................................................................ 91

SIM ToolKit Indication +STIN .................................................................................................................................. 92

SIM ToolKit Get Information +STGI ......................................................................................................................... 93

Unsolicited Result: SIM ToolKit Control Response +STCR) .................................................................................... 96

SIM ToolKit Give Response +STGR ....................................................................................................................... 96

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands ................................................................................................................. 99

Introductory Note ...................................................................................................................................................... 99

Service Programming Code +WSPC .................................................................................................................... 100

Mobile Directory Number +WMDN ........................................................................................................................ 100

Set IMSI +WIMI ..................................................................................................................................................... 100

SID and NID +WSID .............................................................................................................................................. 101

Access Overload Class +WAOC ........................................................................................................................... 101

Slot Cycle Index +WSCI ........................................................................................................................................ 101

Primary Browser Gateway +WBGP ....................................................................................................................... 102

Secondary Browser Gateway +WBGS .................................................................................................................. 102

Packet Dial String +WPDS .................................................................................................................................... 102

Primary CDMA Channels +WPCC ........................................................................................................................ 102

Secondary CDMA Channels +WSCC ................................................................................................................... 103

Service Option Management +WSOM .................................................................................................................. 103

Commit Changes +WCMT .................................................................................................................................... 104

Read SID/NID Entries +WSNR ............................................................................................................................. 104

Download PRL +DPRL ........................................................................................................................................... 105

Service Programming Example .............................................................................................................................. 106

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3 ................................................................................................... 107

Remote Async Command X .................................................................................................................................. 107

Reset to Default Configuration Z0 ......................................................................................................................... 107

Select Tone Dialing T ............................................................................................................................................ 107

Select Pulse Dialing P ........................................................................................................................................... 108

Basic S-Registers S .............................................................................................................................................. 108

Error Control Operation +EB ................................................................................................................................. 109

Numeric Parameter Control +EFCS ...................................................................................................................... 109

Error Control Report +ER ...................................................................................................................................... 109

Error Control Selection +ES .................................................................................................................................. 110

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 5

Table of Contents

Error Control Selective Repeat +ESR ................................................................................................................... 110

Error Control Selection +ETBM ............................................................................................................................. 111

Request Manufacture Identification +GMI ............................................................................................................. 111

Request Manufacture Identification +GMM ........................................................................................................... 111

Request Revision Identification +GMR .................................................................................................................. 112

Request Product Serial Number Identification +GSN ............................................................................................ 112

Request Global Object Identification +GOI............................................................................................................ 112

Modulation Selection +MS ..................................................................................................................................... 113

Modulation Automode Control +MA ...................................................................................................................... 113

Modulation Reporting Control +MR ....................................................................................................................... 113

V.18 Reporting Control +MV18R ........................................................................................................................... 114

V.18 Selection +MV18S ........................................................................................................................................ 114

Cellular Extension +CXT ....................................................................................................................................... 115

Configuration String +CFG .................................................................................................................................... 115

Query Service +CAD ............................................................................................................................................. 115

U m

Interface Data Compression Reporting +CDR ................................................................................................. 116

U m

Interface Data Compression +CDS ................................................................................................................. 116

Set Rm Interface Protocol +CRM .......................................................................................................................... 116

Battery Charge +CBC ........................................................................................................................................... 117

Command State Inactivity Timer +CQD ................................................................................................................ 117

Mobile Station IP Address +CMIP ......................................................................................................................... 117

Base Station IP Address +CBIP ............................................................................................................................ 118

Serving System +CSS ........................................................................................................................................... 118

Select Multiplex Option +CMUX ............................................................................................................................ 119

Hang-up Voice +CHV ............................................................................................................................................ 119

Dial Command for Voice Calls +CDV .................................................................................................................... 120

U m

Packet Data Inactivity Timer +CTA .................................................................................................................. 120

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation ................................................................ 121

Transition to Diagnostics Monitor $QCDMG ......................................................................................................... 121

Quick Net Connect $QCQNC ................................................................................................................................ 121

Protocol Revision in Use $QCPREV ..................................................................................................................... 121

Originate M-to-M Packet Data Call $QCMTOM .................................................................................................... 122

Dump RLP Protocol Statistics $QCRLPD ............................................................................................................. 122

Reset RLP Protocol Statistics $QCRLPR .............................................................................................................. 122

Dump PPP Protocol Statistics $QCPPPD ............................................................................................................. 122

Reset PPP Protocol Statistics $QCPPPR ............................................................................................................. 123

Dump IP Protocol Statistics $QCIPD ..................................................................................................................... 123

Reset IP Protocol Statistics $QCIPR ..................................................................................................................... 123

Dump UDP Protocol Statistics $QCUDPD ............................................................................................................ 123

Reset UDP Protocol Statistics $QCUDPR ............................................................................................................ 123

Dump TCP Protocol Statistics $QCTCPD ............................................................................................................. 124

Reset TCP Protocol Statistics $QCTCPR ............................................................................................................. 124

Set Data Service Option $QCSO .......................................................................................................................... 124

Clear Mobile Error Log $QCCLR ........................................................................................................................... 124

Answer Incoming Voice Call $QCCAV .................................................................................................................. 125

Automatic Packet Detection $QCPKND ................................................................................................................ 125

Pre-arrangement Setting $QCVAD ....................................................................................................................... 125

Set DM Baud Rate $QCDMR ................................................................................................................................ 125

Set Medium Data Rate $QCMDR.......................................................................................................................... 126

Dump RLP 3 Protocol Statistics $QCRL3D ........................................................................................................... 126

Reset RLP 3 Protocol Statistics $QCRL3R ........................................................................................................... 126

SCRM’ing Selection $QCSCRM............................................................................................................................ 126

R-SCH Throttling Selection $QCTRTL .................................................................................................................. 127

R-SCH IP Selection $QCMIP ................................................................................................................................ 127

MIP Selection $QCMIPP ....................................................................................................................................... 128

RFC2002bis Selection $QCMIPT .......................................................................................................................... 128

Current Active Profile $QCMIPEP ......................................................................................................................... 128

Return Profile Information $QCMIPGETP ............................................................................................................. 129

Set NAI for Active Profile $QCMIPNAI .................................................................................................................. 129

Set Reverse Tunneling $QCMIPRT ...................................................................................................................... 129

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile $QCMIPMASS .............................................................................. 130

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile $QCMIPMHSS ................................................................................ 130

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in HEX Active Profile $QCMIPMASSX ................................................................... 130

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in HEX Active Profile $QCMIPMHSSX ..................................................................... 131

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile $QCMIPMASPI ............................................................................. 131

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile $QCMIPMHSPI ............................................................................... 131

Set Primary HA IP Address $QCMIPPHA ............................................................................................................. 132

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 6

Table of Contents

Set Secondary HA IP Address $QCMIPSHA ........................................................................................................ 132

Set Home HA IP Address $QCMIPHA .................................................................................................................. 132

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands ................................................................................................................. 133

Start/End PPP Connection +WPPP ...................................................................................................................... 134

Open Socket +WOSK ........................................................................................................................................... 134

Close Socket +WCSK ........................................................................................................................................... 135

Transmit Socket Data +WSTX .............................................................................................................................. 135

Read Receive Data +WSRX ................................................................................................................................. 136

Display Connection Status +WGSS ...................................................................................................................... 137

Configure Socket Transmit Timeout +WTMO ........................................................................................................ 137

Configure Receive Data Mode +WCRX ................................................................................................................ 138

Force Dormant Mode +WFDM .............................................................................................................................. 138

IP Address Lookup +WDNS .................................................................................................................................. 139

Display IP Address +WIPC .................................................................................................................................... 139

PPP Session Status +WPPP ................................................................................................................................. 139

Socket State Change +WSKS ............................................................................................................................... 140

Socket Open/Close Error +WSKE ......................................................................................................................... 140

Socket Data Transmission Status +WSTX ............................................................................................................ 140

Socket Data Transmission Error +WSTE .............................................................................................................. 141

Received Socket Data +WSRX ............................................................................................................................. 141

Socket Data Error +WSRE .................................................................................................................................... 141

Dormant Mode Status Change +WDOR ............................................................................................................... 142

DNS Lookup Indication +WDNS ............................................................................................................................ 142

Chapter 19 – Reference Information ........................................................................................................................ 143

MS Error Result Code : +CME ERROR: <err> ....................................................................................................... 143

Message Service Failure Result Code: +CMS ERROR: <err> ............................................................................... 144

Specific Error Result Codes ................................................................................................................................... 144

Extended Error Report (+CEER) Call Processing Codes ....................................................................................... 144

Final Result Codes ................................................................................................................................................. 145

Intermediate Result Codes ..................................................................................................................................... 145

gpsOne Error Result Code: +WPDER: <code> ...................................................................................................... 146

Parameters Storage ............................................................................................................................................... 147

Codes for SMS Status Report (+CDS and +CMGR) .............................................................................................. 148

AT Commands Supported When SIM Card Removed ........................................................................................... 149

AT Commands for AMPS Operation ...................................................................................................................... 149

TCP App Socket Status Events .............................................................................................................................. 150

TCP App Socket Error Codes ................................................................................................................................ 150

TCP App DNS Server Codes ................................................................................................................................. 150

TCP App PPP Network Codes ............................................................................................................................... 150

TCP App Restricted AT Commands ....................................................................................................................... 151

Phonebook UCS2 Unicode .................................................................................................................................... 152

Commands Over DM Port (MuxLite) ...................................................................................................................... 153

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes .............................................................................................................. 155

Cell Broadcast Message Directly Displayed +CBM ............................................................................................... 155

Cell Broadcast Message Stored in Memory +CBMI .............................................................................................. 155

Cell Environment Description Indication +CCED ................................................................................................... 155

Call Waiting Indication +CCWA ............................................................................................................................. 156

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS ....................................................................................... 156

SMS Status Report Indication Stored in Memory +CDSI ...................................................................................... 156

Key Press or Release +CKEV ............................................................................................................................... 156

Caller ID Presentation +CLIP ................................................................................................................................ 157

Incoming Message Directly Displayed +CMT ........................................................................................................ 157

Incoming Message Stored in Memory +CMTI ....................................................................................................... 157

Mode Preference +COPS ...................................................................................................................................... 158

Registration & Roaming +CREG ........................................................................................................................... 158

Incoming Call +CRING .......................................................................................................................................... 158

RxLev Indication +CSQ ......................................................................................................................................... 159

Incoming Call +RING ............................................................................................................................................ 159

Call Answered +WANS ......................................................................................................................................... 159

Call Connected +WCNT ........................................................................................................................................ 160

Call Ended +WEND ............................................................................................................................................... 160

Feature Notification Message +WFNM ................................................................................................................. 160

Flash Indication +WFSH........................................................................................................................................ 161

General Indicator +WIND ...................................................................................................................................... 161

Call Originated +WORG ........................................................................................................................................ 162

Call Privacy Indication +WPRV ............................................................................................................................. 162

Roaming Indication +WROM ................................................................................................................................. 162

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 7

Table of Contents

Emergency Mode +WSOS .................................................................................................................................... 163

Current NAM Change +WNAM ............................................................................................................................. 163

Voice Mail Indicator +WVMI .................................................................................................................................. 164

SMS Message Storage Full +WMGF .................................................................................................................... 164

Power Save +WSPS ............................................................................................................................................. 164

Position Determination Start Session Result +1 ................................................................................................... 165

Position Determination Error +WPDER ................................................................................................................ 166

gpsOne Session Prompt +WPUST ........................................................................................................................ 167

Download PRL Status +DPRL .............................................................................................................................. 167

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples ..................................................................................................................... 168

General Examples .................................................................................................................................................. 168

Voice/Data Call Examples ...................................................................................................................................... 168

Short Message Examples ...................................................................................................................................... 170

GpsOne Examples ................................................................................................................................................. 171

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands ...................................................................................................... 175

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS ....................................................................................... 175

Incoming Message Directly Displayed +CMT ........................................................................................................ 175

Roaming Indication +WROM ................................................................................................................................. 176

Enhanced Roaming Indication +WERI .................................................................................................................. 176

Emergency Mode +WSOS .................................................................................................................................... 177

Read Message +CMGR ........................................................................................................................................ 177

List Message +CMGL ............................................................................................................................................ 178

Send Message +CMGS ........................................................................................................................................ 179

Write Message to Memory +CMGW ...................................................................................................................... 180

Service Programming Code +WSPC .................................................................................................................... 180

Verizon® System Selection +WVSS ..................................................................................................................... 181

Initial Programming Required +WOT0 .................................................................................................................. 181

Programming In Progress +WOT1 ........................................................................................................................ 181

Programming Successful +WOT2 ......................................................................................................................... 181

Programming Unsuccessful +WOT3 ..................................................................................................................... 181

Commit Successful +WOTC .................................................................................................................................. 182

SPL Unlocked +WOTS .......................................................................................................................................... 182

NAM Download OK +WOTN ................................................................................................................................. 182

MDM Download OK +WOTM ................................................................................................................................ 182

MSI Download OK +WOTI .................................................................................................................................... 182

PRL Download OK +WOTP .................................................................................................................................. 182

Excess SPC Failures +WLCK ............................................................................................................................... 182

Position Determination Lock Level +WPLCK ........................................................................................................ 183

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands ......................................................................................................... 184

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS ....................................................................................... 184

Set Phone Functionality +CFUN ........................................................................................................................... 184

Signal Quality +CSQ ............................................................................................................................................. 185

Facility Lock +CLCK .............................................................................................................................................. 185

Mobile Directory Number +WMDN ........................................................................................................................ 186

Serving System +CSS ........................................................................................................................................... 186

Packet Zone Identifier +PZID ................................................................................................................................ 187

Boot URL +WBURL ............................................................................................................................................... 187

Trusted Domain +WTDMN .................................................................................................................................... 187

Proxy Address +WDPXY ....................................................................................................................................... 187

WIOTA Connection Control +WIOTA .................................................................................................................... 188

Sprint® System Selection +WSSS ........................................................................................................................ 188

IOTA Error +WOAE ............................................................................................................................................... 188

Preparing Data Services +WOAP ......................................................................................................................... 188

Please Retry +WOAR ........................................................................................................................................... 188

Display PRI Checksum +WSUM ........................................................................................................................... 189

Reset MIN and MDN to Factory Defaults +WRMM ............................................................................................... 189

IOTA Feature Application Note .............................................................................................................................. 190

Index ........................................................................................................................................................................... 191

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 8

Chapter 1 – Introduction

Chapter 1 – Introduction

The AT command set is one of the main interfaces for the modem to interact with an external application layer. CDMA AT commands are defined in TIA/EIA/IS707.3. However, as the wireless applications increase, TIA/EIA/IS707.3 is not sufficient. In addition, a lot of GSM applications already exist and GSM customers would like to maintain the same interface in order to make no or minimum changes to the applications to be used with CDMA modem. To meet the all these needs, this CDMA AT command set is designed to cover the following:

1.

IS707.3 AT commands;

2. GSM 07.07 when applicable;

3.

GSM 07.05 when applicable,

4. ITU-T v25 when applicable;

5.

Proprietary AT set;

6. Customer specific AT commands;

7.

Qualcomm defined AT commands.

Please note that in several instances, the GSM 7.07 and 7.05 specifications could not be followed because of fundamental differences between CDMA and GSM call processing behaviors. In these cases, minimal changes were made to the GSMrelated commands.

Scope of This Document

This document describes CDMA AT commands, their syntax, responses, and result codes. It serves as the reference for wireless application development based on the CDMA modem and for its integration and testing. The intended audience is expected to be familiar with CDMA data services protocol and AT modem commands.

Related References

This interface specification is based on the following recommendations or standards:

1.

ETSI GSM 07.05: Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2); Use of DTE-DCE interface for Short

Message Service (SMS) and Cell Broadcast Service (CBS)

2. ETSI GSM 07.07: Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2); AT command set for GSM Mobile Equipment

(ME)

3. ITU-T Recommendation V.25 ter: Serial asynchronous automatic dialing and control

4.

ETSI GSM 03.40: Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2); Technical implementation of the Short

Message Service (SMS) Point-to-Point (PP)

5.

ETSI GSM 03.38: Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2); Alphabets and language-specific information

6. ETSI GSM 04.80: Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2): Mobile radio interface layer 3,

Supplementary service specification, Formats and coding

7. TIA/EIA/IS-707.3: Data Service Options for Wideband Spread Spectrum Systems: AT Command Processing and the

Rm Interface

8. IS-131: Data Transmissions Systems and Equipment – Extensions to Asynchronous Dialing and Control.

9.

TIA/EIA-592: Asynchronous Facsimile DCE Control Standard – Service Class 2.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 9

Chapter 1 – Introduction

Terminology and Acronyms

This is an alphabetical list of terms and acronyms used throughout this document and the CDMA cellular industry.

2G

3G

AFLT

Second Generation. All digital cellular systems developed to replace the first analog cellular systems. (GSM and CDMA).

Third Generation. Next generation digital cellular systems designed to have high-speed data access and higher voice capacity (CDMA & CDMA2000).

Advanced Forward Link Trilateration. A type of handset-based position location technology. GPS satellites are not used to determine location. To determine location using AFLT, the phone takes measurements of signals from nearby cellular base stations (towers) and reports the time/distance readings back to the network, which are then used to triangulate an approximate location of the handset. In general, at least three surrounding base stations are required to get an optimal position fix.

CBM

CDMA cdmaONE cdma2000

DCE

DTE

DTMF

Cell Broadcast Message. An SMS message that is broadcast to all mobiles on the network.

Code Division Multiple Access. CDMA is a spread spectrum, digital wireless modulation scheme for cellular communications systems. It has approximately 3 times the voice capacity of GSM networks. See IS-95, IS-

95B, IS-2000.

cdmaOne is a brand name, trademarked and reserved for the exclusive use of the CDMA Development

Group. cdmaOne describes a complete wireless system that incorporates the IS-95 CDMA air interface, the

ANSI-41 network standard for switch interconnection and many other standards that make up a complete wireless system. cdma2000 is a third generation (3G) wireless system. It contains a significant increase in voice capacity and high-speed data rates. It is backward compatible with IS-95B and IS-95A.

Data Communications Equipment. This is the modem in the traditional serial communication paradigm of a computer connected via two modems to another computer.

Data Terminal Equipment. This is the computer in the traditional serial communication paradigm of a computer connected via two modems to another computer.

Dual Tone Multi-Frequency: A pre-defined set of tones sent over the air when keys are pressed on the keypad.

Handset (Path)

The audio path (microphone & speaker) that connects to a traditional hand held telephone receiver, usually dual balanced electrical lines.

Headset (Path)

The audio path (microphone & speaker) that connects to an earpiece with a microphone, usually single electrical lines.

IMSI

International Mobile Station IS. This is an international 15 digital phone number that uniquely identifies a mobile. IMSI=MCC + MNC + MIN.

IOTA

Internet Over The Air.

IS-95 The first CDMA standard published by Qualcomm in 1993. It is a TIA standard for North American cellular systems based on CDMA. It is widely deployed in North America and Asia.

IS-95A

IS-95B

IS-2000

IS-707

A CDMA standard with improved voice quality. IS-95A defines what generally is known as cdmaOne, which supports voice and 14.4 Kbps data rates. This is a worldwide standard.

This CDMA standard contains Medium Data Rate capabilities and bug fixes for system access failures. It is considered a 2.5G system. It supports data rates up to 115 Kbps.

The first 3G CDMA standard based on IS-95B. It contains a significant increase in voice capacity and highspeed data rates. It is backward compatible with IS-95B and IS-95A.

TIA/EIA/IS-707 describes data services available on wideband spread spectrum systems. It is organized into a series of related recommendations, some of which address functions common to all CDMA data services and others that describe a specific data service.

IWF

:

LAPM:

MCC

Interworking Function. A process that acts as a gateway or interface between two or more communication components. For example, an IWF is used to interface wireless CDMA networks and wire line PSTN or packet-data networks.

Link Access Procedure for Modems. An error control protocol defined in the ITU-T recommendations V.42.

Like the MNP protocols, LAPM uses cyclic redundancy checking (CRC) and retransmission of corrupted data (ARQ) to ensure data reliability.

Mobile Country Code. A pre-defined 30-digital number that represents a country in the IMSI.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 10

Chapter 1 – Introduction

MDN

MIN

MNC

MO

MS

MT

MSM

NAM

NID

NV-RAM

OTAPA

Mobile Data Number or the mobile phone number.

Mobile Identification Number or mobile user account number.

Mobile Network Code. A pre-defined 2-digital number that represents a sub-network in the IMSI (usually set to “00”).

Mobile Originated. An action (usually a call) that is first started from the phone. An outgoing call or SMS.

Mobile Station. The term MS is commonly used to represent the phone or mobile.

Mobile Terminated: An action that is initiated from a land based network. An incoming call or SMS.

Mobile Station Modem.

Number Assignment Modem. The NAM is collection of internal parameters that define a working phone for a given network (phone number, access parameters, etc.).

Network ID. The NID is an identification number that represents geographic location of a common coverage area; but is a subset of the SID, usually a neighborhood in a large city. NID is usually not used and is set to zero. Also see SID.

Non-Volatile Random Access Memory, NV-RAM is a data storage device that does not lose its data when power is turned off.

Over The Air Parameter Administration. An automatic update in internal software parameters (PRL for example) by means of a specially defined CDMA data call that is mobile terminated (MT).

OTASP

PD

PDU

P-REV

PRI

PRL

SIM

PN Offset

Over The Air Service Programming. An automatic update in internal software parameters PRL; for example, by means of a specially defined CDMA data call that is mobile terminated (MT).

Position Determination. Process by which the mobile GPS position is obtained.

A GSM SMS standard where any type of binary data can be transported via an SMS message. In the CDMA system, the PDU mode is not supported; instead, the Unicode format message is supported.

Pseudorandom Noise Offset: In a CDMA network the PN offset is a variable time delay offset of a repeating random noise generator that is used to distinguish individual sectors of a base station.

The CDMA revision of the mobile or base station.

Product Release Instructions. Carrier specific information required for activation on a CDMA network.

Preferred Roaming List. The PRL is a collection of frequencies, SIDs and NIDs that the call processing software uses to search for approved and unapproved CDMA networks. The PRL is loaded into the phone and is saved in NV-RAM.

Public Switching Telephone Network. The traditional telephone network.

PSTN

RF Radio

RSSI

Receive Signal Strength Indicator: This parameter represents the total RF received signal power from the base station(s) the mobile sees..

R-UIM Removable User Identity Module

– The R-UIM is similar to a subscriber identity module (SIM), but designed for networks other than GSM (global system for mobile telecommunications), such as CDMA.

The R-UIM card contains user information and data features on a removable smart card about the size of a postage stamp. It is a dual-mode solution that can store both GSM provisioning and CDMA provisioning on a single card. When used with a GSM handset, the R-UIM operates like a GSM SIM.

SID System ID. The SID is an identification number that represents geographic locations of a common coverage area, usually a large city. Also see NID.

Subscriber Identity Module.

A SIM card is a portable memory chip. The SIM holds personal identity information, cell phone number, phone book, text messages, and other data.

SMS

SREJ:

Short Messaging Service; A supplement service that is capable of sending and receiving short length text messages to/from the mobile.

Selective Reject. An optional feature of V.42 which enhances data throughput on noisy connections. As data blocks are sent out, the remote side acknowledges only after an agreed upon number of blocks are received

(window size). If any block is received bad, the sender is notified of the rejected bad block so it can be retransmitted.

TA/TE Terminal Application/Terminal Equipment. This is the end “device” (combination of hardware and software) that communicates with a modem via a serial link. In this context, it is the device (PDA/Computer) connected to the WISMO Quik. Also see DTE.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 11

TON/NP

V24-V25

V42

Type of Number/Numbering Plan Identification.

A data compression algorithm.

A data compression algorithm.

Chapter 1 – Introduction

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 12

Chapter 2 – At Command Features

Chapter 2 – AT Command

Features

Serial Interface Settings

A module serial interface is set with the following default values (factory settings):

115,200bps

8 bits data

1 stop bit no parity

RTS/CTS flow control.

Note: Some models may have a different value for the default baud rate.

The +IPR, +IFC and +ICF commands can be used to change these settings, if required. Changes made using these commands become effective immediately following the transmission of the successful command result (OK).

Command Line

Commands always start with AT (which means ATtention) and finish with a <CR> character .

For example:

ATI3<cr>

AT+CGSN<cr>

Display the model and software revision information.

Display the electronic serial number (ESN).

Enable extended AT command results.

Initiate a voice call.

AT+CMEE=1<cr>

ATD5551212<cr>

Information Responses and Result Codes

Command responses start and end with <cr><lf>, unless the ATV0 (DCE response format) and the ATQ1 (result code suppression) commands have been entered.

• If the command has been performed successfully, an OK is returned following any command-related output.

• If command syntax is incorrect, an ERROR string is returned.

• If extended error reports are enabled (+CMEE), the +CME ERROR: <Err> or +CMS ERROR: <SmsErr> strings are returned with different error codes. Refer to the appendix for a definition of error codes and their meanings.

• If the command line has been performed successfully, an OK string is returned.

• In the following examples <CR> and <CR><LF> are intentionally omitted.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 13

Chapter 3 – General Commands

Chapter 3 - General Commands

Attention AT

Description:

This two character command prefix is used to alert the module software that a command has been entered for processing. This prefix must be included in all commands unless otherwise noted. When entered alone, the module responds with OK to signify it is ready to process commands.

Syntax:

Command syntax: AT

Command

AT

Note: Module in online mode.

Possible responses

Note: No response returned.

+++

Note: Reset module.

AT

Note: Module in offline mode.

Note: No response returned.

OK

Note: Ready to process commands.

Request Revision Identification +CGMR

Description:

This command is used to display the operating software version.

Syntax:

Command syntax: AT+CGMR

Command Possible Responses

AT+CGMR

Note: Get software version

+CGMR: S/W VER: WISMOQ WQ1.1 Mar 20 2002 17:30:00

OK

Note: Software Version WISMOQ, revision WQ1.1 generated on the

March 20th, 2002 at 17:30:00

Electronic Serial Number +CGSN

Description:

This command allows the user application to get the ESN of the product. The ESN value is displayed in hexadecimal format.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CGSN

Command Possible Responses

AT+CGSN

Note: Get the ESN

+CGSN: FE7A7704

OK

Note: ESN read from NV

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 14

Chapter 3 – General Commands

Select TE Character Set +CSCS

Description: This command informs the MS which character set is in use by the TE. The MS uses this information to convert each character of entered or displayed text data. The character set is used for send, read or write of short messages.

Values: <Character Set>

“CDMA”

CDMA default (ASCII) character set.

Syntax:

“CUST” Custom character set.

Command syntax: AT+CSCS=<Character Set>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CSCS=”CDMA”

Note: CDMA default alphabet

AT+CSCS?

Note: Custom character set

OK

Note: Command valid

+CSCS: “CDMA”

OK

Note: Command valid

AT+CSCS=?

Note: Get possible values

+CSCS: ("CDMA","CUST")

OK

Note: Possible values

Request IMSI +CIMI

Description:

This command is used to read and identify the IMSI (International Mobile Subscriber Identity ) of the modem.

The PIN may need to be entered using the CPIN command before reading the IMSI.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CIMI

Command Possible Responses

AT+CIMI

Note: Read the IMSI

+CIMI: 310008585551212

OK

Note: IMSI value (15 digits)

Capabilities List +GCAP

Description:

This command gets the complete list of capabilities.

Syntax

: Command syntax: AT+GCAP

Command Possible Responses

AT+GCAP

Note: Get capabilities list

+GCAP: +CGSM, +CIS707-A, +MS, +ES, +DS, +FCLASS

OK

Repeat Last Command A/

Description:

This command repeats the previous command. Only the A/ command itself cannot be repeated.

Syntax:

Command syntax: A/

Command Possible Responses

A/

Note: Repeat last command

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 15

Chapter 3 – General Commands

Phone Offline +CPOF

Description:

This command sends all CDMA software stack tasks offline. AT command can still be received, however,

Syntax: there is no RF functionality. The AT+CFUN=0 command is equivalent to +CPOF.

Command syntax: AT+CPOF

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPOF

Note: Stop CDMA stack

+CPOF:

OK Note: Command valid

Set Phone Functionality +CFUN

Description:

This command selects the mobile station’s level of functionality. AT+CFUN=0 is equivalent to AT+CPOF

The AT+CFUN=1 (by default, AT+CFUN will act the same as AT+CFUN=1) command restarts the entire

CDMA stack and CDMA functionality: a complete software reset is performed. In addition, the OK response will be sent at the last baud rate defined by the +IPR command.

Values: <functionality

0

Set the phone to OFFLINE mode.

Syntax:

1 Set the phone to ONLINE mode and resets.

Command syntax: AT+CFUN=<functionality level>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CFUN?

Note: Ask for current functionality level

AT+CFUN=0

Note: Set phone offline

AT+CFUN=1

Note: Set phone ONLINE. A software reset is performed.

+CFUN: 1

OK

Note: Full functionality

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

Phone Activity Status +CPAS

Description:

This command returns the activity status of the mobile equipment.

Values: <pas>

0 ready (allow commands from TA/TE)

1 unavailable (does not allow commands)

Syntax:

2 unknown

3 ringing (ringer is active)

4 call in progress

5 asleep (low functionality)

6 corrupted RF calibration values (checksum mismatch)

Command syntax: AT+CPAS

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPAS

Note: Current activity status

+CPAS: <pas>

OK

Report Mobile Equipment Errors +CMEE

Description:

This command disables or enables the use of the “+CME ERROR : <xxx>” or “+CMS ERROR :<xxx>” result code instead of simply “ERROR”. See Chapter 20 "MS Error Result Codes" for +CME ERROR result codes

Syntax: description and Chapter 20 "Message Service Failure Result Codes" for +CMS ERROR result codes.

Command syntax: AT+CMEE=<error reporting flag>

Command Possible Responses

OK AT+CMEE=0

Note: Disable MS error reports, use only « ERROR »

AT+CMEE=1

Note: Enable «+CME ERROR: <xxx>» or «+CMS ERROR: <xxx>»

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 16

Chapter 3 – General Commands

Keypad Control +CKPD

Description:

This command emulates the MS keypad by sending each keystroke as a character in a <keys> string.

If emulation fails, a +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. If emulation succeeds, the result depends on the

CDMA sequence activated: <keys>: string of the following characters (0-9,*,#).

Syntax:

Command syntax: AT+CKPD=<keys>

Command

AT+CKPD=”*#21#” Note: Key sequence allowed

AT+CKPD=1234 Note: Sequence not allowed

Possible Responses

OK

+CME ERROR 3

Clock Management +CCLK

Description:

Syntax:

This command is used to set or get the current date and time of the MS real-time clock.

String format for date/time is: “yy/MM/dd,hh:mm:ss”.

Valid years are 98 (for 1998) to 97 (for 2097). The seconds field is not mandatory.

Default date/time is “98/01/01,00:00:00” (January, 1998 / midnight).

Command syntax: AT+CCLK=<date and time string>

Command

AT+CCLK=”00/06/09,17:33:00”

Note: set date to June 9th, 2000, and time to 5:33pm

AT+CCLK=”00/13/13,12:00:00”

Note: Incorrect month entered

AT+CCLK?

Note: Get current date and time

Possible Responses

OK or ERROR

Note: Date/Time stored – ERROR returned when RTC not enabled

+CME ERROR 3

+CCLK: “00/06/09,17:34:23”

Note: current date is June 9, 2000 current time is 5:34:23 pm – network time if available, otherwise calculated based on previous network time if available, otherwise ERROR.

Ring Melody Playback +CRMP

Description: This command causes a melody to be played. The specified melody will playback in an endless loop until stopped with another +CRMP command. All melodies are manufacturer defined. Up to ten manufacturerdefined melodies may be available for individual playback.

Note:

Looped melodies must be stopped by a +CRMP command with the <index> field set to 0 (example:

+CRMP=0,,,0).

When the +CRMP command is performed, the <volume> parameter overwrites the <sound level> value of the +CRSL command.

Values: <call type> A value must be specified; however, the value is currently ignored.

0 Reserved

1

Reserved

2 Reserved

3 Reserved

<volume>

0 Min volume (mute)

...

1 Default

4

Max

<type> A value must be specified if <index> is specified; however, the value is currently ignored.

0

Manufacturer Defined (default)

<index>

0

Stop Melody Playback

1-10 Melody ID for voice/data call type (default:1)

Syntax:

Command syntax: AT+CRMP=<call type>[,<volume>,<type>,<index>]

Command

AT+CRMP=0,2,0,2

Note: Play voice call melody index 2 with volume level 2.

AT+CRMP=0,,,0

Note: Stop the melody.

AT+CRMP=?

Note: supported parameters

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Melody Playback.

OK

Note: The melody is stopped.

+CRMP: (0-3),(0-4),(0-0),(0-10)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 17

Chapter 3 – General Commands

Ringer Sound Level +CRSL

Description

:

Values:

This command is used to set/get the sound level of the ringer on incoming calls.

Syntax:

<sound level>

0 Min volume (muted)

1

Default volume (default)

4 Max volume

Command syntax: AT+CRSL=<sound Level>

Command

AT+CRSL=0

Note: Set volume to Min (muted).

AT+CRSL=4

Note: Set volume to Max.

AT+CRSL?

Note: Get current ringer sound level

AT+CRSL=4

Note: Supported parameters

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Current ring playing is muted.

OK

Note: Current ring playing with Max. volume.

CRSL:4

OK

Note: Current level is 4

CRSL: (0-4)

OK

Subscriber Number +CNUM

Description:

This command is used to return the subscriber MSISDN. If the subscriber has different MSISDNs for different services, each MSISDN is returned on a separate line.

Values: <alphax> optional alphanumeric string associated with <numberx> string type phone number with format as specified by <typex>

<typex>

Syntax

:

Command syntax:

Ruim command syntax: AT+CNUM=<number> (RUIM software releases only)

Response syntax:

+CNUM: <alpha1>, <number1>, <type1>, <CR><LF>+CNUM: <alpha2>, <number2>,

Command

AT+CNUM

AT+CNUM

<type2> …

Note: Get MSISDN

Possible Responses

+CNUM :“Phone”,”8585551212”,129

Note: MSISDNs

AT+CNUM=? +CNUM:

OK

AT+CNUM=8585551212

Note: Set module phone number in RUIM software releases. Entry of the SPC is not required.

OK

Note: New number set.

Note:

For RUIM software releases, this command provides a means for setting the phone number without the need to have previously entered the SPC (+WSPC command). The value for <number> can be up to 15 digits. The use of this command does not effect the IMSI.

Select Type of Address +CSTA

Description:

This command is used to select the type of phone address to use.

Values

:

Syntax:

<typex> type of address byte in integer format – only supports 129

Command syntax: AT+CSTA=<typex>

Command

AT+CSTA?

Note: Get type of address

AT+CSTA=?

Note: Get supported address types

Possible Responses

+CSTA: 129

Note: Local Number format

+CSTA: (129-129)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 18

Chapter 3 – General Commands

View Modem Timers +WTMR

Description: This command is used to read the modem’s accumulated internal timers. These timers include Uptime, Call

Time, Call Count, and Last Call Time. Uptime is the number of seconds the modem has been running since boot-up. Call Time is the total number of seconds the modem has been in a call since manufacture (Voice,

Data, OTASP, and CDMA Test Calls; but SMS is not included). Call count is the total number of calls made since manufacture. Last Call Time returns the time of the most recent call in seconds. It is not stored in NV and is initialized to zero on boot-up. The range of all returned timer items is 0 to 4294967295 (136 years).

Values: <Uptime> seconds since modem boot-up total call seconds since modem manufacture (excluding SMS)

<Call

<Last Call Time> time of the most recent call in seconds

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WTMR

Response syntax: +WTMR: <Uptime>,<Call Time>, <Call Count>, <Last Call Time>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WTMR

Note: Display modem timers

+WTMR: 1029, 45670,289, 85

OK

Note: Uptime = 1029 seconds

Call Time = 45670 seconds

Call Count = 289 calls

Last Call Time = 85 seconds

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 19

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Chapter 4 – Call Control

Commands

Dial Command D

Description:

The ATD command is used to originate a voice or data call. The dial command also controls supplementary services .

For

Note: ATD<nb> is followed by PPP negotiation. a

ATD<nb>; dialing string may only contain characters “0-9”,”#”,”*” only. Note that some countries may have specific numbering rules for their CDMA handset numbering.

The response to the ATD command is one of the following:

Description Verbose Result

Code

Numeric Code (with

ATV0 set)

OK 0

CONNECT <speed> 10,11,12,13,14,15

BUSY

NO ANSWER

NO CARRIER

NO DIALTONE

7

8

3

6

Direct Dial Syntax:

Command syntax: ATD<nb>[;]

Command

Command executed (voice)

If the call succeeds, for data calls only, <speed> takes the value negotiated by the product.

If the called party is already in communication,

If no hang up is detected after a fixed network time-out

Call setup failed or remote user release.

Voice call with missing “;”

ATD18005551212;

Note: Attempt a voice call.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command executed

+WORG:18005551212

Note: Voice call origination sent to Base Station with dial string “18005551212”.

ATD5551212;

Note: Example of a failed voice call attempt.

+WCNT: 9

Note: Call Connected, CDMA traffic channel established with service option 9. You can now hear audio of the calling party’s phone ringing. However, this event does not mean the other calling party has answered.

OK

Note: Command executed

+WORG:5551212

Note: Voice call origination sent to Base Station with dialing string “5551212”.

+WEND: 3

Note: Call Attempt failed/ended. Reason 3, signal faded.

Dialing from a phonebook entry (stored in the RUIM card or NV) can be performed with the following commands:

ATD><index>;

ATD>”Bill”;

Call <index> from the +CPBS selected phonebook.

Call “Bill” from the +CPBS selected phonebook.

ATD><mem><index>; <mem> is a +CPBS=? listed phonebook and <index> is a valid location within the phonebook

Note:

A semicolon must be used at the end of the AT command to signal phonebook dialing. Otherwise, the command will result in an error.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 20

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Phonebook Syntax:

Command syntax: ATD><index>[;]

ATD>[<mem>]<name>[;]

ATD>[<mem>]<index>[;]

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPBS?

Note: Which phonebook is selected.

ATD>5;

Note: Dial location #5 from ME phonebook.

+CPBS: ME,11,100

OK

Note: Command executed

OK

Note: Command executed

ATD>SM202;

Note: Dial location 202 from the SM(RUIM card) phonebook.

+WORG:5551212

Note: Voice call origination sent to Base Station with dialing string “5551212”.

+WEND: 3

Note: Call Attempt failed/ended. Reason 3, signal faded.

OK

Note: Command executed

+WORG:5551212

Note: Voice call origination sent to Base Station with dialing string “5551212”.

+WEND: 3

Note: Call Attempt failed/ended. Reason 3, signal faded.

ATD>”Bill”;

Note: This command is NOT valid for MC,

RC, and LD phonebooks as they are supported in CDMA networks

OK

Note: Command executed

+WORG:5551212

Note: When the FD facility is enabled, only the numbers in the FDN phonebook can be called. For example, if “014629” is present in the FD phonebook, the command ATD014629; will be successful. Data calls are not allowed when the FD facility is enabled.

Hang-Up Command H

Description:

The ATH (or ATH0) command is used by the application to disconnect the remote user. In the case of multiple calls, all calls are released (active, on-hold and waiting calls).

The specific ATH1 command has been appended to disconnect the current outgoing call, only in dialing or alerting state (i.e., ATH1 can be used only after the ATD command, and before its terminal response (OK,

NO CARRIER, ...). It can be useful in the case of multiple calls.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATH

Possible Responses

ATH

Note: Ask for disconnection

ATH1

Note: Ask for outgoing call disconnection

OK

+WEND: 10

Note: Every call, if any, is released

ERROR

+WEND: 10

Note: Outgoing call, if any, is released

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 21

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Answer a Call A

Description:

When the product receives a call, it sets the RingInd signal and sends the ASCII “RING” or “+CRING:

<type> ” string to the application (+CRING if the cellular result code +CRC is enabled). Then it waits for the application to accept the call with the ATA command.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATA

Possible Responses

RING

Note: Incoming call

ATA

Note: Answer to this incoming call

ATH

Note: Disconnect call

+WANS:0

+WCNT: 10

Note: Call accepted

OK

+WEND: 10

Note: Call disconnected

Remote Disconnection

Description:

A message is used by the product to inform the application that the remote user has released an active call.

The product sends +WEND: <result code> to the application. The DCD signal may be set based upon the

AT&C2 setting for packet calls. See Chapter 21,Unsolicited AT Result Codes, for more information on the

+WEND command.

Extended Error Report +CEER

Description:

This command gives the cause of any general call processing error or malfunction. See Chapter 20,

Extended Error Report .

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CEER

ATD18005551212;

Possible Responses

OK

ATD1234567;

Note: Outgoing voice call while already in a call

AT+CEER

AT+CEER

Note: Ask for reason of release

+WORG:18005551212

+WCNT:3

ERROR

Note: Call setup failure

+CEER: Error 2

OK

Note: Operation not allowed when call in progress

+CEER : Error <x>

OK

Note: <x>is the cause information element values

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 22

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

DTMF Signals +VTD, +VTS

+VTD

Description:

The product enables the user application to send DTMF tones over the CDMA network. This command is used to define tone duration (the default value is 0,0). To define this duration, the application uses:

AT+VTD=<on>,<off>.

Values: <on> on tone duration

0 95 milliseconds

1

150 milliseconds

2 200

3

250 milliseconds

4 300 milliseconds

5

350 milliseconds

<off> off tone duration

0

60 milliseconds

1 100 milliseconds

2

150 milliseconds

3 200 milliseconds

Syntax: Command syntax : AT+VTD=<on>,<off>

Command

AT+VTD=4,3

Note: To define 300 ms on tone duration and 200 ms off tone duration.

AT+VTD=?

Note: Display valid parameter ranges.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

+VTD: (0-5), (0-3)

OK

+VTS

Description: The product supports the ability of the user application to send burst DTMF tones over the CDMA network.

This command enables the transmission of burst DTMF tones. To transmit DTMF tones (only when there is an active call), the application uses: AT+VTS=<Tone> where <Tone> is in {0-9,*,#}.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+VTS=<Tone>

Command Possible Responses

AT+VTS=# OK

Note: Command valid

AT+VTS=11

AT+VTS=4

OK

OK

Informative To send tone sequence 13#, the application sends: AT+VTS=13#

DTMF Start and Stop Continuous +WSDT, +WSDS

Description:

Starts and stops a continuous DTMF tone while in a call state (conversation).

Values: <X>:

(0-9, #,*)

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WSDT=<X>

Possible Responses

AT+WSDT=2

AT+WSDS

OK

Starts DTMF tone

OK

Stops DTMF tone

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 23

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Redial Last Telephone Number DL

Description: This command is used by the application to redial the last number used in an ATD commanded voice call.

The ATDL command causes the last voice call number to be redialed. The phonebook is not referenced for the redial. Data call numbers are not supported by this command; only voice call numbers.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATDL

Possible Responses

ATDL

Note: Redial last number

OK

+WORG: 8585551212

Note: Last call was a voice call. Command valid

Automatic Dialing with DTR %Dn

Description:

This command enables and disables the automatic sending of the short message (SMS) stored in the first location. The number is dialed and then short message is sent when DTR OFF switches ON.

Values: <n> (0-2) Enable or disable automatic message transmission or number dialing.

Informs the product that the number is a voice rather than a data number.

Disables automatic DTR number dialing / message transmission.

AT%D1

Syntax: Command syntax: AT%D<n>

Command

AT%D2

Note: Activates DTR short message sending

Automatic Answer S0

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command has been executed

Description:

This S0 (zero) register parameter determines and controls the product automatic answering mode .

Values: <value> (0-255

)

0 No automatic answer.

1 – 255

Answers after the specified number of rings.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATS0=<value>

Possible Responses

ATS0=2

Note: Automatic answer after 2 rings

OK

ATS0?

Note: Current value

ATS0=0

Note: No automatic answer

Other

002

OK

Note: always 3 characters padded with zeros

OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 24

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Incoming Call Bearer +CICB

Description: This specific command is used to set the type of incoming calls when no incoming bearer is given (see

+CSNS). The setting the +CICB command affects the current value of +CSNS.

Values: <mode>

0 Data

2

Speech

3 Data once (10 minute timeout)

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CICB=<mode>

Command

AT+CICB=2

Note: If no incoming bearer, force a voice call

AT+CICB?

Note: Interrogate value

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command accepted

+CICB: 2

OK

Note: Default incoming bearer: voice call

AT+CICB=?

Note: Test command

+CICB: (0-4)

OK

Note: Speech, data default incoming bearer

Single Numbering Scheme +CSNS

Description: This command selects the bearer to be used when an MT single numbering scheme call is set up (see

+CICB, these commands are the same).

Note: The setting the +CSNS command affects the current value of +CICB.

Values: <mode>

0

Data

2 Speech

3

Data once (10 minute timeout)

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CSNS

Possible Responses

AT+CSNS=0

Note: Force a data call

AT+CSNS=2

Note: Force a voice call

AT+CSNS?

Note: Interrogate value

AT+CSNS=?

Note: Test command

OK

Note: Command accepted

OK

Note: Command accepted

+CSNS: 2

OK

Note: Default incoming bearer: voice call

+CSNS: (0-4)

OK

Note: Voice, data default incoming bearer

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 25

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Microphone Gain +VGT

Description: This command sets the microphone gain of the current audio path.

Values: <MicGain> value to Microphone relative gain:

AT+VGT Value Microphone Relative Gain Step (dB)

0 -2

1

2

3

+6

+8

+16

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+VGT=<MicGain>

Command Possible Responses

AT+VGT=2 OK

Note: Command valid

AT+VGT?

Note: Interrogate value

+VGT: 2

OK

Note: Current value

AT+VGT=?

Note: Test command

+VGT : (0-3)

OK

Note: Possible values

Volume Gain Control +VGR

Description: This command is used by the application to tune the receive gain of the speaker. If the modem is in the Idle state, it will generate an audible tone at the selected volume.

Values: <RGain> value to Speaker relative gain:

AT+VGR Value Speaker Relative Gain Step (dB)

0

1

Mute

-23

2

3

4

-17

-11

-5

Syntax: Command syntax : AT+VGR=<Rgain>

Command Possible Responses

AT+VGR=2 OK

Note: Command valid

AT+VGR?

Note: Interrogate value

+VGR: 2

OK

Note: Current value

AT+VGR=?

Note: Test command

+VGR : (0-4)

OK

Note: Possible values; default: 3

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 26

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Microphone Mute Control +CMUT

Description:

Values:

This command is used to mute the microphone input on the product (for the active microphone set with the

+SPEAKER command). This command is only allowed during a call.

<mode>

0 Microphone mute off (default).

1

Microphone mute on.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CMUT=<mode>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CMUT=?

Note: Test command

AT+CMUT?

Note: Ask for current value

AT+CMUT=1

Note: Mute ON (call active)

AT+CMUT?

Note: Ask for current value

AT+CMUT=0

Note: Mute OFF (call not active)

+CMUT : (0-1)

OK Note: Enable / disable mute

+CMUT : 0

OK Note: Current value is OFF

OK

Note: Command valid

+CMUT : 1

OK Note: Mute is active (call active)

+CME ERROR: 3

Note: Command not valid

Speaker & Microphone Selection +SPEAKER

Description: This command is used to select and activate a speaker/microphone audio path. The module provides two audio paths. An audio path is functional only with appropriate module external hardware.

Values: <ActiveSpkMic >

0 : HEADSET - Audio path corresponding to SPK_2/MIC_2.

1

: HANDSET - Audio path corresponding to SPK_1/MIC_1. (Default)

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+SPEAKER=<ActiveSpkMic>

Command Possible Responses

AT+SPEAKER=0

Note: Select HEADSET audio path.

AT+SPEAKER?

OK

Note: Command valid

+SPEAKER: 0

OK Note: HEADSET audio path active.

Echo Cancellation +ECHO

Description:

This command is used to enable, disable or configure the Echo Cancellation functions for voice calls (in rooms, in cars, etc.). The +SPEAKER function automatically sets echo cancellation based upon handset or headset choice and this command allows non-standard operation.

Values: <mode>

0 Vocoder Echo Cancellation Off

1

Ear Seal Echo Cancellation

2 Head Set Echo Cancellation

3

AEC

4 Speaker Echo Cancellation for car kit operation

5

Default Echo Cancellation for current path settings

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+ECHO= <mode>

Command

AT+ECHO?

Note: Read current settings

AT+ECHO=0

Note: Set Echo Cancellation Off

AT+ECHO=1

Note: Set Echo Cancellation to Ear Seal

AT+ECHO=2

Note: Set Echo Cancellation to Headset

AT+ECHO=4

Note: Set Echo Cancellation to Handset

Possible Responses

+ECHO: 0

OK

OK

OK

OK

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 27

Chapter 4 – Call Control Commands

Side Tone Modification +SIDET

Description:

This command is used to set the level of audio feedback in the speaker (microphone feedback in the speaker).

Values: <val1>

0

Sidetone is disabled

1 Sidetone is enabled

<val2>

0 No side tone

1

Handset Sidetone levels

2 Headset Sidetone levels

3

Max Sidetone level

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+SIDET=<val1>,<val2>

Command Possible Responses

AT+SIDET=1,0 OK

Note: Command valid

AT+SIDET?

Note: Current value

+SIDET: 1,0

OK

Note: Command valid

Initialize Voice Parameters +VIP

Description:

This command allows voice parameters to be restored from NV memory.

Values:

Gain controls are restored (+VGT and +VGR)

Voice path selection is restored (+SPEAKER)

Echo cancellation is restored (+ECHO)

Sidetone values are restored (+SIDET)

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+VIP

Possible Responses

AT+VIP OK

Note: Command valid

TTY Mode +WTTY

Description: This command enables TTY mode on the headset audio path. The modem must be in a voice call to set this command, and when the call ends it goes back to standard audio mode.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WTTY

Possible Responses

AT+WTTY OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 28

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands

Chapter 5 – Network Service

Commands

Signal Quality +CSQ

Description: This command is used to ascertain the received signal strength indication (<rssi>) and the channel frame error rate

(<fer>).

Note: See Chapter 24 for Sprint® specific version of this command .

Values: <rssi> The lowest value is 0 and the highest value is 31.

0 = 110dBm, 31 = -75dBm. 1.09375dBm per step.

Note: Certain models use a range other than 0 – 31.

10-31

0-9 Weak or insufficient

99

No signal.

<fer>

99 Not known or not detectable. Currently always returns 99.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CSQ

Command

AT+CSQ

Possible Responses

+CSQ: <rssi>,<fer>

OK

Note: <rssi> and <fer> as defined above

Mode Preference +COPS

Description: The Mode Preference of a CDMA modem governs the basic system acquisition behavior of the MS in conjunction with the PRL (Preferring Roaming List). It’s important to note that the PRL takes precedence over mode preference when guiding the phone to a band or system. The PRL must allow a particular band first, before the mode preference can take effect. In other words, a mode preference change is simply a request; the PRL decides whether or not to allow it. After execution of the +COPS command, an unsolicited

+COPS: <mode> will follow soon to confirm the new mode selection, but not in all cases. See Unsolicited

Result Codes in Chapter 21. All changes to +COPS are automatically saved in NV RAM.

Note 1

: AMPS selection is available only in modems that support AMPS mode.

Note 2: Refer to Chapter 20 for AT commands that are applicable to AMPS operation.

Note 3

: This command is not available in Sprint®. and Verizon. software versions. any other mode in RUIM software versions will result in an error return.

Values: The parameter values are the following ones:

<mode>

0 Automatic.

1

CDMA Only.

2 CDMA or AMPS only.

3

Analog only.

<term>

0

Permanent – this mode persists until another +COPS command is issued

1 Power cycle – this mode persists until power cycle is performed

Note:

AT+COPS by itself is a short-hand equivalent to AT+COPS=0,0.

Syntax on next page.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 29

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+COPS=<mode>,<term>

Command Possible Responses

AT+COPS?

Note: Ask for current Mode

Preference

+COPS: 0,0

OK

Note: Automatic mode, use PRL order, Permanent

AT+COPS=?

AT+COPS=0,0

Note: Ask for Automatic mode

AT+COPS=1,1

Note: Ask for CDMA Only mode

AT+COPS=2,0

Note: Ask for CDMA or AMPS only mode

AT+COPS=3,0

Note: Ask for Analog only mode

+COPS: (0-3),(0-1)

OK

Note: Modes: Automatic, CDMA Only, CDMA or AMPS only; Term: Permanent, Power Cycle.

OK

+COPS: 0,0

Note: Unsolicited +COPS result confirms Automatic mode, Permanent term is requested.

OK

+COPS: 1,1

Note: Unsolicited +COPS result confirms CDMA Only mode, Power Cycle term is requested.

OK

+COPS: 2,0

Note: Unsolicited +COPS result confirms CDMA or

AMPS only mode, Permanent term is requested.

OK

+COPS: 3,0

Note: Unsolicited +COPS result confirms Analog only mode, Permanent term is requested.

Band Preference +WBND

Description: The Band Preference of a CDMA modem governs the basic system acquisition behavior of the MS in conjunction with the mode preference (+COPS) and the PRL (Preferring Roaming List). It’s important to note that the PRL takes precedence over band preference when guiding the phone to a band. The PRL must allow a particular band first, before the band preference can take effect. In other words, a band preference change is simply a request; the PRL decides whether or not to allow it. If the setting is accepted by the MS, the value will be written to non-volatile RAM and persist after a power-cycle.

Note 1: This command is not available in Sprint® and Verizon software versions.

Note 2:

<band> 1 (PCS) is not available in RUIM software versions.

Values:

The parameter values are the following ones:

<band>

0

Any

1 PCS

2

Cellular A or B

3 Cellular A

4

Cellular B

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WBND=<band>

Possible Responses

AT+WBND?

Note: Ask for current Band Preference

AT+WBND=?

AT+WBND=0

Note: Allow Any Band

+WBND: 0

OK

Note: Any

+WBND: (0-4)

OK

Note: Any, PCS, Cell, Cell A, Cell B

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 30

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands

Roam Preference +WRMP

Description: The Roam Preference of a CDMA modem informs the MS whether it is allowed to roam on foreign CDMA networks or only allow operation on home networks. The determination of what is a foreign or home network is programmed into the PRL (Preferring Roaming List). This command simply enables or disables the capability of the MS to roam, based on the PRL configuration. If the setting is accepted by the MS, the value will be written to non-volatile RAM and persist after a power-cycle. After execution of the +WRMP command, the MS may change roaming states. The unsolicited result +WROM: <mode> will indicate the new state.

See Unsolicited Result Codes in Chapter 21.

Note

: This command is not available in Sprint® and Verizon software versions.

Values:

The parameter values are the following ones:

<mode>

0

Home Networks only, as defined in the PRL (default value)

1 Roaming on Affiliated networks, as defined in the PRL

2

Roaming on Any Network, as defined in the PRL. syntax:

Command

AT+WRMP=<mode>

AT+WRMP?

Note: Ask for current Mode Preference

AT+WRMP=?

AT+WRMP=0

Note: Allow Home only networks

AT+WRMP=1

Note: Allow Roaming Affiliated Networks

AT+WRMP=2

Note: Allow Roaming on Any Network

Possible Responses

+WRMP: 0

OK Note: Home only

+WRMP: (0-2)

OK Note: Home, Affiliated, Any

OK

+WROM: 0 Note: Unsolicited +WROM may or may not appear based on current circumstances

OK

+WROM: 1 Note: Unsolicited +WROM may or may not appear based on current circumstances

OK

+WRMP: 2 Note: Unsolicited +WROM may or may not appear based on current circumstances

Network Registration & Roaming +CREG

Description:

This command is used by the application to ascertain the registration and roaming status of the product.

Note: Also see +WROM unsolicited response for CDMA roaming status.

Values: <mode>

0

Disable network registration unsolicited result code (default)

1

Enable network registration unsolicited code result code +CREG: <stat>

<stat>

0 not registered, MS is not currently searching for a new operator.

1 registered, home network.

2 not registered, MS currently searching for a base station.

4 unknown.

5 registered, roaming

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CREG= <mode>

Response syntax: +CREG: <mode>, <stat>

Command

AT+CREG=0

Note: Disable network registration unsolicited result code.

AT+CREG=1

Note: Enable network registration unsolicited result code

Possible Responses

+CREG: 0,1

OK Note: Command valid

+CREG: 1,1

OK Note: Command valid

1,5

OK Note: Unsolicited enabled,

MS currently roaming.

AT+CREG=? +CREG: (0-1)

OK Note: 0,1 <mode> values are supported

Note: Example of the unsolicited result code. MS is searching for a base station.

+CREG: 2

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 31

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands

Change NAM Selection +WNAM

Description:

This command is used to request a change in the NAM (Number Assignment Modem ) selection. The modem supports up to 4 NAMs. However, if a NAM is not fully programmed, the modem will not switch to the requested NAM. The default NAM for the modem is 1. The response to this command is only OK, and is no guarantee that the NAM will change. If the NAM selection request is accepted, the unsolicited command

+WNAM: <nam> will be returned. If or when the actual NAM changes, the unsolicited command +WCNM:

<nam> will be returned. See Unsolicited Result Codes in Chapter 21.

Values: <nam>

1

NAM 1

2 NAM 2

3

NAM 3

4 NAM 4

5

Auto NAM

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WNAM=<nam>

Possible Responses

AT+WNAM=2

Note: Use NAM 2, if programmed

AT+WNAM=3

Note: Use NAM 3, if programmed

AT+WNAM=5

Note: Try Auto NAM

OK

+WNAM: 2

+WCNM: 2

OK

Note: No unsolicited response indicates that NAM 3 is not valid, thus no change in NAM.

OK

+WNAM: 5

+WCNM: 1

Note: Auto NAM is selected, NAM 1 chosen.

AT+WNAM=? +WNAM: (1-5)

Read Current NAM +WCNM

Description:

This command is used to read the current NAM (Number Assignment Modem). The modem supports up to 4

NAMs. Also, note that there exists an unsolicited response +WCNM: <nam> that is returned any time the

NAM changes. See Unsolicited Result Codes in Chapter 21.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WCNM

Possible Responses

AT+WCNM

Note: Ask for the current NAM

+WCNM: 1

OK

Note: NAM 1 in use

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 32

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands

Emergency Mode +WSOS

Description:

In the event of an emergency call, the modem will automatically put itself into emergency mode. After the call has ended and/or emergency mode is no longer desired, this command must be sent to exit the modem out of emergency mode.

Note: Changing the mode preference using +COPS while emergency mode is in effect will exit the modem out of Emergency Mode.

Note : For RUIM capable modems, the emergency numbers 110, 112, 119, and 120 are also supported by the modem software in addition to 911.

Values:

The parameters values are the following ones:

<flag>

0

Exit Emergency Mode

1 Manually enter Emergency Mode (not supported)

Note:

AT+WSOS by itself is a short-hand equivalent to AT+WSOS=0.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WSOS=<flag>

Possible Responses

AT+WSOS?

Note: Ask for current Emergency Mode status

AT+WSOS=?

AT+WSOS

Note: Exit Emergency Mode.

Note2: This is the same as AT+WSOS=0

+WSOS: 1

OK

+WSOS: (0-0)

OK

OK

+WSOS:0

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms Emergency

Mode exit

AT+WSOS=0

Note: Exit Emergency Mode.

AT+WSOS=1

Note: Try to manually enter Emergency Mode.

This is not allowed.

ATD911;

Note: Emergency Mode entered as the result of an emergency call

AT+COPS=0,0

Note: Changing the mode preference while in

Emergency Mode, will result in Emergency

Mode being exited

OK

+WSOS:0

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms Emergency

Mode exit

ERROR

Note: This is not allowed. Emergency Mode will only be entered as a result of an emergency call

+WSOS: 1

+WORG: 911

+WSOS: 0

+COPS: 0,0

Note: An unsolicited response for both +WSOS and

+COPS are returned when mode preference is changed while in Emergency Mode.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 33

Chapter 5 – Network Service Commands

Extended Roam Indication +WRMW

Description:

This command is used to suppress output of non-standard Extended Roam Indicators (64 through 127) that are displayed by the +WROM unsolicited response. This setting is written to NV and is persistent across resets.

Note: This command is not available in Sprint® and Verizon® software versions.

Values: <value>

0

Suppress output of ERI indicators 64 through 127.

1 Enable output of ERI indicators 64 through 127.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WRMW=<value>

Possible Responses

AT+WRMW=?

AT+WRMW?

Note: Display current setting.

AT+WRMW=1

Note: Enable output of ERI 64 through 127.

+WRMW: (0-1)

OK

+WRMW: 0

OK

Note: ERI 64 through 127 suppressed.

OK

AT+WRMW?

Note: Display current setting.

+WRMW: 1

OK

Note: ERI 64 through 127 displayed.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 34

Chapter 6 – SIM Card Operational Commands

Chapter 6 – SIM Card

Operational Commands

This section details the commands that are available when a SIM card is present. These commands are available only in

RUIM software versions.

Note that the PIN codes used in this section are for example purposes only and do not reflect the actual PIN codes programmed into the modem. Contact your service provider to obtain the actual PIN codes used by your modem.

Enter PIN +CPIN

Description:

This command is used to enter the ME (Mobile Equipment) passwords (CHV1 / CHV2 / PUK1 / PUK2, etc.), that are required before any ME functionality can be used. CHV1/CHV2 must be 4 to 8 digits long,

PUK1/PUK2 must be 8 digits long. The application is responsible for checking the PIN after each reset or power on if the PIN was enabled.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CPIN=<pin>

Possible Responses

AT+CPIN=1234 OK

Note: PIN code is correct

After 3 unsuccessful attempts to enter the PIN (Personal Identification Number), the PUK (Personal

Unblocking Key) will be required. PUK validation forces the user to enter a new PIN code as a second parameter and this will be the new PIN code if PUK validation succeeds. CHV1 is then enabled if PUK1 is correct. The application therefore uses this command:

Command syntax:

AT+CPIN=<PUK>,<NewPin>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPIN=00000000,1234

Note: Enter PUK and new PIN

AT+CPIN=12345678,1234

Note: Enter PUK and new PIN, 2nd attempt

+CME ERROR: 16

Note: Incorrect PUK

OK

Note: PUK correct, new PIN stored

To ascertain which code must be entered (or not), the following query command can be used: AT+CPIN?

The possible responses are:

+CPIN: READY

+CPIN: UIM PIN

+CPIN: UIM PUK

+CPIN: UIM PIN2

+CPIN: UIM PUK2

+CPIN: PH-UIM PIN

+CPIN: PH-NET PIN

+CME ERROR: <err>

ME is not pending for any password

CHV1 is required

PUK1 is required

CHV2 is required

PUK2 is required

UIM lock (phone-to-UIM) is required

Network personalization is required

SIM failure (13) absent (10) etc.

Note: that in this case the mobile equipment does not end its response with the OK string. The response

‘+CME ERROR: 13’ (SIM failure) is returned after 10 unsuccessful PUK attempts. The SIM card is then out of order and must be replaced by a new one.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 35

Chapter 6 – SIM Card Operational Commands

Enter PIN2 +CPIN2

Description:

This command is used to validate the PIN2 code (CHV2), or to validate the PUK2 code (UNBLOCK CHV2) and to define a new PIN2 code. Of course, the +CPIN command allows PIN2 or PUK2 codes to be validated, but only when the last command executed resulted in PIN2 authentication failure. PIN2 length is between 4 and 8 digits. The PUK2 length must be 8 digits.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CPIN2=<pin2>

Possible Responses

AT+CPIN2=1234 OK

Note: PIN2 code is correct

After 3 unsuccessful attempts, PUK2 will then be required. PUK2 validation forces the user to enter a new

PIN2 code as a second parameter and this will be the new PIN2 code if PUK1 validation succeeds. The application therefore uses this command:

Command syntax: AT+CPIN2=<puk2>,<NewPin2>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPIN2=00000000,1234

Note: Enter PUK2 and new PIN2

+CME ERROR: 16

Note: Incorrect PUK2

AT+CPIN2=12345678,1234

Note: Enter PUK2 and new PIN2, 2nd attempt

OK

Note: PUK2 correct, new PIN2 stored

To ascertain which code must be entered (or not), the following query command can also be used:

AT+CPIN2?

The possible responses are:

+CPIN: READY

+CPIN: UIM PIN2

ME is not pending for any password

CHV2 is required

+CPIN: UIM PUK2 PUK2 is required

+CME ERROR: <err> SIM failure (13) absent (10) etc.

The product requires that the PIN2 code be successfully entered in order to write a entry into the Fix Dialing

Phonebook (FDN).

Command Possible Responses

OK AT+CPBS=”FD”

Note: Select Phonebook FDN

AT+CPBW=5,”12345678”,145”test1”

Note: Write entry 5 in the FDN

AT+CPIN2=1234

Note: Enter PIN2

AT+CPBW=5,”12345678”,145”test1”

Note: Write entry 5 in the FDN

+CME ERROR: 17

Note: PIN2 not yet entered

OK

Note: PIN2 successfully entered

OK

Note: Command now successful

PIN Remaining Attempt Number +CPINC

Description:

This command is used to get the number of valid attempts for PIN1 (CHV1), PIN2 (CHV2), PUK1

(UNBLOCK CHV1) and PUK2 (UNBLOCK CHV2) identifiers.

Values: <n1>, <n2> are the attempts left for PIN1, PIN2 (0 = blocked, 3 max)

<k1>,

For this to work, the card should be present at the time of initialization. Otherwise, an error will be sent

(+CME ERROR: 10).

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CPINC

Response syntax: +CPINC: <n1>,<n2>,<k1>,<k2>

AT+CPINC

Note: Get the number of attempts left

Possible Responses

+CPINC: 2,3,10,10

OK

Note: First CHV1 attempt was a failure

AT+CPINC?

Note: Get the number of attempts left

+CPINC: 2,3,10,10

OK

Note: First CHV1 attempt was a failure

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 36

Chapter 6 – SIM Card Operational Commands

Facility Lock +CLCK

Description

: This command is used by the application to lock, unlock or interrogate an ME or network facility <fac>. The call barring facilities “A0” and “AI” require that a password value be included in the command even though passwords are not currently enforced for these facilities. The “SC” and “FD” facilities are available only in builds, which include UIM support.

This command is also used for the control of the call barring supplementary service. Functions for the barring of data and voice calls is provided as well as querying the status of call barring. Note that emergency voice calls cannot be barred.

Values: <fac>

“SC” SIM PIN enabled (<mode> = 1) / disabled (<mode> = 0)

“FD”

SIM FDN feature enabled (<mode> = 1) / disabled (<mode> = 0)

“AO” BAOC; Barr Outgoing Calls

“AI”

BAIC; Barr Incoming Calls

<mode>

0

Unlock the facility (<passwd> required)

1

Lock the facility (<passwd> required)

2 Query status

<passwd>

Use PIN1 for the “SC” facility

Use PIN2 for the “FD” facility

Use any four digit value for the “AO” and “AI” facilities

Syntax: (for Facility Lock):

Command syntax:

AT+CLCK= <fac>,<mode>[,<passwd>]

Response syntax: +CLCK: <status>

Command

AT+CLCK=”SC”,1,1234

Note: Enable SIM PIN

AT+CLCK?

Note: Get current facility lock status

Possible Responses

OK

Note: SIM PIN enabled

+CLCK:(“SC”,1),(“FD”,0),(“AO”,1),(“AI”,1)

OK

Note: SIM PIN is enabled, SIM FDN feature is disabled,

Outgoing call barring is enabled, Incoming call barring is enabled

AT+CLCK=”SC”,0,5555

Note: Disable SIM PIN

AT+CLCK=”AO”,1,1234

Note: Bar Outgoing Calls

AT+CLCK=”AI”,1,1234

Note: Bar Incoming Calls

AT+CLCK=”AO”,2

Note: Query outgoing call barring status

+CME ERROR: 16

Note: Incorrect password used

OK

Note: Outgoing calls are barred

OK

Note: Incoming calls are barred

+CLCK: 1

OK

Note: Outgoing calls are barred

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 37

Chapter 6 – SIM Card Operational Commands

Change Password +CPWD

Description:

This command is used by the application to change a password, PIN1or PIN2. The “SC” and “P2” facilities are available only in builds, which include UIM support.

Values: <fac>

“SC”

PIN1

“P2” 7.6.2

<oldpwd>

Current PIN1 or PIN2 password

<newpwd>

Desired PIN1 or PIN2 password

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CPWD= <fac>, <oldpwd>, <newpwd>

Possible Responses

AT+CPWD=”SC”,1234,5555

Note: Change UIM PIN1

AT+CPWD=”SC”,1234,5555

Note: Change UIM PIN1

AT+CPWD?

Note: Get status

OK

Note: PIN1 now 5555

+CME ERROR: 16

Note: PIN incorrect

+CPWD:(“SC”,8),(“P2”,8)

OK

Note: PIN1 & PIN2 passwords are supported with 8 digit maximum

Card Identification +CCID

Description: This command is used to display the SIM card ESN. The data is output in hexadecimal format. If there is no

ESN present on the SIM card, only the OK portion of the message will be output.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CCID

Possible Responses

AT+CCID

Note: Get card ID

AT+CCID?

Note: Get current value

AT+CCID=?

Note: Get possible value

+CCID: C3729F82

Note: ESN is presented in hexadecimal format.

+CCID: C3729F82

Note: Same result as +CCID

OK

Note: No parameter but this command is valid.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 38

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Chapter 7 – Short Messages

Commands

For SMS messages, in the CDMA system, the PDU mode will not be supported; instead, the UCS-2 Unicode format message is supported. The UCS-2 Unicode header code will start at 0x80 and above.

Parameters Definition

<cbn>

<da>

<dcs>

<dt>

<encod>

Call Back Number

Destination Address

Data Coding Scheme, coded like in document [5].

Discharge Time in string format :

“yy/mm/dd,hh :mm :ss”(Year [00-99], Month [01-12],

Day [01-31], Hour, Minute, Second

Encoding

<fo>

<index>

<lang>

<length>

<mem1>

<mem2>

<mid>

<mr>

First Octet, coded like SMS-SUBMIT first octet in document [4], default value is 17 for SMS-SUBMIT

Place of storage in memory.

Language

Length of SMS User Data field.

Memory used to list, read and delete messages (+CMGL, +CMGR and +CMGD).

Memory used to write and send messages (+CMGW, +CMSS).

CBM Message Identifier.

Message Reference.

Originator Address.

<oa>

<pid>

<priority>

<ra>

Protocol Identifier.

Message Priority

Recipient Address.

Service Center Address

<sca>

<scts> Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/mm/dd,hh :mm :ss”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds)

<sn>

<st>

<stat>

<tooa>

<tora>

<tosca>

<total1>

<total2>

<ts>

<used1>

<used2>

<vp>

CBM Serial Number

Status of a SMS-STATUS-REPORT

Status of message in memory.

Type-of-Address of <oa>.

Type-of-Address of <ra>.

Type-of-Address of <sca>.

Number of message locations in <mem1>.

Number of messages locations in <mem2.

Timestamp for MT SMS.

Total number of messages locations in <mem1>.

Total number of messages locations in <mem2.

Validity Period of the short message, default value is 167

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 39

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Select Message Service +CSMS

Description: This command is used to display the supported SMS services. The supported services are originated (SMS-

MO) and terminated short message (SMS-MT) + Cell Broadcast Message (SMS-CB) services.

Values: <MO>

0 Mobile Originated SMS not supported.

1

Mobile Originated SMS supported.

<MT>

0

Mobile Terminated SMS not supported.

1 Mobile Terminated SMS supported.

<CB>

0 Broadcast SMS not supported.

1

Broadcast SMS supported.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CSMS?

Possible Responses

AT+CSMS?

Note: Display current values

+CSMS: <MO>,<MT>,<CB>

OK

Note: SMS-MO, SMS-MT and SMS-CB support

New Message Acknowledgement +CNMA

Description:

This command allows reception of a new message routed directly to the TE to be acknowledged.

In TEXT mode, only positive acknowledgement to the network (RP-ACK) is possible.

Note: This AT command is not designed for input of the command into the HyperTerminal by hand since the acknowledgement will not be quick enough to be received by the network. However, it is possible for the client system to automatically send this command when the +CNMI is set to “2,2,0,0,0”.

Syntax:

Acknowledge with +CNMA is possible only when a +CMT or +CDS indication is shown (see +CNMI command).

Command syntax: AT+CNMA

Command

AT+CNMI=2,2,0,0,0

Possible Responses

OK

+CMT:”8587351530”,”02/04/03,11

:38”,129,7,0<CR><LF>

Testing

Note: Message received

AT+CNMA

Note: Acknowledge the message received

AT+CNMA

Note: Try to acknowledge again

OK

Note: Send positive acknowledgement to the network

+CMS ERROR : 340

Note: No +CNMA acknowledgment expected

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 40

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Preferred Message Storage +CPMS

Description: This command allows the message storage area to be selected (for reading, writing, etc). The total storage area size is: 30 for “MT”, “MO”, “BC” and 10 for “SR”. For RUIM software loads, these sizes vary and are dependent on the configuration of the SIM card .

Values: <mem1> Memory area to be used to list, read and delete messages. It can be:

“MT”

SMS Mobile Terminated message storage in NV (default)

“BC” CBM message storage in NV.

“SR”

Status Report message storage in NV.

Each reported memory area includes information about the current used and total storage locations.

<used>

the number of used storage locations in the reported area.

<total> the total number of available storage locations.

When <mem1> is selected, all following +CMGL, +CMGR and +CMGD commands are related to the type of

SMS stored in this memory.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CPMS=<mem1>,<used>,<total>,[<mem2>,<used>,<total>]

Possible Responses

AT+CPMS=?

Note: Display available message storage areas.

+CPMS: (“MT”,”BC”,”SR”),(“MO”)

OK

Note: Read, list, delete: SMS, CBM or SMS Status Report. Write, send: SMS

+CPMS: “MT”,3,30,”MO”,3,30

OK

AT+CPMS?

Note: Display currently selected area information.

AT+CPMS=”AM”

Note: Select invalid message storage area.

AT+CPMS=”BC”

Note: Select CBM message storage

+CMS ERROR: 302

+CPMS: 2,30,3,30

OK

Note: Read, list, delete CBM from NV RAM

Show Text Mode Parameters +CSDH

Description:

This command gives additional information on text mode result codes. This information is given in brackets in the +CMTI, +CMT, +CDS, +CMGR, +CMGL commands. This setting currently cannot be changed.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CSDH

Possible Responses

AT+CSDH?

Note: Current value

+CSDH: 0

OK

Note: Do not show header values

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 41

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

New Message Indication +CNMI

Description: This command selects the procedure for message reception from the network.

Values <mode>

The <mode> value controls the processing of unsolicited result codes. Only mode 2 is supported at this time. The other mode values are accepted and return OK but the processing of unsolicited result codes will be the same as with mode value 2.

0

Buffer unsolicited result codes in the TA. If the TA result code buffer is full, indications can be buffered in some other place or the oldest indications may be discarded and replaced with the new received indications

1 Discard indication and reject new received message unsolicited result codes when TA-TE link is reserved. Otherwise forward them directly to the TE

2 Buffer unsolicited result codes in the TA when TA-TE link is reserved and flush them to the TE after reservation. Otherwise forward them directly to the TE

3 Forward unsolicited result codes directly to the TE. TA-TE link specific in band used to embed result codes and data when TA is in on-line data mode

Syntax:

<mt> Sets the result code indication routing for SMS-DELIVERs. Default is 1.

0

No SMS-DELIVER indications are routed.

1 SMS-DELIVERs are routed using unsolicited code: +CMTI: “MT”, <index>

2

or 3 SMS-DELIVERs (except class 2 messages) are routed using unsolicited code: +CMT: <oa>,

<scts>, <tooa>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority>[,<cbn>],<length><CR><LF><data> (text mode)

<bm>

Sets the result code indication routing for received Cell Broadcast Messages. Default is 1.

0

1

No CBM indications are routed to the TE. The CBMs are stored.

The CBM is stored and an indication of the memory location is routed to the customer application using unsolicited result code: +CBMI: “BC”, <index>

2 or 3 New CBMs are routed directly to the TE using unsolicited result code (format matches that of

+CBM: <oa>, [<alpha>,] <scts> [,<tooa>, <length>] <CR><LF><data> (text mode)

<ds> sets the routing for SMS-STATUS-REPORTs. Default is 1.

0

No SMS-STATUS-REPORTs are routed.

1 SMS-STATUS-REPORTs are routed using unsolicited code: +CDS: <fo>, <mr>, [<ra>] , [<tora>],

<scts>, <dt>, <st> (Text mode)

2 SMS-STATUS-REPORTs are stored and routed using the unsolicited result ode: +CDSI: “SR”,

<index>

<bfr> Default is 0.

0

TA buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is flushed to the TE when <mode>

1…3 is entered (OK response shall be given before flushing the codes)

1

TA buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is cleared when <mode> 1…3 is entered.

Command syntax: AT+CNMI=<mode>,<mt>,<bm>,<ds>,<bfr>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CNMI=2,1,0,0,0

Note: <mt>=1

OK

AT+CMTI : “MT”,1

Note: message received

OK AT+CNMI=2,2,0,0,0

Note: <mt>=2

+CMT : “8585551212”,”98/10/01,12 :30

00”,129,1,2,0,5<CR><LF>

Hello

Note: message received

OK AT+CNMI=2,0,0,1,0

Note: <ds>=1

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”<CR>

Message to send <ctrl-Z>

Note: Send a message in text mode

+CMGS : 7

OK

Note: Successful transmission

+CDS : 2, 116, ”8585551212”, 129, “98/10/01,12 :30 :07”,

“98/10/01 12 :30 :08”, 32768

Note: message was correctly delivered

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 42

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Read Message +CMGR

Description

: This command allows the application to read stored messages. The messages are read from the memory selected by +CPMS command. A message read with status “REC UNREAD” will be updated in memory with the status “REC READ”.

Values: <stat>

Status of message in memory. <stat> parameter for SMS Status Reports is always “READ”.

Text Mode Possible Values Status of Messages in Memory

“UREAD”

“READ”

“USENT” received unread messages received read messages stored unsent messages

“SENT”

“ALL” stored sent messages all messages

Note:

For SMS Status Reports, only “ALL” and “READ” values of the <stat> parameter will list messages; other values will only return OK.

<oa/da> Origination/destination address value in string format.

<mr>

: Message Reference

<scts> : Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

<dt> Discharge Time in string format: “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz” (Year [00-99], Month [01-12], Day

[01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour] )

<st>

<lang>

Status of a SMS-STATUS-REPORT

Language (network specific)

<encod> Encoding (network specific)

<priority> priority:

0 Normal

1

Interactive

2 Urgent

<cbn>

3 Emergency

Call Back Number

<length> Length of the text message (in bytes).

<data> text

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CMGR=<index>

Response syntax: +CMGR: <stat> [,<oa>], <scts>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority>[,<cbn>], <length>

<CR><LF> <data> (for SMS-DELIVER only)

+CMGR: <stat> [,<da>], <dt>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority>[,<cbn>], <length> <CR><LF> <data> (for SMS-

SUBMIT only)

+CMGR: <stat>,<mr>,<scts>,<dt>,<st> (for SMS-STATUS-REPORT only)

Command

AT+CMGR=1

Note: Read the message

Possible Responses

+CMTI: “MT”,1 Note: New message received

+CMGR: “REC UNREAD”,”8585551212”, ”98/10/01,18 :22

:11+00”,1,2,0,”8585550000”,9<CR><LF>

ABCdefGHI

OK

AT+CMGR=1

Note: Read the message again

AT+CMGR=2

Note: Read at a wrong index

AT+CPMS=”SR”;+CNMI=,,,2

Reset to text mode, set read memory to

“SR”, and allow storage of further SMS

Status Report into “SR” memory

+CMGR: “REC READ”,”8585551212”, ”98/10/01,18 :22

:11”,1,2,0,”8585550000”,9<CR><LF>

ABCdefGHI

OK Note: Message is read now

+CMS ERROR: 321

Note: Error : invalid index

+CPMS:0,10,0,10

OK

AT+CMSS=3

Send an SMS previously stored

+CMSS: 160

OK

“SR”,1

New SMS Status Report stored in “SR” memory at index 1

AT+CMGR=1

Read the SMS Status Report

+CMGR: “READ”,160,

“8585551212”,129,”01/05/31,15:15:09”,

“01/05/31,15:15:09”,0

OK

Note: For the RUIM software edition using some SIM cards, the maximum supported message text length is 99 characters. Longer message texts will be truncated to 99 characters.

The maximum message text length for all other software editions is 160 characters.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 43

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

List Message +CMGL

Description:

This command allows the application to read stored messages, by indicating the type of the message to read. The messages are read from the memory selected by the +CPMS command .

Values: <index> Place of storage in memory.

<stat>

Text Mode Possible Values

“UREAD”

“READ”

“USENT”

Status of Messages in Memory received unread messages received read messages stored unsent messages

“SENT”

“ALL” stored sent messages all messages

Note:

For SMS Status Reports, only “ALL” and “READ” values of the <stat> parameter will list messages; other values will only return OK.

<oa/da>

<fo>

Origination/destination address value in string format.

First Octet, coded like SMS-SUBMIT first octet in document [4], default value is 17 for SMS-

<mr>

SUBMIT

Reference

<dt>

<st>

<lang>

Discharge Time in string format: “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz” (Year [00-99], Month [01-12], Day

[01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour] )

Status of a SMS-STATUS-REPORT

Language

<encod> Encoding

<length>

Length of the text message (in bytes).

<data> Message text

Syntax: Command syntax : AT+CMGL=<stat>

Response syntax:

+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<da/oa>,<lang>, <encod>,<length><CR><LF><data> (for

SMS-DELIVER and SMS-SUBMIT

, may be followed by other <CR><LF>+CMGL:<index>…)

+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<fo>,<mr>,<scts>,<dt>,<st> (for SMS-STATUS-REPORT only, may be followed by other <CR><LF>+CMGL:<index>…)

Command

AT+CMGL=“UREAD”

Note: List unread messages in text mode

AT+CMGL=”READ”

Note: List read messages in text mode

AT+CMGL=”SENT”

Note: List stored and sent messages in text mode

Possible Responses

+CMGL: 1,”REC UNREAD”,”8585551212”,1,2,15

<CR><LF>Unread message!

+CMGL: 3,”REC UNREAD”, “8585551212”, 1,2,5<CR><LF>Hello

OK

Another message unread!

Note: 2 messages are unread, these messages will then have their status changed to “REC READ” (+CSDH:0)

+CMGL: 2,”REC READ”,”8585551212”,1,2,9<CR><LF>

Keep cool

OK

OK

Note: No message found

Note: For the RUIM software edition using some SIM cards, the maximum supported message text length is 99 characters. Longer message texts will be truncated to 99 characters.

The maximum message text length for all other software editions is 160 characters.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 44

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Send Message +CMGS

Description:

This command is used to send a SMS message. This is a two line command. The first line includes the command and its associated parameters. The second line of this command is the SMS message content. A message terminator character <term> is specified as the last character of the message text and servers to initiate message transmission or abort the +CMGS command.

Note: If the “FD” facility is enabled, only the <da> entries in the FDN phonebook can be sent.

Syntax: Command AT+CMGS=<da> [,<length>] [,<priority>] [,<privacy>] [,<reply>] [,<cbn>] <cr><message text> [<term>]

Command Possible responses

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”<cr>

Please call me soon, Fred. <ctrl-Z>

Note: Send a message

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”,2,1,1”5550000”<cr>

Please call ASAP<ctrl-Z>

Note: Send a message with the specified priority, privacy, reply option and call back number. Note that the <length> parameter is omitted.

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”,19<cr>

<ESC>Call me at 5551212

Note: Send a nineteen byte message that includes the <ESC> character.

AT+CMGS="8585551212"<cr> <Unicode message><0x00 0x1A>

Note: Unicode message. Two byte Unicode message <ctrl-Z> terminator.

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

Note: Message reference output.

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

Note: Message reference output.

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

Note: Message reference output.

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

Note: Message reference output.

Values: <da> Destination address value; ASCII digit character phone number.

<length>

Length of the text message (in bytes). If specified, the message is automatically sent when this number of message bytes have been entered. Terminator characters that are part of the message text are ignored. If not specified, a message terminator character <term> must be used.

<priority> The priority level of the message.

0

(default)

1 Interactive

2

Urgent

3 Emergency

<privacy> The privacy level of the message.

0

Not restricted (default)

1 Restricted

2

Confidential

3 Secret

<reply> The reply options for the message.

0

No acknowledge requested (default)

1

Positive user acknowledge request

2

Delivery acknowledge request

3

Request both user acknowledge and delivery acknowledge

<cbn>

<cr>

The call back number; ASCII digit character phone number.

Required first line terminator; ASCII carriage return character (0x0d).

<message text>

Message text; ASCII or UCS2 Unicode formatted. See section 20.11 for more information on Unicode formatting.

<term> Message terminator. Ignored if <length> is specified.

ASCII message:

<ctrl Z> (0x1A) to send the message

<ESC> (0x1B) to abort the message

Unicode message:

0x00 0x1A to send the message

0x00 0x1B to abort the message

Note: For the RUIM software edition using some SIM cards, the maximum supported message text length is 99 characters.

Longer message texts will be truncated to 99 characters when read.

The maximum message text length for all other software editions is 160 characters.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 45

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Write Message to Memory +CMGW

Description: This command stores a message in memory (SMS-SUBMIT). The memory location <index> is returned (no choice possible as with phonebooks +CPBW). A text or Unicode message is entered as described for the

Send Message +CMGS command.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CMGW=<da> [,<length>] [,<priority>] [,<privacy>] [,<reply>] [,<cbn>] <cr><message text> [<term>]

Response syntax:

+CMGW: <index> or +CMS ERROR: <err> if writing fails

Command

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”<cr>

Hello how are you ?<ctrl-Z>

Note: Write a message

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”,19<cr>

<ESC>Call me at 5551212

Note: Write a nineteen byte message that includes the

<ESC> character.

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”,2,1,1”5550000”<cr>

Please call ASAP<ctrl-Z>

Note: Write message with the specified priority, privacy, reply option and call back number. Note that the

<length> parameter is omitted.

Possible responses

+CMGW: 4

OK

Note: Message stored in index 4

+CMGW: 5

OK

Note: Message stored in index 5

+CMGW: 6

OK

Note: Message stored in index 6

Values: <da>

Destination address value; ASCII digit character phone number.

<length> Length of the text message (in bytes). If specified, the message is automatically sent when this number of message bytes have been entered. Terminator characters that are part of the message text are ignored. If not specified, a message terminator character <term> must be used.

<priority>

The priority level of the message.

0 Normal

1

Interactive

2 Urgent

3

Emergency

<privacy>

The privacy level of the message.

0 Not restricted (default)

1

Restricted

2 Confidential

3

Secret

<reply>

The reply options for the message.

0

No acknowledge requested (default)

1

Positive user acknowledge request

2

Delivery acknowledge request

3 Request both user acknowledge and delivery acknowledge

<cbn>

<cr>

The call back number; ASCII digit character phone number.

Required first line terminator; ASCII carriage return character (0x0d).

<message text> Message text; ASCII or UCS2 Unicode formatted. See section 20.11 for more information on Unicode formatting.

<term>

Message terminator. Ignored if <length> is specified.

ASCII message:

<ctrl Z> (0x1A) to send the message

<ESC> (0x1B) to abort the message

Unicode message:

0x00 0x1A to send the message

0x00 0x1B to abort the message

Note:

For the RUIM software edition using some SIM cards, the maximum supported message text length is 99 characters.

Longer message texts will be truncated to 99 characters when read.

The maximum message text length for all other software editions is 160 characters.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 46

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Send Message From Storage +CMSS

Description:

This command sends a message stored at location value <index>.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CMSS=<index>[,<da> [,<toda>] ]

Response syntax: +CMSS: <mr> or +CMS ERROR: <err> if sending fails

If a new recipient address <da> is given, it will be used instead of the one stored with the message.

Command

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”<CR>

Today is my birthday <CTRL-Z>

Note: Store message in phonebook.

AT+CMSS=5,8582221212

Note: Send message 5 to a destination number

AT+CMSS=5,8583331212

Note: Send message 5 to a different destination number

Possible Responses

+CMGW : 5

OK

Note: Message stored with index 5

+CMSS: 1

OK

Note: Successful transmission. One SMS message sent since power up.

+CMSS: 2

OK

Note: Successful transmission. Two SMS messages sent since power up.

For response mode, <mr> is the number of SMS messages that have been sent since power up. The maximum count is 65,535 messages.

Note:

If the “FD” facility is enabled, only the <da> entries in the FDN phonebook can be set.

Delete Message +CMGD

Description:

This command is used to delete one or several messages from preferred message storage.

Values: <index>

0-9

When the preferred message storage is “BC”. Integer type values in the range of location numbers of

Message memory when the preferred message storage is “MT” or “SR”.

<DelFlag>

0 Delete message at location <index>

1 Delete All READ messages

2 Delete All READ and SENT messages

3 Delete All READ, SENT and UNSENT messages

4 Delete All messages.

Note

: When the preferred message storage is “SR”, as SMS status reports are assumed to have a “READ” status, if <DelFlag> is greater than 0, all SMS status reports will be deleted.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CMGD=<Index> [,<DelFlag>]

Command Possible Responses

+CMTI:”MT”,3

Note: New message received

AT+CMGR=3

Note: Read it

+CMGR: “REC UNREAD”,”8585551212”,

“98/10/01,18 :19 :20”,1,2,0,17 <CR><LF>

AT+CMGD=3

Note: Delete it

Message received!

OK

Note: Unread message received from 8585551212 on the 01/10/1998 at 18H19m 20s

OK

Note: Message deleted

AT+CMGD=1,0 OK

Note: The message from the preferred message storage at the location 1 is deleted

AT+CMGD=1,1 OK

Note: All READ messages from the preferred message storage are deleted

AT+CMGD=1,2 +CMS ERROR:321

Note: NV Error deleting READ messages and SENT (no messages to delete)

AT+CMGD=1,3 OK

Note: All READ, SENT and UNSENT messages are deleted

AT+CMGD=1,4 OK

Note: All messages are deleted

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 47

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Select Broadcast Messages +CSCB

Description:

This command turns on/off the reception of Broadcast SMS messages.

Values: <bm>

The parameter of +CNMI command controls the indication of an incoming BC SMS message .

<mode>

0

Activates reception of BC SMS.

1 Turns off reception of BC SMS. Emergency BC SMS will be received in this mode.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CSCB=<mode>

Command

AT+CSCB=0

Note: Turn on reception of BC SMS

Possible Responses

OK

Note: BC SMS can be received

+CBMI: “BC”,5

Note: A BC SMS was received, and stored in slot 5

AT+CSCB=1

Note: Turn off reception of BC SMS

OK

Note: Only Emergency BC SMS can be received.

Reception of all other BC SMS will be stopped.

Message Status Modification +WMSC

Description : This command is used to change the status of one message from preferred message storage.

Values: <loc> Location number of the stored message (integer)

<status>

Text Mode

“UREAD”

“READ”

“USENT”

“SENT”

Possible Responses:

OK

+CMS ERROR: 341

Location is valid and has been changed

Non-volatile memory error

+CMS ERROR: 321

+CMS ERROR: 302

Invalid index (out of range or no SMS stored) if attempting to change Status Report SMS or if syntax is incorrect

Note:

Status of SENT or USENT indicate changing MO memory SMS. Status of READ or UREAD implies using preferred memory. Changes are not accepted when preferred memory is set to Status Report (all status reports are always assumed to be READ and cannot be changed).

Syntax

:

Command syntax:

AT+WMSC= <loc>, <status>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WMSC=4,”UREAD”

AT+WMSC=8,”USENT”

OK

Note: Message stored in preferred memory index 4 status changed to NOT READ

+CMS ERROR: 321

Note: Invalid index, no message at location 8 of MO memory

AT+CPMS=”SR”

Note: Change preferred memory to

Status Report

AT+WMSC=0,”UREAD”

+CPMS:1,10,4,10

OK

+CMS ERROR: 302

Note: Cannot change Status Report messages

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 48

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Message Overwriting +WMGO

Description: The +CMGW command writes an SMS to the first location available. To write an SMS to a specified location, the +WMGO command forces the product to write an SMS (with the +CMGW command) to the location specified with +WMGO, but for just one +CMGW command.

Values:

Syntax:

<loc>

Location number of the record to write or overwrite

Command syntax:

AT+WMGO= <loc>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WMGO=0

AT+WMGO=30

OK

Note: Next MSG write will be to index 0

+CMS ERROR: 302

Note: Invalid index (out of range)

On the next AT+CMGW command, the record number used will be the one specified by the AT+WMGO command. The location is forgotten and, in order to perform a second overwrite, +WMGO has to be used again.

If the external application specifies a free location, and if an incoming message is received before the

AT+CMGW command, the product may store the incoming message at a location available. This could be the one specified by +WMGO (the product does not prevent from this). If the user then issues an

AT+CMGW command without changing the AT+WMGO location, the new message will be overwritten!

Note : that this location number is not kept over a software reset.

Change SMS Status +WUSS

Description:

The +WUSS command enables or disables a change of the SMS message status following a +CMGR or

+CMGL command.

Values: <mode>

0

The SMS Status will change.

1 The SMS Status will not change.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WUSS = <mode>

Possible Responses

AT+WUSS=1 OK

AT+WUSS=0 OK

Note: If lower layer failure, +CMS ERROR: 513

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 49

Chapter 7 – Short Messages Commands

Set SMS Compose Language and Encoding +WSCL

Description:

The +WSCL command sets the SMS composition language and encoding types. When composing a message (+CMGS, +CMGW), the SMS language and encoding fields will be set using the current +WSCL value.

Values: <lang>

0 Unspecified

1

English

2 French

3

Spanish

4 Japanese

5

Korean

6 Chinese

7

Hebrew

<enc>

0

Octet (or Unspecified)

1

IS91EP

2 ASCII

3

IA5

4 USC-2 UNICODE

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WSCL = <lang>, <encod>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WSCL=1,2 OK

Note: Set language to English, encoding to ASCII

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”<CR>

Hello how are you ?<ctrl-Z>

Note: Write a message in English

AT+WSCL=6,4

+CMGW: 4

OK

Note: Message stored in index 4

OK

Note: Set language to Chinese, encoding to

UNICODE

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”<CR>

Ãû×Ö<ctrl-Z>

Note: Send a message in Chinese

+CMGS: <mr>

OK

Note: Message sent

Set Timestamp of MT SMS +WSTM

Description:

The +WSTM command sets the timestamp that will be used when the modem receives a Mobile Terminated

SMS. When a new MT SMS message is received the setting of this command determines if the timestamp that was received with the message is kept, or modem’s CDMA time, which represents the actual time of message arrival is used. When choosing to use modem’s CDMA time, the command gives the option of using local or GMT time.

Values: <ts>

0

Original Time Stamp of the received MT SMS

1 Time of arrival – GMT Time

2

Time of arrival – Local Time

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WSTM = <ts>

Possible Responses

AT+WSTM=2 OK

Note: Set MT SMS timestamp to time of arrival (local time zone)

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 50

Chapter 8 – Supplementary Services Commands

Chapter 8 – Supplementary

Services Commands

Supplementary Service commands are specialized call processing commands used to control carrier features on the modem such as caller ID, call forwarding, call waiting, 3-way calls, and specialized CDMA test calls.

Call Forwarding +CCFC

Description:

This command allows control of the call forwarding supplementary service, if supported by the carrier. All calls will be forwarded unconditionally to the phone number specified. The modem will make a brief call to the CDMA network using an ATD specified prefix number (country and carrier specific) to setup or cancel call forwarding. An audio tone will be produced in the audio path to confirm the change of the call forwarding state.

Values: <number>

The phone number to forward all calls to.

Note 1:

Country and carrier specific call forwarding services (e.g. *68, *72, etc.) may also be available to the host application in addition to the modem provided +CCFC functionality. The host application can utilize these enhanced services for call forwarding with the modem ATD command (e.g. ATD*72).

Note 2:

If the “FD” facility is enabled, only the entries in the FDN phonebook can be forwarded.

Syntax: Command syntax

: AT+CCFC= <number>

Command Possible Responses

ATD*72

Note: Specify the call forwarding prefix number.

AT+CCFC=8585551212

Note: Register to an unconditional call forwarding.

AT+CCFC=0

Note: Cancel unconditional call forwarding

OK

Note: Prefix number set.

OK

+WORG:*728585551212

+WCNT:3

Note: Call forwarding active for all incoming calls to phone number 858-555-1212

OK

+WORG:*720

+WCNT:3

Note: Call forwarding cancelled.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 51

Chapter 8 – Supplementary Services Commands

Calling Line Identification Restriction +CLIR

Description:

This command allows control of the outgoing caller ID restriction supplementary service.

Values: <mode>

Sets the caller ID restriction for outgoing calls

0 Outgoing Caller ID works normally, according to the subscription of the Caller ID service.

1

Outgoing Caller ID is restricted. The called party will see ‘Restricted’ on their Caller ID display.

Note: This command works by automatically pre-pending a *67 to the outgoing dialing string. Thus, this command will only work on CDMA networks that recognize a *67 to suppress outgoing caller ID. Also, the original dialing string cannot be longer than 29 characters in length.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CLIR=<mode>

Command

AT+CLIR=1

Note: Restrict outgoing caller ID.

AT+CLIR?

Note: Ask for current functionality

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

+CLIR :<mode>

OK

Note: <mode> as defined below

Calling Line Identification Presentation +CLIP

Description:

This command allows control of the incoming caller ID presentation supplementary service. When presentation of the CLI (Calling Line Identification) is enabled (and the carrier allows), +CLIP response is returned after the RING unsolicited result code. By default, +CLIP is enabled.

Values: <mode> This parameter enable or disables the caller ID unsolicited command

0

Disable

1 Enable

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CLIP=<mode>

Command

AT+CLIP=1

Note: Enable CLIP

Possible Responses

OK

Note: CLIP is enabled

AT+CLIP?

Note: Ask for current functionality

+CLIP:<mode>

OK

Note: <mode> defined as below

RING

AT+CLIP=0

Note: Disable CLIP presentation

Note: Incoming call

+CLIP: “8585551212”,129

Note: Incoming call with number presentation

OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 52

Chapter 8 – Supplementary Services Commands

Send Flash to Base Station +WFSH

Description: This command sends a flash or flash with information to the base station. The flash command is used to manage call waiting and 3-way calls. For call waiting situations when the 3 party call is received, send a flash (AT+WFSH) to toggle between the two different call parties. The +WFSH unsolicited AT command will be returned if a flash was sent to the base station over the air. Note that on CDMA networks, this does not guarantee that an actual switch between calls took place, because there is no acknowledgement to the modem. For 3-way calls, initiate the first call to party # 1 (see ATD). Then send a flash with information

(AT+WFSH=18005551212) to initiate a call to party # 2, party # 1 will automatically be placed on hold. The

“information” is the phone number of party # 2. Once a conversation with party # 2 is established, send a regular flash (AT+WFSH) to connect all 3 parties. Send another flash (AT+WFSH) to disconnect party # 2, or End call (see ATH) to end the call with all parties.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WFSH

Command syntax AT+WFSH= < phone_number > (for a flash with information)

Unsolicited result syntax:

+WFSH (confirms a flash was sent to the base station)

Command

ATD8585551212;

Note: Make a voice call

AT+WFSH

Note: Send a flash to the Base Station (toggle to the second call).

Note: Conversation with second call.

AT+WFSH

Note: Send a flash to the Base Station (toggle to the first call).

ATH

Note: Release the all calls

ATD858551212

Note: Make a voice call

AT+WFSH=6195552121

Note: Place first call on hold, connect to second party.

AT+WFSH

Note: Connect all 3 parties.

AT+WFSH

ATH

Possible Responses

OK

+WORG:8585551212

+WCNT:3 Note: Conversation…

+CCWA:”8582701234”,129

Note: Indication of another incoming call

OK

+WFSH

Note: Flash sent to the Base Station. Call to the second call. However, this is not 100% guaranteed because there is no confirmation from the Base Station.

OK +WFSH

Note: Flash sent to the Base Station. Call switches to the first call. However, this is not

100% guaranteed because there is no confirmation from the Base Station.

OK

+WEND:10

Note: All Calls End

OK

+WORG:858551212

+WCNT:3

Note: Conversation...

OK

+WFSH

Note Modem now places first call on hold and attempts connection to second call.

OK

+WFSH

Note: All 3 parties now connected.

OK

+WFSH

Note: Disconnect second party, connected to first party only.

OK

+WEND:10

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 53

Chapter 8 – Supplementary Services Commands

List Current Call State +CLCC

Description:

This command is used to return the current call state of the modem.

Note that when dormant mode is active, a “no call” status will be returned even though a data call may still be in progress.

Values: <state>

(state of the call):

0 no call

1 traffic

2 dialing (MO call)

3 incoming (MT call)

(teleservice) :

0 voice

1 data

3 sms

4 otasp

5 markov or loopback

9 unknown or not applicable

Syntax:

<termination>

0 unknown or not applicable

1 mobile terminated (MT) call

2 mobile originated (MO) call

Command syntax:

AT+CLCC

+CLCC: <state>, <mode>, <termination>

Command

AT+CLCC

Possible Responses

+CLCC: 0,9,0

Note: Seek current phone state OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 54

Chapter 9 – Data Commands

Chapter 9 – Data Commands

Using AT Commands During a Data Connection

To use AT Commands during a data connection (e.g. while the product is in online mode), it is necessary either to switch to offline mode, or to use the +WMUX command to enable Commands / Data multiplexing.

Note: currently the +WMUX command is not supported yet.

Switch From Online to Offline Mode +++

During a circuit data call, the “+++” command can be used to suspend the data call and switch from online mode to offline mode. The “OK” response is returned when the modem has completed the transition to offline mode and is ready to accept AT commands.

Note: The “+++” sequence only works with the +ICF command using the following settings:

• 8 data bits, with no parity

• 7 data bits, with even parity

Switch From Offline to Online Mode

See the ATO command description.

Select Mode +FCLASS

Description: This command puts the product into a particular operating.

Values: <n>

0

Data

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+FCLASS= <n>

AT+FCLASS=?

Note: Test command

AT+FCLASS=0

Note: Data mode requested

AT+FCLASS?

Note: Current value

Possible Responses

+FCLASS: 0

OK

Note: fax not supported

OK

Note: Command valid

+FCLASS: 0

OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 55

Chapter 9 – Data Commands

Cellular Result Codes +CRC

Description: This command gives more detailed ring information for an incoming call. Instead of the string “RING”, an extended string is used to indicate which type of call is ringing (e.g. +CRING:VOICE).

These extended indications are:

+CRING:VOICE

RING ASYNC

+CRING:OTAPA

+CRING:TEST

+CRING:UNKNOWN for normal voice calls for all types of data calls for OTAPA calls for markov, loopback, and test calls for unknown/undefined calls types

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CRC

Possible Responses

AT+CRC=0

Note: Extended reports disabled

AT+CRC=1

Note: Extended reports enabled

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

DTE-DCE Local Rate Reporting +ILRR

Description: This command controls whether or not the extended-format “+ILRR:<rate>” information text is transmitted from the DCE to the DTE. Currently the product only supports 0 = OFF.

Values: <value>

Decimal number corresponding to the selected option. Currently, only 0 is supported (disables reporting of local port rate).

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+ILRR=<value>

Possible Responses

AT+ILRR=0

Note: Local port rate report disabled

OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 56

Chapter 9 – Data Commands

V.42 bis Data Compression +DS

Description:

This command enables or disables V.42bis data compression if this feature is provided on the PSTN in the

IWF.

Values: Four numeric sub-parameters are accepted:

<dir> specifies the desired direction(s) of operation of the data compression function; from the DTE point of view. Default is 3.

0

Negotiated … no compression

1 Transmit only

2

Receive only

3 Both directions, accept any direction

<neg> specifies whether or not the DCE should continue to operate if the desired result is not obtained.

Default is 0

0

Do not disconnect if V.42 bis is not negotiated by the remote DCE as specified in <dir>

1

Disconnect if V.42 bis is not negotiated by the remote DCE as specified in <dir>

<P1>

512-4096

Specifies the maximum number of dictionary entries that should be negotiated.

Default is 4096 .

<P2>

6-250 Specifies the maximum string length to be negotiated. Default is 250.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+DS=<dir>,<neg>,<P1>,<P2>

Command Possible Responses

AT+DS=3,0,4096,250

Note: Set new parameters

OK

Note: Command valid

AT+DS?

Note: Current values

+DS: 3,0,4096,250

OK

Note: Command valid

V.42 bis Data Compression Report +DR

Description:

This command returns the results of data compression capability. If data reporting is enabled, this command returns the data compression type of an incoming or outgoing data call. Otherwise, the command returns

NONE.

The intermediate result code represents current DCE-DCE data compression type. The syntax for +DR reporting is: +DR<result>, and the result code is defined as follows:

+DR: NONE

+DR: V42B

+DR: V42B RD

+DR: V42B TD

Data compression is not in use

Rec. V.42 bis is in use in both directions

Rec. V.42 bis is in use in receive direction only

Rec. V.42 bis is in use in transmit direction only

The +DR intermediate result code, if enabled, is issued before the final result code, before the +ILRR intermediate report and after the service report control +CR.

Values:

This syntax is for setting the +DR reporting method.

<val>

0

Disable reporting

1 Enable reporting

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+DR=<val>

Command

AT+DR=1

Note: Reporting enabled

AT+DR?

Note: Display the current value

AT+DR=?

Note: Display the supported values

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

+DR: 1

OK

Note: Command valid

+DR: (0,1)

OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 57

Chapter 10 – V24-V25 Commands

Chapter 10 – V.24-V.25

Commands

Refer to ITU-T Recommendation V.25 specifications if you desire more details about the following commands.

Fixed DTE Rate +IPR

Description:

Syntax:

This command is used to specify the baud rate for the module DATA port. The factory default value is

115200. When autobaud is specified (AT+IPR=0), the module sets the DATA port operating baud rate to the detected DTE baud rate. The AT&F command restores the baud rate value that was active when the last

AT&W command was used.

Note:

The use of baud rates below 9600 may affect the operability of some module software features; e.g.,

TCP App.

Command syntax: AT+IPR

Command

AT+IPR?

Note: Read syntax.

AT+IPR=?

Note: List of supported <rate> values,[(list of fixed-only <rate> values)]

AT+IPR=38400

Note: Disable autobaud and set rate to 38400 bps

Possible Responses

+IPR: 9600

OK

Note: Current rate is 9600 bps

+IPR: (0,1200,2400,4800,9600,19200), (45,50,75,

110,150,300,600,38400,57600,115200,230400)

OK Note: Possible value (

*

)

OK

AT+IPR=0 Note: Enable autobaud OK

(*) The first list of values are the baud rates that are detectable by the module autobaud feature. The second list of values are the module DATA port supported baud rates .

DTE-DCE Character Framing +ICF

Description: This command is used to specify the UART start-stop (asynchronous) character framing for the module

DATA port. The factory default value is 3,3. The AT&F command restores the value that was active when the last AT&W command was used.

Values: <format>

0

Autodetect (Not supported)

1 8 Data 2 Stop (Not supported)

2

8 Data 1 Parity 1 Stop (Not supported)

3

8 Data 1 Stop

4

7 Data 2 Stop

(Supported)

(Not Supported)

5

7 Data 1 Parity 1 Stop (Not Supported)

6 7 Data 1 Stop

<parity>

(Not Supported)

0 Odd

1

Even

2 Mark

3

None

(Supported)

(Supported)

(Supported)

(Supported)

Note:

The supported format values are software release specific. Use the +ICF=? command to display the valid format values for the software release in use.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+ICF= <format>, <parity>

Command Possible Responses

AT+ICF=3,3

Note: Set values.

OK

Note: New values set

AT+ICF?

Note: Display current settings.

+ICF: 3,3

OK

Note: Current values

AT+ICF=?

Note: Display valid parameter ranges.

+ICF: (3-5),(0-3)

OK

Note: Possible values

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 58

Chapter 10 – V24-V25 Commands

DTE-DCE Local Flow Control +IFC

Description:

This command is used to specify the module DATA port flow control method. The factory default values are

2,2. The AT&F command restores the value that was active when the last AT&W command was used.

Values: <Tx>

0

None Transmit data flow control disabled.

1 XON/XOFF Remove Xon (0x19) and Xoff (0x17) characters from data stream.

2

Hardware Use RTS (Request To Send) signal (default)

3 XON/XOFF Leave Xon (0x19) and Xoff (0x17) characters in data stream.

<Rx>

0 None Receive data flow control disabled.

1

XON/XOFF Remove Xon (0x19) and Xoff (0x17) characters from data stream.

2 Hardware Use CTS (Clear To Send) signal (default)

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+IFC=<Tx>,<Rx>

Command

AT+IFC=?

Note: Display valid parameter ranges.

AT+IFC?

Note: Display current settings.

AT+IFC=3

Note: Set Tx flow control to XON/XOFF.

AT+IFC=,1

Note: Set Rx flow control to XON/XOFF.

AT+IFC?

Note: Display current settings.

AT+IFC=2,2

Note: Set Tx and Rx flow control to hardware.

Possible Responses

+IFC: (0-3),(0-2)

OK

Note: Valid parameter ranges

+IFC: 2,2

OK

Note: Default values are 2,2 (hardware flow control).

OK

Note: New Tx flow control value set.

OK

Note: New Rx flow control value set.

+IFC: 3,1

OK

Note: Settings displayed.

OK

Note: New Tx and Rx flow control values set.

Set DCD Signal &C

Description: This command is used to specify the behavior of the Data Carrier Detect (DCD) signal on the module DATA port. The factory default value is 2. The AT&F command restores the value that was active when the last

AT&W command was used.

Values:

<n>

Syntax:

The DCD signal is always asserted.

1

The DCD signal is asserted in a call and de-asserted when not in a call.

2 The DCD signal is always asserted except at the end of a call. At the end of a call, the DCD signal is de-asserted for 1 second. Default is 2

Command syntax:

AT&C<n>

Command

AT&C0

Note: DCD always on

AT&C1

Note: DCD matches the true state of the call.

AT&C2

Note: Wink DCD signal on call disconnect

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 59

Chapter 10 – V24-V25 Commands

Set DTR Signal &D

Description:

This command controls the interpretation of the Data Terminal Ready (DTR) signal on the module DATA port. The factory default value is 2. The AT&F command restores the value that was active when the last

AT&W command was used .

Values: <n>

0 The DTR signal is ignored.

1

Enter online command state following ON-to-OFF transition of circuit 108/2

2 Enter command state following ON-to-OFF transition of circuit 108/2.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT&D<n>

Command

AT&D0

Note: The DTR signal is ignored

AT&D1

Note: Enter online command state following ON-to-OFF transition of circuit 108/2

AT&D2

Note: Enter command state following ON-to-OFF transition of circuit 108/2

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

Set DSR Signal &S

Description:

This commands controls the Data Set Ready (DSR) signal on the module DATA port.

Values: <n>

0 The DSR signal is always on. (Default)

1

The DSR signal is always off.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT&S<n>

Command

AT&S0

Note: The DSR signal always on.

AT&S1

Note: The DSR signal is always off.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

OK

Note: Command valid

Back to Online Mode O

Description: If a data call is active and the MS is in command mode (+++ command issued; data call suspended), the

ATO command causes the module to exit command mode and resume online data mode.

Values: <n>

0 Result codes returned. (Default)

1

Result codes suppressed.

Syntax: Command syntax:

ATO

Command

ATO

Note: Return to online mode from offline mode

ATO

Note: Return to online mode from offline mode

Possible Responses

OK

NO CARRIER

Note: Not in a call

Result Code Suppression Q

Description: This command is used to control the suppression of AT command result codes.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATQ <n>

ATQ0

Note: Result codes are returned

ATQ1

Note: Result codes are suppressed

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command valid

(none)

Note: No response

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 60

Chapter 10 – V24-V25 Commands

DCE Response Format V

Description:

This command is used to specify the result code format. Refer to section 21 for a list of result codes.

Numeric result codes are only available for Hayes standard AT commands. All other AT command results are returned in word format. Result codes, both word and numeric, can be suppressed by the ATQ command.

Unsolicited responses are not affected by the ATV command and will always be displayed in word format as documented . The unsolicited response +RING is not affected by the ATV command. The +RING response can be formatted by the +CRC command.

Values: <n>

0

Numeric result codes

1 Word result codes. (default)

Syntax: Command syntax: ATV<n>

Command

ATV0

Note: Display result codes as numbers

ATV1

Note: Display result codes as words (Default)

Audio Loopback &T

Possible Responses

0

Note: Command is valid (0 means OK)

OK

Note: Command valid

Description:

This command is used to perform audio loop back of the current audio path. This command can be used to validate the audio loop. This is a standard Hayes

®

modem AT command.

Values: <num>

0 Not defined; returns OK.

1

Audio loopback on for current path.

2 Audio loopback is off.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT&T<num>

Command Possible Responses

AT&T1 OK

Note: Audio loopback is on.

AT&T2 OK

Note: Audio loopback is off.

Echo E

Description:

This command is used to determine whether or not the modem echoes characters received by an external application (DTE). This is a standard Hayes

®

modem AT command.

Syntax: Command syntax: ATE

Command

ATE0

Note: Characters are not echoed

ATE1

Note: Characters are echoed

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Done

OK

Note: Done

Display Configuration &V

Description:

This command is used to display the modem configuration. It lists all the commands supported by the modem and their possible parameters. This is a standard Hayes

®

modem AT command.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT&V

Command Possible Responses

AT&V

Note: Display the active parameter settings

&C: 2; &D: 2; …

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 61

Chapter 10 – V24-V25 Commands

Request Identification Information I

Description:

This command causes the product to transmit one or more lines of information from the DCE.

Values: <num>

0 Manufacturer data

1

Not used

2 Not used

3

Software revision data

4 Not used

5

Configuration data

6 Capability data

7

Not used

Note:

Syntax:

For the data returned by the ATI6 command, the use of the IS-707 +GCAP command is preferred.

Command syntax:

ATI<num>

Command

ATI0

Note: Display manufacturer data

ATI3

Note: Display software revision data

ATI6

Note: Display capability data

Possible Responses

MODEM

800 1900

OK

S/W VER: WISMOQ …

OK

+CGSM, +CIS707, …

OK

Restore Factory Setting &F

Description:

This command is used to restore the factory setting from NV memory. See Chapter 19. This command will reset the modem as the very last part of its operation.

Note: There is a remote chance of NVRAM corruption of a modem reset or power loss occurs during the processing of this command. This command should be used only during initial setup of the modem’s operating characteristics.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT&F

Command Possible Responses

AT&F OK

Note: Command valid, modem resets

Save Configuration &W

Description:

This command writes the current configuration to NV. See table in Chapter 19 for a list of items.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT&W

Command Possible Responses

AT&W OK

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 62

Chapter 11 – Phone Book Commands

Chapter 11 – Phone Book

Commands

In this chapter, the AT commands are used to operate on mobile phonebook. These phonebook commands adhere to the set defined in GSM 07.07 specification. Please refer to GSM 07.07 for further AT command usage and description.

For all phonebook read commands (+CPBR, +CPBF, +CPBP), the TON/NPI MSB of each number is set to 1 (ex: a TON/NPI stored as 17 is displayed as 145).

When accessing numbers in the call history phonebooks (“LD”, “MC”, or “RC”), if a matching number is found in one of the other phonebooks, the text portion of the matching entry is copied to the call history entry.

The phone book “SM” is only supported in an RUIM capable modem.

When an RUIM is present, the “MT” phonebook is a combination of two phonebooks as shown in the example below. This must be taken into account when using a phone book AT command index to access an entry in this phonebook.

ME Æ Index range 1 to 100

SM Æ Index range 1 to 150 (SIM card)

MT Æ ME start at 1, SM start at 101 (SIM card)

< - - - - - - - ME - - - - - - -> < - - - - - - - SM - - - - - - - - ->

1 100 101 250

Select Phonebook Memory Storage +CPBS

Description:

This command selects the type of memory where the phonebook will be stored. Possible phone books are listed below under the <bk> section. If there’s no RUIM card present, selecting “SM” phonebook returns

ERROR.

Values:

Syntax:

<bk>

“SM” ADN (RUIM phonebook)

“ME”

ME (ME NV phonebook)

“LD” LND (ME or RUIM last dialed phonebook; depending on presence of RUIM)

“EN”

EN (ME NV emergency numbers)

“MC” MSD (ME missed calls list)

“MT”

MT (combined ME and RUIM phonebook)

“RC” LIC (ME received calls list)

“FD”

FDN (SIM Fix Dialing, restricted phonebook)

Command syntax:

AT+CPBS=”<bk>”

Command

AT+CPBS=?

Note: Possible values, not all may be supported

AT+CPBS=”EN”

Note: Select the emergency phonebook

AT+CPBS?

Note: Return the currently selected phonebook

AT+CPBS=”MT”

Note: Select the MT phonebook (RUIM present).

AT+CPBS?

Possible responses

+CPBS: EN,0,9

OK

+CPBS: (“ME”,”MC”,”LD”,”RC”,”EN”)

Note: Not all may be supported

OK

Note: Emergency phonebook selected

Note: EN phonebook selected, 0 locations used, 9 available

OK

Note: MT phonebook selected

+CPBS: MT,5,300

Note: Display MT phonebook information. Combination of ME and SM phonebooks.

OK

Note: 5 locations used, 300 available (combination of ME and RUIM phonebooks).

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 63

Chapter 11 – Phone Book Commands

Return Selected Phonebook Locations +CPBU

Description: This command returns information about the currently selected phonebook. This includes the starting entry location, the total number of locations, maximum length of the phone number, the TON/NPI value range, and the maximum number of characters for the text portion of each entry.

The format of the returned data for the “MT” phonebook is different. It is a combination of the “ME” and “SM” phonebooks with values that describe each.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CPBU?

Command

AT+CPBS=”ME”

Note: Select the ME phonebook.

AT+CPBU?

Note: Display ME phonebook information.

AT+CPBS=”MT”

Note: Select the MT phonebook.

AT+CPBU?

Note: Display MT phonebook information.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: ME phonebook selected

+CPBU: (1 –100),32,(0-255),12

OK

Note: 100 locations starting at 1, 32 digits maximum, TON/NPI value range is 0-255, and 12 characters for the text.

OK

Note: MT phonebook selected

+CPBU: (1-100,101-180),(32,20),(0-255),(12,12)

OK

Note: 100 locations starting at 1 for the ME phonebook, 80 locations starting at 101 for the SM phonebook, 32 digits maximum for the ME phonebook and 20 digits maximum for the SM phonebook, TON/NPI value range is 0-255, and 12 characters for the text in both the ME and SM phonebooks.

Find Phonebook Entries +CPBF

Description:

This command returns the first ten phonebook entries with alphanumeric fields starting with a given string.

The user can use a string that is more exact to ensure that the entry they are looking for is found. The string search is case sensitive.

Note:

Syntax:

When the “MT” phonebook is selected, the find operation searches the “ME” portion first followed by the

“SM” portion. The returned values may be a combination of entries from both the “ME” and “SM” phonebooks.

This command is functional for the “ME”, “EN”, “SM”, and “MT” phonebooks only.

Command syntax:

Command

AT+CPBF=”TES”

AT+CPBF=”string”

AT+CPBF=”NEXT”

Note: Find entries that start with “NEXT”

Possible Responses

+CPBF: 1,”6195551212”,145,”test1”

OK

Note: Displays location starting with “TES”

+CME ERROR: 22

Note: Entry not found

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 64

Chapter 11 – Phone Book Commands

Write Phonebook Entry +CPBW

Description: This command writes a phonebook entry to location <index> in the current phonebook selected with the

+CPBS command.

Values:

Note:

If the “MT” phonebook is selected, <index> is in the range of the combined “ME” and “SM” phonebooks.

When using auto address mode (<index> not specified in the command), the “ME” phonebook is accessed first for an available location. If a location is not available in the “ME” phonebook, the “SM” phonebook is accessed.

The +WSPC command must be issued with a valid SPC code value before entries in the “EN” phonebook can be changed.

<index>

<text string>

Integer type value depending on the capacity of the currently selected phonebook.

<phoneNumber> Phone number is in ASCII format. Valid characters are 0-9 and *, #, -.

<TON/NPI>

Type of address in integer form. The MSB of this will always be set high.

Text string or Unicode formatted record.

PIN2 verification is required to do this command on the FDN. If the PIN2 authentication has been performed during the current session, the +CPBW command with FDN is allowed.

Command Possible Responses

OK AT+CPBS=”FD”

Note: Select FDN phonebook

AT+CPBW=5,”8585551212”,145,”test”

Note: Write in FDN at location 5

+CME ERRO: 17

Note: PIN2 is required

AT+CPIN2?

AT+CPIN2=1234

Note: Example PIN2 entered

AT+CPBW=5,”8585551212”,145,”test”

Note: Write in FDN at location 5

RUIM PIN2

Note: SIM PIN2 is required

OK

Note: PIN2 successfully entered

OK

Note: Write in FDN successful

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CPBW=<index>,”<phoneNumber>”,<TON/NPI number>,”<text string>”

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPBW=1,”6195551212”,145,”test1”

Note: Write location 1. Message cannot begin with the characters ‘80’, ‘81’, or ‘82’ (Unicode message record

OK

Note: Data stored in location 1. identifiers).

AT+CPBW=5,”6195551212”,145,”8000410042”

Note: Write location 5 using Unicode format for the <text string>; character input mode.

OK

Note: Data stored in location 5.

AT+CPBW=5,”6195551212”,145,”<bytes>”

Note: Write location 5 using Unicode format for <bytes>; binary input mode. Message cannot contain byte values

0x00 (null) or 0x22 (“); message truncation will result.

OK

Note: Data stored in location 5.

AT+CPBW=6,”6195551234”,145,”80xyz”

Note: Write location 6.

OK

Note: Data stored in location 6. The string

“80xyz” is invalid UCS2 format and is interpreted as a non-Unicode string.

OK AT+CPBW=2

Note: Erase location 2

AT+CPBW=1,”8585551212”,145,”test1”

Note: Location 1 overwritten

AT+CPBW=80,”8585551212”,145,”test80

Note: Error left off trailing quotes

AT+CPBW=,”8585551212”,145,”test”

Note: Write to the first open location

AT+CPBW=,”8585551212”,145,”FullBook”

Note: Phonebook is full

AT+CPBW=,”8585551212”,145,”Text is too long for this ”

Note: Write string to the first open location.

OK

ERROR

OK

+CME ERROR: 20

Note: Phonebook full

+CME ERROR: 24

Note: Text string exceeds the maximum character length

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 65

Chapter 11 – Phone Book Commands

Phonebook Read +CPBR

Description:

This command returns phonebook entries from a range of locations from the currently selected phonebook.

When the “MT” phonebook is selected, a request for the range 95 through 105 will return locations 95 through 100 of the “ME” phonebook and locations 1 through 5 of the “SM” phonebook (“MT” phonebook locations 101 through 105).

Note:

Syntax:

There are only 9 entries total in the Emergency Numbers phonebook (1 – 9).

Command syntax:

AT+CPBR=<first>[,last]

Command

AT+CPBR=1

Note: Read entry 1

AT+CPBR=10

Note: Read entry 10 which was stored in

Unicode format.

AT+CPBR=1,3

Note: Read location 1 to 3 and return and data they may contain. Only 10 entries starting at the first entry are displayed. User can enter command multiple times with different indices.

AT+CPBR=12,1

Note: <x,y> where x<y

AT+CPBR=300

Possible Responses

+CPBR:1,”6185551212”,145,”test”

OK

Note: Display location 1

+CPBR:10,”6185551212”,145,”8005310532”

OK

Note: Display location 10 (Unicode format).

+CPBR:1,”6185551212”,145,”test1”

+CPBR:2,”6185551212”,129,”test2”

+CPBR:3,”6185551212”,115,”test3”

Note: The MSB of the TON/NPI is ALWAYS set high

ERROR

Note: Invalid range x>y

+CMEE:21

Note: Invalid index

Note:

For the LD, MC, and RC phonebooks, the TON/NPI number will not be displayed.

Phonebook Search +CPBP

Description:

This searches the currently selected phonebook for a phone number match and returns the entry if found. If the specified number exists in multiple locations within the selected phonebook, only the first entry found will be returned. The search looks for the exactly number string match.

When the “MT” phonebook is selected, the search operation searches the “ME” portion first followed by the

“SM” portion.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CPBP= ”<phone number>”

Command Possible Responses

AT+CPBP= ”8585551212”

Note: Find ”8585551212” in current phonebook if it exists.

+CPBP=1,”8585551212”,145,”FullBook”

OK

Note: ME phonebook previously selected. Display entry that matches.

Note:

AT+CPBP=”123” +CME ERROR: 22

Note: Entry not found

The phone number to search must match that stored in phone book. Partial number searching is not supported and will return an error.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 66

Avoid Phonebook Initialization +WAIP

Chapter 11 – Phone Book Commands

Description: This command controls access to the available phonebooks. If +WAIP is set to 1, phonebook initialization at module startup is not performed and phonebook functions are not available. When +WAIP is set to 0, normal phonebook functionality is available. A change to the WAIP <mode> value is saved to NV and becomes active following a module reset.

Values:

Syntax:

<mode>

0

Enabled - Normal operating mode.

1 Disabled - No phonebook initialization.

Command syntax: AT+WAIP=<mode>

Command

AT+WAIP=?

Note: Display valid command parameters.

AT+WAIP?

Note: Display current WAIP setting.

AT+WAIP=1

Note: Disable phonebook access.

AT+WAIP=0

Note: Enable phonebook access.

Possible responses

+WAIP: (0-1)

OK

+WAIP: 1

OK

Note: No phonebook commands are allowed. If entered, “+CMEE ERROR: 3” is returned.

OK

Note: Access is denied following module reset.

OK

Note: Access is permitted following module reset.

Delete Calls From Phonebook +WDCP

Description:

This command will delete all entries from a selected phonebook if it supports this feature. Typically, +WDCP is used to delete the calls stored in LD, MC, and RC phonebooks.

Values: <call phonebook>

LD, MC, or RC

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WDCP=”<call phonebook>”

Possible Responses

AT+WDCP?

AT+WDCP=?

AT+WDCP=”LD”

+WDCP: “LD”

Note: Returns phonebook(s) that support deleting calls.

+WDCP: (“LD”,”MC”,”RC”)

Note: Possible supported phonebooks

OK

Note: Erase call history for last dialed phone book

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 67

Chapter 12 – Postion Determination (GPS) Commands

Chapter 12 – Position

Determination (GPS)

Commands

The position determination AT commands are supported on gpsOne equipped CDMA modules. GpsOne is a wireless-assisted hybrid solution that utilizes both GPS and base-station trilateration to determine the mobile position. A high degree of position accuracy is possible using gpsOne due to the inclusion of CDMA system timing information in the position calculation.

The gpsOne feature includes a number of AT commands that are used to configure, start, stop, and report position data. The reported position data is used by the user or application software host to provide the desired features. GpsOne functionality is dependent on the carrier and network configurations. A number of gpsOne session examples are included in section 21 to aide in the understanding of the gpsOne AT commands.

Position Determination Session Type +WPDST

Description: This command sets the desired position determination session type. The session type specifies how the next PD session is to function. An attempt to change the session type while a PD session is in progress will result in an error.

Values: <type>

0

Session to provide the last position info available. Position fix not performed.

Note:

1 Session to provide single-shot fix. Perform a new position fix.

2 Tracking mode independent fixes; session to provide continuous independent position fixes.

3

Tracking mode; session to provide continuous position fixes.

4 Data download; session to download ephemeris/almanac data only. Used for MS-based fix determination. Download data is valid for 30 to 120 minutes.

When a tracking mode is requested (continuous position fixes) and the TCP/IP transport layer is used, a data call will interrupt the reception of position fixes. The modem will store up to 10 of the most current position fixes and present them when the data call ends.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WPDST=<type>

Possible Responses

AT+WPDST?

Note: Request current setting type

AT+WPDST=0

Note: Select the last position info available

AT+WPDST=1

+WPDST: 0

OK

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+CME ERROR: 600

Note: Select single-shot fix

AT+WPDST=?

Note: Display valid command parameter range.

Note: PD session already active.

+WPDST: (0-4)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 68

Chapter 12 – Postion Determination (GPS) Commands

Position Determination Operating Mode +WPDOM

Description: This command sets the desired position determination session operating mode. The mode specifies how the next PD session position data is to be derived and calculated. An attempt to change the session mode while a PD session is in progress will result in an error.

Values: <mode>

0 Standalone only; MS uses internal GPS functions.

1

Network (PDE-based) only; MS obtains all position determination data from the PDE.

2 Speed optimal (minimize time-to-fix, MS-based first, PDE-based later if failed).

3

Accuracy optimal (PDE preferred, MS in case of failure) .

4 Data optimal– minimize data exchanged between MS and PDE.

5

MS-based only; MS performs all position determination functions.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPDOM=<mode>

Command

AT+WPDOM?

Note: Request current setting mode

AT+WPDOM=1

Note: Use PDE provided data.

AT+WPDOM=?

Note: Display valid command parameter range.

Possible responses

+WPDOM: 5

OK

Note: Current mode displayed.

OK

Note: Command valid.

+WPDOM: (0-5)

OK

Position Determination Data Download +WPDDD

Description: This command specifies configuration parameters that are used in a position determination data download session. The default is zero for both parameters if the +WPDDD command is not used. The appropriate parameters must be set prior to starting a PD data download session.

Values: <type>

0 Single-shot download of ephemeris/almanac data

1

Periodically download ephemeris/almanac data. <duration> specifies time between downloads.

<duration>

Number of minutes between ephemeris/almanac data downloads when <type> is set to 1. Range of this parameter is 0 to 255 minutes. The download duration parameter is currently ignored.

Note: The GPS almanac data is valid for 3 to 4 days and GPS ephemeris data is valid for 30 to 120 minutes.

Syntax : Command syntax: AT+WPDDD=<type>,<duration>

Command Possible responses

AT+WPDDD=?

Note: Display valid parameter ranges.

+WPDDD: (0-1),(0-255)

OK

AT+WPDDD?

Note: Display current settings

AT+WPDDD=0,60

Note: Request single-shot data download

AT+WPDDD=1,30

Note: Request continuous data download

+WPDDD: 0,0

OK

OK

Note: Duration value currently ignored.

OK

Note: Duration value currently ignored.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 69

Chapter 12 – Postion Determination (GPS) Commands

Position Determination Fix Rate +WPDFR

Description: This command specifies the position determination session fix rate. This setting is used in tracking sessions only and specifies the number and interval for the unsolicited position data responses (+WPDSS). The default value for the +WPDFR parameters is zero. The appropriate parameters must be set prior to starting a PD tracking session.

Values: <num> Number of fixes. Valid range is 0 to 400.

Time between fixes in seconds. Valid range is 0 to 1800.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPDFR=<num>,<time>

Command

AT+WPDFR=?

Note: Display valid parameter ranges.

AT+WPDFR?

Note: Display current settings.

AT+WPDFR=10,100

Note: Specify 10 fixes with 100 seconds between fixes

Possible responses

+WPDFR: (0-400),(0-1800)

OK

+WPDFR: 10,100

OK

OK

Note: Command accepted.

Position Determination Privacy Level +WPDPL

Description: This command is used to set the position determination session privacy level. The privacy level is used to control what mobile station position information is made available to the PDE during a PD session.

Values: <level>

0

Low (no restrictions) – Permits sending of pilot phase measurements, GPS pseudo-ranges, and MS position information to the PDE.

1

Medium – Pilot phase measurements can be sent to the PDE. Disables sending of MS position information and GPS pseudo-ranges. Allows only MS-based position calculated fixes. Allows AFLTonly MS-assisted fixes.

2 Highest – No information that could be used to locate the mobile will be sent to the PDE. Allows only

MS-based position calculation fixes. Disables PDE-based position calculation/MS-assisted fixes.

Note: If the MS is in emergency mode (e911), the module will provide all available position data (level 0) when requested by the PDE.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPDPL=<level>

Command Possible responses

AT+WPDPL=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

AT+WPDPL?

Note: Display current setting.

AT+WPDPL=2

Note: Select highest level of security.

+WPDPL: (0-2)

OK

+WPDPL: 0

OK

OK

Note: Command accepted.

Position Determination NV Privacy Level +WPPRV

Description: This command is used to specify the NV Privacy level for the position determination session. This setting controls how the PD session responds to PDE originated location requests. The new value is committed to

NV and is persistent following a module power cycle.

Values:

Syntax:

<level>

0 Lowest level of privacy. The module puts no restrictions on position data shared with the network.

(Default)

1 Medium level of privacy. The module will only perform mobile based position fixes, PDE based fixes are disallowed. Mobile terminated sessions not are allowed, except E911 position fixes.

2 Highest level of privacy. The module will not send any information to the network that could allow the network to estimate the current user location. Note that depending on the level of PDE sophistication, this could impede the module's GPS performance. The module will only perform mobile based position fixes, PDE based fixes are disallowed. Mobile terminated sessions not are allowed, except E911 position fixes.

Command syntax:

AT+WPPRV=<level>

Command

AT+WPPRV=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

Possible responses

+WPPRV: (0-1)

OK

AT+WPPRV?

Note: Display current setting.

+WPPRV: 0

OK

AT+WPPRV=1 Note: Set to medium privacy level OK Note: Command accepted.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 70

Chapter 12 – Postion Determination (GPS) Commands

Position Determination Transport Setting +WPTLM

Description: This command specifies the transport layer to be used for the position determination session. The transport layer is carrier specific and may require other PD parameters (IP address, IP port) to also be configured.

Values: <setting>

0

TCP/IP - Use a TCP/IP based socket for PDE/MS PD data exchanges.

1 DBM - Use data burse messages for PDE/MS PD data exchanges.

Syntax:

Note: For software versions earlier than v3.0, when a tracking mode is requested (continuous position fixes) and the TCP/IP transport layer is used, position fixes will not be delivered until the data call ends. Then, only the last 10 position fixes will be presented.

Command syntax:

AT+WPTLM=<setting>

Command

AT+WPTLM=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

AT+WPTLM?

Note: Display current setting.

AT+WPTLM=0

Note: Set the transport setting to TCP/IP

Possible responses

+WPTLM: (0-1)

OK

+WPTLM: 1

OK

OK

Note: Command accepted.

Set Position Determination IP Address +WPDIP

Description:

This command is used to set the IP address for the position determination session. A valid IP address is required if the TCP/IP transport layer is used.

Values: <ip_address>

Specified in standard IP address format xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx where xxx is 000 to 255. This is a carrier specific value.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPDIP=<ip_address>

Command Possible responses

AT+WPDIP?

Note: Query current PD IP address.

+WPDIP:192.168.135.124

OK

AT+WPDIP=192.168.135.124

Note: Set PD IP address.

OK

Note: New PD IP address set.

Set Position Determination Port ID +WPDPT

Description:

This command is used to set the port ID value for the position determination session. A valid port ID value is required if the TCP/IP transport layer is used.

Values: <port_id>

Numeric value in the range 0 to 65535. Value is carrier specific.

Syntax : Command syntax:

AT+WPDIP=<port_id>

Command

AT+WPDPT?

Note: Query current PD port id value.

AT+WPDPT=4911

Note: Set PD port id value.

Possible responses

+WPDPT: 4911

OK

OK

Note: New PD port id value set.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 71

Chapter 12 – Postion Determination (GPS) Commands

Position Determination Start Session +WPDSS

Description: This command is used to start a position determination session. Configuration settings, either default or as set by a PD related AT command, will be used. For an ephemeris/almanac data download session, the data is returned to the module PD software and not displayed. For all other PD session types, position data will be returned using +WPDSS unsolicited responses. The content of the unsolicited +WPDSS responses is dependent on the service requested by the +WPDSS command. Only one PD session may be active at a time.

Values: <service>

“P”

Position only

“PV” Position and Velocity; velocity includes heading data.

“PH”

Position and Elevation

“PVH” Position, Velocity, and Elevation; velocity includes heading data.

Note:

Multiple letter codes for the service parameters must be ordered as shown.

<performance>

0

No time allowed for GPS search. Use Advanced Forward Link Trilateration (AFLT) only.

1-255

Upper bound of permitted GPS search time in seconds. Note that this does not correspond to overall session time, but only the amount of time spent searching in GPS mode.

<accuracy>

Accuracy threshold in meters; only used in MS-based position determination sessions. If the position uncertainty is higher than the accuracy threshold, the session will fall back to PDE-calculated fixes if permitted by the current privacy setting (+WPDPL <level> not 2). The PDE-calculated fixes will not be checked to the accuracy threshold. If the privacy setting prohibits PDE-calculated fixes, the accuracy threshold exceeded fix will be used.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WPDSS=<service>,<performance>,<accuracy>

Command

AT+WPDSS=”PV”

Note: Start a PD session for position and velocity.

Use AFLT with no accuracy threshold.

AT+WPDSS=”PVH”,20,50

Note: Start a PD session for position, velocity, and elevation. GSP search time limited to within 20 seconds. Desired accuracy within 50 meters.

AT+WPDSS?

Possible responses

OK

Note: Command accepted.

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+WPDSS: ”PVH”,20,50

OK

Note: “PVH” session in progress.

+WPDSS:

OK

Note: No active session.

Position Determination End Session +WPDES

Description: This command is used to end a position determination session prior to its normal termination. For example, the termination of a PD session before the +WPDFR command specified number of fixes have been returned.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WPDES

Command

AT+WPDES

Note: End current PD session

Possible responses

OK

Note: Command accepted. PD session ended.

+CME: ERROR: 604

Note: No active session.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 72

Chapter 12 – Postion Determination (GPS) Commands

gpsOne Session Consent +WPDCT

Description:

Values:

Syntax:

This command is used to set the default user consent for network initiated gpsOne sessions. The specified value will be saved to NV after each AT+WPDCT command and is module reset persistent.

<n>

0 Always accept (factory default)

1

Always refuse

2 Prompt

Command syntax: AT+WPDCT=<n>

Command

AT+WPDCT=?

Note: Show available options.

AT+WPDCT?

Note: Show current setting.

AT+WPDCT=2

Note: Set default consent to prompt.

Possible Responses

+WPDCT: (0-2)

OK

+WPDCT: 0

OK

OK

gpsOne Session Prompt Input +WPDUC

Description:

This command is used to enter a value in response to a +WPUST prompt. This command is available only for a 20 second period following output of the +WPUST unsolicited response. If this command is used at any other time, ERROR will be returned.

Values: <response>

0 Accept network initiated gpsOne session.

1

Refuse network initiated gpsOne session.

Syntax:

Command syntax: AT+WPDUC=<response>

Command

AT+WPDUC=?

Note: Show available options.

AT+WPDUC?

Note: Show last response.

AT+WPDUC=1

Note: Refuse network initiated gpsOne session.

Possible Responses

+WPDUC: (0-1)

OK

+WPDUC: 0

OK

IP Server Address +WMPC

Description: This command is used to read or set the MPC server IP and port address. This command is available only in the China Unicom software edition. This command will return ERROR in all other software editions.

Values: <ip1 - ip4>

The IP address to be used. The valid range for each portion of the IP address is 0 – 255. Ip1 is the MSB and ip4 is the LSB of the IP address. Note that the four IP address parts must be comma separated.

<port>

The port number to be used. Valid port number values are in the range 0 to 65535.

Syntax:

Command syntax: AT+WMPC=<ip1 - ip4>,<port>

Command

AT+WMPC=12,192,20,210,8888

Note: Set to MPC server IP address 12.192.20.210 and port 8888.

AT+WMPC?

Note: Show current settings.

AT+WMPC=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

Possible responses

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+WMPC: 12,192,20,210,8888

OK

Note: Current settings displayed.

+WMPC: (0-255),(0-255),(0-255),(0-255),(0-65535)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 73

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Chapter 13 - Specific AT

Commands

Manufacturer Identification +WGMI

Description:

This command gives the manufacturer identification.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WGMI

Possible Responses

AT+WGMI

Note: Get manufacturer identification

+WGMI: MODEM

OK

Note: Command valid, modem

Request Model Identification +WGMM

Description : This command is used to get the supported frequency bands. With multi-band products the response may be a combination of different bands.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WGMM

Command Possible Responses

AT+WGMM

Note: Get supported bands

+WGMM: 800 1900

OK

Note: CDMA 800 MHz band and 1900 (PCS)

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 74

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Cell Environment and RxLev Indication +CCED

Description:

This command can be used by the application to retrieve information about the main cell and up to six neighboring cells. This is an extended command that may be used in two different settings :

1. Interrogation of the cell environment information

2. Interrogation of the received signal strength indication (RSSI)

Values:

The +CCED command supports two modes of operation: on request by the application or automatically by the product every 5 seconds.

<mode>

0

Requests a single snapshot of cell data

1

Start automatic snapshot mode

2

Stop automatic snapshot mode

Automatic snapshot mode will not return a terminating “OK”. The unsolicited responses +CCED and/or

+CSQ will be used to return the requested information.

<requested dump>

1

Main Cell: <mode>, <band class>, <Channel #>, SID, NID, <Base Station P Rev>, [<Pilot PN offset>],

<Base Station ID>, [<Slot cycle index>], [<Ec/Io>], <Rx power>, <Tx power>, <Tx Adj>

2 Neighbor1 to Neighbor20 (max): The first value is the <number of neighbor entries> in the response.

Each neighbor entry consists of the following values: <band class>, [<Pilot PN>], <Frequency

Assignment>

4

Timing Advance: Always zero for CDMA

8

Main cell RSSI indication (RxLev) from 0 to 31.

If the <requested dump> parameter is not specified, the <requested dump> value from the previous

+CCED command will be used. If no previous +CCED <requested dump> value is available, a default value of 13 (8, 4, and 1) will be used.

For <requested dump> 4, 2, and 1, the requested information is output using the unsolicited +CCED response. Place holders are used in the +CCED output for fields that cannot be measured or are not meaningful in the current mode of operation. In this case, consecutive commas will be present in the output. There are also several optional parameters ([]) that are not displayed in analog mode and will result in place holders in the +CCED command output. Automatic snapshots of these dumps is not supported during communication or registration.

For <requested dump> 1, the first value output in the unsolicited +CCED response is the +CCED command specified <mode> (0, 1, or 2). The value displayed for Ec/Io is the index of the Active set in

0.5dB steps from 0 (0dB) to 63 (-31.5dB). For example: 0 = 0dB, 1 = 0.5dB, 2 = 1dB, … 62 = 31dB,

63 = 31.5dB. The value displayed for <Rx power>, <Tx power>, and <Tx Adj> is in terms of dBm.

For <requested dump> 8, the information is output using the unsolicited +CSQ response. The 07.07 format of the +CSQ response is respected. However, the <fer> portion of the +CSQ response is not evaluated by this dump request so the <fer> value will always be 99. Automatic snapshots are supported in idle mode and during communication.

The combination of multiple <requested dump> values (addition of the values) in a single +CCED command is supported with the exception of <requested dump> 2. The <requested dump> 2 value must be use by itself and not in combination with other dump request values.

Either or both the +CCED and +CSQ responses are used for output depending upon the <requested dump> value. Activation or deactivation of a +CCED response flow will not affect an existing +CSQ response flow. Likewise, activation or deactivation of a +CSQ response flow will not affect an existing

+CCED response flow.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 75

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CCED=<mode>[, <requested dump>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+CCED=?

AT+CCED?

+CCED: (0-2),(1-15)

OK

+CCED: 0,13

OK

AT+CCED=0

Note: one time, dump default (8, 4, and 1)

AT+CCED=0,1

Note: one time, dump main cell

AT+CCED=1,8

Note: Start automatic snapshots and dump <rssi>.

AT+CCED=2,8

AT+CCED=0,2

Note: one time, dump neighbor cells.

Neighbor cells must be dumped separately.

+CSQ: 15, 99

+CCED: 0,0,1,125,4,65535,6,,0,,,-107,-32,-63

OK

+CCED: 1,725,4,65535,6,,0,,,-104,-35,-63

OK

+CSQ: 18, 99

Note: No OK response. New +CSQ response output every 5 seconds.

OK

Note: Stop automatic snapshots of <rssi>.

+CCED:18,0,268,384,0,272,384,0,296,384,0,8,384,0,48,384,0,2

48,384,0,164,384,0,16,384,0,12,384,0,224,384,0,108,384,0,476,

384,0,472,384,0,76,384,0,292,384,0,300,384,0,312,384,0,308,3

84

OK

Note: 18 neighbor cells are present. The first neighbor cell band class is 0, its PilotPN is 268, and its frequency assignment is

384.

If the <requested dump> parameter is not specified, the <requested dump> value from the previous +CCED command will be used. If no previous +CCED <requested dump> value is available, a default value of 13 (8, 4, and 1) will be used.

For <requested dump> 4, 2, and 1, the requested information is output using the unsolicited +CCED response. Place holders are used in the +CCED output for fields that cannot be measured or are not meaningful in the current mode of operation. In this case, consecutive commas will be present in the output. There are also several optional parameters ([]) that are not displayed in analog mode and will result in place holders in the +CCED command output. Automatic snapshots of these dumps are not supported during communication or registration.

For <requested dump> 1, the first value output in the unsolicited +CCED response is the +CCED command specified <mode>

(0, 1, or 2). The value displayed for Ec/Io is the index of the Active set in 0.5dB steps from 0 (0dB) to 63 (-31.5dB). For example: 0 = 0dB, 1 = 0.5dB, 2 = 1dB, … 62 = 31dB, 63 = 31.5dB. The value displayed for <Rx power>, <Tx power>, and <Tx

Adj> is in terms of dBm.

For <requested dump> 8, the information is output using the unsolicited +CSQ response. The 07.07 format of the +CSQ response is respected. However, the <fer> portion of the +CSQ response is not evaluated by this dump request so the <fer> value will always be 99. Automatic snapshots are supported in idle mode and during communication.

The combination of multiple <requested dump> values (addition of the values) in a single +CCED command is supported with the exception of <requested dump> 2. The <requested dump> 2 value must be use by itself and not in combination with other dump request values.

Either or both the +CCED and +CSQ responses are used for output depending upon the <requested dump> value. Activation or deactivation of a +CCED response flow will not affect an existing +CSQ response flow. Likewise, activation or deactivation of a +CSQ response flow will not affect an existing +CCED response flow.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 76

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Analog Digital Converters Measurements +ADC

Description:

This command returns the current raw value of the specified ADC data item. Two external and four internal items can be queried.

VBATT Battery voltage (+Vbatt) being supplied to the Modem.

THERM

HDET

ADC_0

ADC_1

Thermistor level (internal temperature) of the Modem.

Internal test use only.

External general-purpose user defined input (pin 33).

External general-purpose user defined input (pin 38).

ADC_CHG_MON Battery charger monitor (CHG_IN).

Values: <item>

0

VBATT: 0 to 2.5 volts. Returned value = (+V_BAT*256)/(2.5*2.5) Range: 0-255.

Examples: 172 returned for 4.2 volts, 156 returned for 3.8 volts, 135 returned for

1

THERM:

3.3 volts. Value range 0-255.

100 °C (68) to –40 °C (240). Returned value = (vt*256)/2.5 vt = -0.012*T + 1.864

“T” is thermistor temperature in °Celsius. Range: 68-240 or -1.2288 °C per step.

Internal use. Value range: 0-255

2

HDET:

3 ADC_0: 0 to 2.5 volts. Value = (Vadc*256)/2.5 Value range: 0-255 or ~.00977 volt per step.

4 ADC_1: Same value, range, and step as ADC 0.

5

ADC_CHG_MON: 0 to 4.2 volts. Value = (CHG_IN*256)/4.2 Value range: 0-255 or ~ .0165 volt per step.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+ADC=<item>

Command

AT+ADC=0

Note: Select VBATT

AT+ADC=1

Note: Select THERM

AT+ADC=?

Note: Ask for the list of possible values

AT+ADC?

Note: Ask for the current item selected

Possible Responses

+ADC: 164

OK

Note: raw value for VBATT (~4.00 volts)

+ADC: 94

OK

Note: raw thermistor temperature (~34 ° C)

+ADC: (0-5)

Note: possible values 0 –5

+ADC: 1

OK

Note: THERM selected

Mobile Equipment Event Reporting +CMER

Description:

This command enables or disables the sending of unsolicited result codes in the case of a key press.

Values: <keyp>

(keypad) :

0 No keypad event reporting.

1

Keypad events are reporting using the unsolicited response: +CKEV: <key>, <press>.

See Chapter 21 regarding Key Press or Release, for more information on +CKEV.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CMER=<keyp>

Possible Responses

AT+CMER?

Note: Display current setting.

AT+CMER=1

Note: Enable keypad event reporting.

+CMER: 0

OK

Note: Keypad event reporting disabled.

OK

Note: Keypad event reporting enabled.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 77

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Read GPIO Value +WIOR

Description:

Set the I/O port as an input and read the I/O pin value.

Values: <index>

The GPIO to read.

<value>

Value of the GPIO pin.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WIOR=<index>

Response syntax:

+WIOR: <value>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WIOR=32

Read GPIO 32 value

+WIOR: 0

OK

GPIO 32 value is 0

Write GPIO Value +WIOW

Description: Set the I/O port as an output and set the requested I/O pin value.

Valid GPIO pins for 23xx are: 2, 3, 4, 5, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 16, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, 36, 40, 42, 43, 44, 45,

46, 47.

Valid GPIO pins for the V5 24xx module are: 3, 4, 6, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 37, 48.

Values: <index>

The GPIO to write.

<value>

0 I/O bit is set to 0.

1

I/O bit is set to 1.

Syntax

:

Command syntax:

AT+WIOW=<index>,<value>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WIOW=16,1

Set GPIO 16 to 1

OK

GPIO value is written

Play Tone +WTONE

Description:

This specific command allows a tone to be played on the current speaker or on the buzzer. Frequency, volume and duration can be set.

Values: <mode>

0

1

Stop playing.

Play a tone

<dest>

1

This parameter sets the destination (mandatory if <mode>=1)

Speaker

2

Buzzer

<freq>

This parameter sets tone frequency (in Hz) (mandatory if <mode>=1). The range is between 1 and 4000Hz. However, for handset and a person to hear, the effective range may be 150-4000Hz.

Syntax:

<volume>(0-3)

This parameter sets the tone volume. The default value is 1. Values are the same as

+CRSL.

<duration> (0-50) This parameter sets tone duration (unit of 100 ms). When this parameter is equal to 0

(default value), the duration is infinite, and the tone can be stopped by AT+WTONE=0.

Command syntax:

AT+WTONE=<mode>[,<dest>,<freq>,<volume>,<duration>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+WTONE=1,1,300,2,50

Note: Play a tone

AT+WTONE?

Note: Current value

OK

Note: Done

+WTONE: 1,1,300,2,50

OK

AT+WTONE=0

Note: Stop playing

AT+WTONE=?

Note: Test command

OK

Note: Done

+WTONE: (0-1),(1-2),(1-4000),(0-3),(0-50)

OK

Note: Done

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 78

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Play DTMF Tone +WDTMF

Description:

This specific command allows a DTMF tone to be played on the current speaker. DTMF, volume and duration can be set. This command is only used to play a DTMF tone. To send a DTMF over the CDMA network, use the +VTS command.

Values: <mode>

0 Stop playing.

1

Play a DTMF tone

<dtmf>

<volume> (0-3)

This parameter sets the DTMF to play in {0-9,*,#,A,B,C,D} (mandatory if <mode>=1)

This parameter sets tone gain. The values are identical to those of the +WTONE

(speaker) command (mandatory if <mode>=1).

<duration> (0-50)

This parameter sets the tone duration (unit of 100 ms). When this parameter is 0

(default value), the duration is infinite, and the DTMF tone can be stopped by

AT+WDTMF=0.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WDTMF=<mode>[,<dtmf>,<volume>,<duration>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+WDTMF=1,”*”,2,10

Note: Play a DTMF tone

AT+WDTMF?

Note: Current value

OK

Note: Done

+WDTMF: 1,”*”,2,10

Note:

AT+WDTMF=0

Note: Stop playing

AT+WDTMF=?

Note: Test command

OK

Note: Done

ERROR

Note: Done

Hardware Version +WHWV

Description: This command displays the MSM version along with hardware version number.

MSM version display format: Major.Minor; e.g., 5.1

Major:

Minor:

The three-digit production hardware version is written to the modem during manufacturing. First digit represents PCB version (ex: 5. as in V5). The second and third digits represents a minor hardware change to the PCB (ex. 04).

PCB version

Minor hardware change

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WHWV

Command

AT+WHWV

Note: Request MSM Version

AT+WHWV

Note: Request MSM Version

Possible Responses

+WHWV: 5.1

OK

Note: MSM version is 5.1

+WHWV: 6.0

OK

Note: MSM version is 6.0

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 79

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Select Voice Gain +WSVG

Description:

The product has 2 voice gain paths. This command provides a means for selecting the desired voice path.

Values: <n> Path

0 HANDSET (Default)

1

HEADSET

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WSVG=<n>

Possible Responses

AT+WSVG=0

Note: Select Path 1 (Default)

AT+WSVG=1

Note: Select Path 2

AT+WSVG=?

Note: Get the list of possible values

AT+WSVG?

Note: Get the current value

OK

Note: Path 1 selected

OK

Note: Path 2 selected

+WSVG: (0-1)

Note: possible values 0 or 1

+WSVG: 1

Note: Path 1 is selected

Status Request +WSTR

Description:

This command returns additional information for the initialization sequence and network status.

Values

: If <status> is 1 (initialization sequence), then:

<value>

0

1

2

Not started

On going

Finished

If <status> is 2 (Network status), then:

<value>

0

1

No network

Network available

Syntax: Command syntax:

Response syntax: +WSTR: <status>,<value>

Command

AT+WSTR=<status>

AT+WSTR=1

Note: Select the status 1 (INIT SEQUENCE)

Possible Responses

+WSTR: 1,2

OK

Note: Init finished

AT+WSTR=2

Note: Select the status 2 (NETWORK STATUS)

AT+WSTR=?

Note: Ask the list of possible values

+WSTR: 2,1

OK

Note: The network is available

+WSTR: (1-2)

Note: possible values : 1, 2

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 80

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Ring Indicator Mode +WRIM

Description:

This specific command sets or returns the state of the Ring Indicator Mode. In pulse RI mode, an electrical pulse lasting approximately 10µs is sent on the Ring Indicator signal just before sending any unsolicited AT response in order not to lose AT responses when client tasks are in sleep state. Still in RI mode, when receiving incoming calls, electrical pulses are sent on the RI signal.

In up-down RI mode, no pulses are sent before unsolicited AT response, and up-down signals are sent when receiving an incoming call.

Values: <n>

0 up-down RI mode

1 pulse RI mode

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WRIM=<n>

Command

AT+WRIM=0

Note: Select up-down RI mode

AT+WRIM=1

Note: Select pulse RI mode

AT+WRIM=?

Note: Ask the list of possible values

AT+WRIM?

Note: Ask the current value

Possible Responses

OK

Note: up-down RI mode selected

OK

Note: pulse RI mode selected

+WRIM: (0-1)

OK

Note: possible values 0 or 1

+WRIM: 1

OK

Note: current RI mode is pulse RI.

32kHz Sleep Mode +W32K

Description:

This specific command allows the 32kHz sleep mode to be enabled or disabled. When sleep mode is entered, the product uses a 32kHz internal clock during inactivity stages. When enabled, sleep mode is active after 1 to 15 seconds.

Values: <mode>

0 Disable 32kHz power down mode

1

Enable 32kHz power down mode

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+W32K=<mode>

Possible Responses

AT+W32K=1

Note: Enable 32kHz sleep mode

AT+W32K=0

Note: Disable 32kHz sleep mode

OK

Note: 32kHz sleep mode is enabled

OK

Note: 32kHz sleep mode is disabled

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 81

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Change Default Melody +WCDM

Description: This specific command allows a manufacturer specific melody to be selected. This melody will be played for any incoming voice call, either on the buzzer or on the speaker.

Note:

Values:

Selection of the player will have an effect on the setting of the WCDP command.

<melody>

0…10 Desired melody (Default is 0)

<player>

0 Play specified melody on the buzzer for any incoming voice call. (default)

1

Play specified melody on the speaker for any incoming voice call.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WCDM=<melody>,<player>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WCDM=0

Note: Select no melody

AT+WCDM=5

Note: Select melody n°5

OK

OK

AT+WCDM?

Note: Indicate the current melody

+WCDM: 5,0

OK

Note: Melody n°5 is currently selected, and the buzzer is selected to play it.

RING

Note: An incoming call occurs, and the melody n°5 is played on the buzzer.

AT+WCDM=,1

Note: Select the speaker to play the melody on.

AT+WCDM?

OK

+WCDM: 5,1

OK

Note: Now the speaker is selected to play the melody if an incoming call occurs.

Software Version +WSSW

Description:

This command displays the internal software version.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WSSW

Possible Responses

AT+WSSW

Note: Get Software version

+WSSW: WQ1.6

OK

Note: internal software information

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 82

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Custom Character Set Tables +WCCS

Description:

This command provides the ability to edit and display the custom character set tables. The “CUSTOM” mode of the +CSCS command uses the custom character set tables. In this mode, when the user enters a string, this string is translated into the CDMA character set using the ‘Custom To CDMA’ table. In a similar way, when the user requests a string display, the string is translated from CDMA character set using the ‘CDMA

To Custom’ table.

In edit mode, the edit session is terminated by <ctrl-Z> (0x1A), or aborted by <ESC> (0x1B). Only hexadecimal characters (‘0’…’9’, ‘A’…’F’) can be used; two hexadecimal digits per character. The number of characters entered must equal the edit range requested, otherwise the command will terminate with a

“+CME ERROR: 3” result.

Values: <mode>

0 Display the table

1

Edit the table

<table>

0

Custom To CDMA conversion table

1

CDMA To Custom conversion table

<char 1>, <char 2> Character range to display/edit. If only <char 1> is present, only this char is displayed/edited.

0…127

0…127 for CDMA To Custom conversion table for Custom To CDMA conversion table

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WCCS=<mode>,<table>,<char 1>[,<char 2>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+WCCS=0,0,20,30

Note: Display character locations 20 through 30 of the Custom To CDMA conversion table

+WCCS: 11, 78797A2020202020097E05

OK

Note: 11 characters displayed

AT+WCCS=1,0,115<CR>

20<ctrl-Z>

Note: Edit character 115 of the Custom To CDMA conversion table

AT+WCCS=1,1,0,4<CR>

40A324A5E8<ctrl-Z>

Note: Edit the 5 first characters of the CDMA To

Custom conversion table

AT+WCCS=1,1,200

Note: Edit character 200 of CDMA To Custom conversion table

OK

Note: Edit successful

OK

Note: Edit successful

+CME ERROR: 3

Note: Index out of range

CPHS Command +CPHS

Description: This command is used to activate, deactivate or interrogate a CPHS feature (e.g. Voice Mail Indicator).

When performing an interrogation (mode = 2), the selected <FctId> CPHS feature is automatically enabled

Note:

(status = 1).

This command will return +CME ERROR: 3 if the CPHS feature is disabled.

Values: <Mode>

0 Deactivate a CPHS feature

1

Activate a CPHS feature

2 Interrogate a CPHS status

<FctId>

1 Voice Mail Indicator

<Status>

0 CPHS feature disabled

1

CPHS feature enabled

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CPHS=<Mode>,<FctId>

Command

AT+CPHS=<Mode>,<FctId>

AT+CPHS?

AT+CPHS=?

Note: display the range of values

Possible Responses

OK

+CPHS: <Status>,<FctId1><CR<LF>

OK

+CPHS: (0-2),(1-1)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 83

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Change Default Player +WCDP

Description:

This command is used to select the default destination for the melody player. Selection of the player will have effect on the setting of the WCDM command.

Note:

Values:

This command is diminished and included for backwards compatibility only. Use +WCDM command instead.

<player>

0

Speaker

1 Buzzer

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WCDP = <player>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WCDP=? +WCDP : (0-1)

OK

AT+WCDP=0

Select the speaker.

AT+WCDP?

OK

+WCDP: 0

OK

Reset +WRST

Description:

This command is used to reset the modem after the specified <delay> time period. The <delay> value is entered in terms of hours and minutes.

Values: <mode>

0 timer reset is disabled

1 timer reset is enabled

<Delay>

“000:00”- “199:59”

<RemainTime>

“000:00”- “199:59”

Syntax: Command syntax:

Response Syntax:

Command

+WRST =<Mode>,<Delay>

+WRST: <Mode>,<Delay>,<RemainTime>

Possible Responses

ERROR

OK

AT+WRST=?

AT+WRST=0

Note: Disable timer

AT+WRST=1,”001:03”

Note: Enable timer and put delay at

1 hour 3 minutes

AT+WRST?

OK

+WRST: 1,”001:03”,”001:01”

OK

Note: Timer activated to reset after 1 hour and 3 minutes.

Actually 1 hour and 1 minute remaining before next reset.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 84

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Set Standard Tone +WSST

Description:

This command is used to set/get the sound level of the Standard Tones.

Values: <sound level>

0 Max volume (default)

4

Min volume (muted)

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WSST=<sound level>

Possible Responses

OK AT+WSST=0

Note: Set volume to Max.

AT+WSST=4

Note: Set the volume to Min (muted)

AT+WSST?

Note: get current standard tones sound level

AT+WSST=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

OK

Note: Standard Tones are muted

+WSST: 4

OK

Note: Current level is 4

+WSST: (0-4)

OK

Set Voice Privacy Level +WPRV

Description:

This command requests the CDMA voice privacy level. CDMA voice privacy is an optional feature of CDMA networks. Therefore, voice privacy will only become enabled during a voice call if the base station supports voice privacy; otherwise this feature is unavailable on your CDMA carrier. Thus, this command enables a request from the modem to the base station for voice privacy. If voice privacy is activated by the base station, the unsolicited command +WPRV:1 will appear indicating the long code PN mask for the traffic channel has been scrambled by the base station (also see Chapter 18). This command may be issued before or during a voice call.

Note:

When voice privacy is enabled, an audible alert will be generated if the state of voice privacy changes (loss or establishment).

Values: <voice privacy level>

0

Normal (default)

1 Private

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPRV=<voice privacy level>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WPRV=0

Note: Set to normal voice call

OK

AT+WPRV=1

Note: Request a secure voice call

ATD18005551212;

OK

OK

+WORG:18005551212

+WCNT:3

+WPRV:1

Note: Voice Privacy is now ON

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 85

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Security PIN +WPIN

Description:

This command sets, enables, or disables the security PIN. When this PIN is enabled, only ATD (emergency numbers only), ATH, and +WPIN commands will be accepted.

Note 1:

The default value of the WPIN will be the last four digits of the mobile directory number if configured (+WMDN). See the +WMDN command.

Note 2:

When the security PIN is enabled, the unit will power-up in the “locked” state.

Values:

Note 3: For RUIM software loads, the default value for WPIN is '0000' even if an MDN is present.

<mode>

0

Disable modem lock

1 Enable modem lock

2

Change the PIN number

3 Verify the PIN. Unlock the modem until reset. Does not change NV enable/disable setting.

4

Enable modem lock upon power up

<current val> & <new val>

0000 – 9999

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPIN=<mode>,<current val>,<new val>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WPIN=0,1111

Note: Disable the security PIN

AT+WPIN?

Note: Query the current state

AT+WPIN=1,2222

Note: Enable the security PIN

AT+WPIN=1,1111

Note: Enable the security PIN

AT+WPIN?

Note: Query the current state

AT+WPIN=2,1111,5555

Note: Change the security PIN code from 1111 to 5555

OK

+WPIN: 0

OK

Note: PIN disabled

+CME ERROR: 44

Note: Invalid PIN

OK

+WPIN: 1

OK

Note: PIN enabled

OK

AT+CSQ?

ATD8585551212;

+CME ERROR: 44

Note: Modem is locked, only ATD & +WPIN commands will be accepted

+CME ERROR: 44

Note: Modem is locked, only emergency numbers accepted using ATD.

OK AT+WPIN=0,5555

Note: Disable the security PIN

AT+WPIN=3,5555

Note: Verify the security PIN

AT+WPIN=3,0000

Note: Verify the security PIN

AT+WPIN=4,0000

Note: Power up modem lock

+CME ERROR: 44

Note: Wrong PIN value entered. Modem locked.

OK

Note: Correct PIN value entered. Modem unlocked.

OK

Note: Modem locked at power up.

Request PRL Version Information +WPRL

Description: This command requests PRL Version information for the currently selected NAM.

Syntax:

Note:

Command syntax:

Command

AT+WPRL?

AT+WPRL?

Note: Request current NAM’s PRL version

AT+WPRL?

Note: Request current NAM’s PRL version

The range for PRL is a 16-bit type.

Possible Responses

+WPRL: 1024

OK

+CME ERROR: 41

Note: PRL request invalid because there’s no PRL loaded.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 86

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Minute Alert +WMBP

Description:

This command is used to set the minute alert while in a voice conversation.

Values: <mode>

0 Disable alert

1

Enable alert

<interval>

1 – 30

Time in minutes

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WMBP=<mode>,<interval>

Command

AT+WMBP=0

Note: Turn off the alert

AT+WMBP=1,4

Note: Turn on the alert and set 4 minutes apart

AT+WMBP?

Note: Request current setting

AT+WMBP=?

Note: Display valid parameter ranges.

Possible Responses

OK

OK

+WMBP: 1,4

+WMBP: (0-1),(1-30)

Configure LED Indicator +CLED

Description:

This command is used to configure GPIO 41 and GPIO 54 for general purpose use. The default use of these two GPIO’s is to drive LED indicators on the Developer Kit board. This command allows a user application to disable this default behavior. When disabled, the user application has full control over the state of these

GPIO’s. The modem operating software will be prevented from change them for operational status indications.

The byte value specified with the +CLED command is a bitmap where bit 0 configures LED1/GPIO 41 and bit 1 configures LED2/GPIO 54. Bit positions 2 through 7 are ignored.

The state of the +CLED specified control bits is not persistent. Both bit positions are always set active (1) during boot resulting in LED status indicator operation. The +CLED command must be used by the user application after each boot if GPIO 41 or GPIO 54 are used for other purposes.

Values: <bitmap value> bit 0 bit 1

0 = GPIO 41 selected; 1 = LED1 selected.

0 = GPIO 54 selected; 1 = LED2 selected. bit 2 – bit7 Reserved

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CLED=<bitmap value>

Command

AT+CLED?

Note: Display current settings.

AT+CLED=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

AT+CLED=1

Note: Set bit 1 to inactive and bit 0 to active.

AT+WIOW=54,0

Note: Set GPIO state.

AT+WIOR=41

Note: Read state of LED1 indicator.

AT+CLED=2

Note: Set bit 1 to active and bit 0 to inactive.

AT+WIOW=41,1

Note: Set GPIO state.

AT+WIOW=54,1

Note: Set LED2 state.

Possible Responses

CLED: 3

OK

Note: Both GPIO’s are used for modem operational status indicators.

CLED: (0-3)

OK

OK

Note: GPIO 54 available, LED1 used for modem status.

OK

Note: Set GPIO 54 to 0.

+WIOR: 1

OK

Note: Read current state of LED1 indicator

OK

Note: LED2 used for modem status, GPIO 41 available.

OK

Note: Set GPIO 41 to 1.

OK

Note: LED2 indicator set to “on”. LED on/off state may change due to modem status indication.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 87

Chapter 13 – Specific AT Commands

Keypad Enable/Disable +WPAD

Description:

This command is used to enable or disable the keypad functionality. When enabled, keypad functionality supports a 5 by 5 keypad matrix of Row and Column lines. When disabled, the GPIO’s associated with the keypad (57 through 66) are available for custom use.

Note:

The setting established by the AT+WPAD command is not persistent unless saved to NV by the AT&W command.

Values:

Syntax:

<mode>

0

Keypad disabled

1 Keypad enabled

Command syntax: AT+WPAD=<mode>

Command

AT+WPAD=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

AT+WPAD?

Note: Display current setting.

AT+WPAD=0

AT&W

Note: Disable keypad and write to NV.

Possible Responses

+WPAD (0-1)

OK

+WPAD: 1

OK

Note: Keypad enabled.

OK

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 88

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Chapter 14 - SIM ToolKit for

RUIM Software Version

Overview of SIM Application ToolKit

Note: The SIM ToolKit features and functionality are available only in the RUIM software version.

Summary

SIM ToolKit, also known as .SIM Application ToolKit, introduces new functionalities which open the way to a broad range of value added services. The principle is to allow service providers the ability to develop new applications (e.g. banking, travel, ticket booking, etc.) for subscribers and to download them into the SIM. This solution allows new services to be accessible to the user by adding new SIM-based applications without modifying the handset.

Functionality

SIM Toolkit refers to the functionalities described in the GSM Technical specification 11.14. It introduces about 25 new commands for the SIM. Three classes of ToolKit functionalities have been defined with class 1 offering a subset of commands and class 3 offering the full range of commands.

The SIM Application Toolkit supports:

• Profile Download

• Proactive SIM

• Data Download into SIM

• Menu Selection

• Call Control by SIM

Profile Download

The Profile Download instruction is sent by the customer application to the SIM as part of the initialization. It is used to indicate which SIM Application Toolkit features the customer application supports.

The AT command used for this operation is +STSF (SIM ToolKit Set Facilities).

Proactive SIM

A proactive SIM provides a mechanism whereby the SIM can ask the customer application to perform certain actions.

These actions include:

• display menu

• display given text

• get user input

• send a short message

• play the requested tone

• set up a call

• provide location information

This mechanism allows SIM applications to generate powerful menu-driven sequences on the customer application and to use services available in the network.

The commands used for this operation are:

+STIN (SIM Toolkit Indication)

+STGI

(SIM Toolkit Get Information)

+STGR (SIM Toolkit Give Response)

Data Download to SIM

Data downloading to the SIM allows data (SMS, phonebook) or programs (Java applets) received by SMS or by Cell

Broadcast to be transferred directly to the SIM Application.

This feature does not need any AT command. It is transparent to the customer application.

Menu Selection

A set of menu items is supplied by the SIM Application ToolKit. The menu selection command can then be used to inform the

SIM Application which menu item is selected.

The commands used for this operation are:

+STIN

(SIM Toolkit Indication)

+STGI (SIM Toolkit Get Information)

+STGR

(SIM Toolkit Give Response)

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 89

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Call control by SIM

The call control mechanism allows the SIM to check all dialed numbers, supplementary service control strings and USSD strings before connecting to the network. This gives the SIM the ability to allow, bar or modify the string before the operation starts.

The commands used for this operation are:

+STCR (SIM Toolkit Control Response)

+STGR

(SIM Toolkit Give Response)

Messages Exchanged During a SIM ToolKit Operation

The following scheme shows the SIM Toolkit commands and unsolicited results that are exchanged.

STEP 1: Configuration and Activation

+STSF=X,XXXXXXXX

STEP 2: SIM sends pro-active command

+STIN=X

STEP 3: Customer application gets all the information.

MULTI-TECH

Modem

+STGI=X

+STGI response

STEP 4: User response is sent to the SIM.

+STCR:X

Customer

Application

+STGR=X,XXXXXX

Step One

The customer application informs the modem which facilities are supported. This operation is performed with the +STSF (SIM

ToolKit Set Facilities) command, which is also used to activate or deactivate the SIM Toolkit functionality.

Step Two

An unsolicited result +STIN (SIM ToolKit indication) is sent by the product to indicate the customer application which command type the SIM Application Toolkit is running on the SIM card. The last SIM Toolkit indication can be requested by the +STIN? command.

Step Three

The customer application uses the +STGI (SIM ToolKit Get Information) command to get all the information about the SIM

ToolKit command, given by +STIN.

Step Four

The customer application uses the +STGR (SIM Toolkit Give Response) to send its response (if any) to the SIM ToolKit

Application.

The +STCR (SIM Toolkit Control response) indication is an unsolicited result sent by the SIM when call control functionality is activated and before the customer application has performed any outgoing call, SMS, SS, or USSD.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 90

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

SIM ToolKit Set Facilities +STSF

Description:

Values:

This command allows SIM ToolKit facilities to be activated, deactivated or configured.

<mode>

0 Deactivates the SIM Toolkit functionalities.

1

Activates the SIM Toolkit functionalities.

2 Configures the SIM Toolkit functionalities.

The activation or deactivation of the SIM Toolkit functionalities requires the use of the +CFUN (Set phone functionality) command to reset the product. +CFUN is not necessary if PIN is not entered yet.

<Config>

(160060C01F . 5FFFFFFF7F) (hex format)

<Config> parameter gives the coding of the TERMINAL PROFILE, precisely the list of SIM

Application Toolkit facilities that are supported by the customer application.

<Timeout>

1-255 : Timeout for user responses (multiple of 10 seconds).

<Timeout> parameter (multiple of 10 seconds) sets the maximum time the user has for reacting (to select an item, to input a text, etc).

Note:

Syntax:

<Autoresponse>

0 Automatic response is not activated

1

Automatic response is activated

When the <Autoresponse> is activated, the +STIN indication for Play Tone (5), Refresh (7), Send SS (8),

Send SMS (9) or Send USSD (10) is automatically followed by the corresponding +STGI response.

Some bits are related to the product only and not to the customer application. The product automatically sets these bits to either 0 or 1 whatever the user enters with the +STSF command. Each facility is coded on 1 bit:

• .bit = 1: facility is supported by the customer application.

• .bit = 0: facility is not supported by the customer application.

Only the first five bytes of the TERMINAL PROFILE (Class 2) can be configured; the other are set to 0.

Command syntax: AT+STSF=<mode>[,<config>][,<Timeout>][,<AutoResponse>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+STSF=<Mode>[,<Config>][,<Timeout>][,<AutoResponse>] OK

+CME ERROR: <err>

AT+STSF? +STSF:

<Mode>,<Config>,<Timeout>,<Autoresponse>

Error Codes: +CME ERROR: 3 Operation not allowed. This error is returned when a wrong parameter is entered.

Example:

AT+CMEE=1

OK

Enable the reporting of mobile equipment errors

AT+WIND=15 Set

OK

Query ME Status

ME is ready.

AT+CPAS

+CPAS: 0

OK

AT+STSF=?

+STSF: (0-2), (160060C01F . 5FFFFFFF7F),(1-255)

OK

AT+STSF?

+STSF: 0,”160060C000”,3

Test command SIM ToolKit Set Facilities

No activation of SIM ToolKit functionality

OK

AT+STSF=2,”5FFFFFFF7F”

OK

AT+STSF=3

+CME ERROR: 3

AT+STSF=1

OK

Activation of SIM ToolKit functionality

Software.

OK

AT+CPIN?

+CPIN: SIM PIN

AT+CPIN=0000

Is the ME requiring a password?

Yes, SIM PIN required

OK PIN Ok

+WIND: 4

AT+STSF?

+STSF: 1,”5FFFFFFF7F”,3

OK

Set all SIM ToolKit facilities (class 3).

Syntax Error

Init phase is complete

SIM ToolKit functionality activated with all facilities

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 91

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

SIM ToolKit Indication +STIN

Unsolicited Result:

In order to allow the customer application to identify the pro-active command sent via SIM ToolKit, a mechanism of unsolicited SIM ToolKit indications (+STIN) is implemented.

Syntax: +STIN: <CmdType>

Option: <CmdType>

0

1

Indicates that a .Setup Menu. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

Indicates that a .Display Text. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

6

7

9

2

3

4

5

11

98

99

Indicates that a .Get Inkey. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

Indicates that a .Get Input. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

Indicates that a .Setup Call. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

Indicates that a .Play Tone. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM. (*)

Indicates that a .Sel Item. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

Indicates that a .Refresh. pro-active command has been sent from the SIM. (*)

Indicates that a .Send SMS. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM. (*)

Indicates that a SETUP EVENT LIST. Pro-active command has been sent from the SIM.

Indicates the timeout when no response from user.

Indicates that a .End Session. Has been sent from the SIM.

(*) if the automatic response parameter is activated, this indication is followed by the corresponding +STGI response.

Last SIM Toolkit Indication:

The last SIM toolkit indication sent by the SIM can be requested by the AT+STIN? command. This command is only useable between the sending of the STIN indication by the SIM (Step 2 in Chapter 14 diagram

“Messages Exchanged During an SIM ToolKit Operation”) and the response of the user with the +STGI command (Step 3 in the same diagram).

Command syntax: AT+STIN?

Command

AT+STIN?

Note: Ask for the last SIM toolkit indication sent by the SIM.

Possible Responses

+STIN: 0

OK

Note: the last SIM toolkit indication was a Setup Menu

AT+STGI=0

Note: Display the SIM toolkit application

Menu.

AT+STIN?

Note: Ask for the last SIM toolkit indication sent by the SIM.

OK

+CME ERROR: 4

Note: operation not supported, the

+STGI command has been already used.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 92

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

SIM ToolKit Get Information +STGI

Description: This command allows you to get the information (text to display, Menu information, priorities.) of a pro-active command sent from the SIM. The information is returned only after receiving a SIM Toolkit indication

(+STIN).

Syntax: Command syntax: +STGI=<Cmd>

Command

+STGI=<Cmd>

+STGI=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

Possible Responses

See following table.

+CME ERROR: <err>

+STGI: (0-11)

OK

Cmd Description

0 Get information about

‘Setup Menu’ pro-active command.

Possible Responses

+STGI: <Alpha Identifier menu>

+STGI: <Id1>,<NbItems>,<Alpha Id1 Label>,<Help

Info>[,<NextActionId>]<CR><LF>

1

2

3

4

5

6

Get information about

‘Display text’ pro-active command.

Get information about ‘Get

Inkey’ pro-active command.

Get information about ‘Get

Input’ pro-active command.

Get information about

‘Setup call’ pro-active command.

Get information about

‘Play

Tone’ pro-active command.

Get information about ‘Sel

Item’ pro-active command.

+STGI: <Id2>,<NbItems>,<Alpha Id2 Label>,<Help

Info>[,<NextActionId>]<CR><LF> [.]]

No action expected from SIM.

+STGI: <Prior>,<Text>,<ClearMode>

No action expected from SIM.

+STGI: <Format>,<HelpInfo>[,<TextInfo>]

SIM expects key pressed (+STGR).

+STGI: <Format>,<EchoMode>,<SizeMin>,<SizeMax>

<HelpInfo>[,<TextInfo>]

SIM expects key input (+STGR).

+STGI: <Type>,<CalledNb>,<SubAddress>,<Class>

SIM expects user authorization (+STGR).

+STGI: <ToneType>[,<TimeUnit>,<TimeInterval>,<TextInfo>]

No action.

+STGI: <DefaultItem>, <Alpha Identifier menu><CR><LF>

+STGI: <Id1>,<NbItems>,<Alpha Id1 Label>,<Help

Info>[,<NextActionId>]<CR><LF>

+STGI: <Id2>,<NbItems>,<Alpha Id2 Label>,<Help

Info>[,<NextActionId>]<CR><LF> [.]]

SIM expects an item choice (+STGR).

+STGI: <RefreshType>

No action (Refresh done automatically by product).

Currently not supported

7

8

Get information about

‘Refresh’ pro-active command.

Get information about

‘Send SS’ pro-active command.

9 Get information about

‘Send SMS’ pro-active command.

10 Get information about

‘Send

USSD’ pro-active command

11 Get information about

‘SETUP EVENT LIST’ pro-active command.

+STGI: <TextInfo>

No action (Send SMS done automatically by product).

Currently not supported

+STGI: <Evt>

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 93

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Values: Values when Cmd=0 (Setup menu )

Compared to other commands, the customer application can always get information about setup menu after having received the +STIN:0 indication.

<Alpha Identifier menu>

Alpha identifier of the main menu

<Idx> (1 –255) Menu item Identifier

<NbItems> (1 –255)

Number of items in the main menu

<Alpha Idx Label> Alpha identifier label of items in ASCII format

<HelpInfo>

0

No help information available

1

<NextActionId>

Help information available

Contains a pro-active command identifier.

Values when Cmd=1 (Display text )

<Prior>

0

1

Normal priority of display

High priority of display

<Text> Text to display in ASCII format

<ClearMode>

0

1

Clear message after a delay (3 seconds)

Wait for user to clear message

Values when Cmd=2 (Get Inkey )

<Format>

0

Digit (0-9, *, #,and +)

1

2

3

SMS alphabet defaults

UCS-2

Yes/No

<HelpInfo>

0

No help information available

1 Help information available

<TextInfo>

Values when Cmd=3 (Get Input )

<Format>

0

Digit (0-9, *, #,and +)

1

2

SMS alphabet defaults

UCS-2

3 Unpacked

4

Packed

<EchoMode>

0

Echo

1 Echo

<SizeMin> (1 –255)

Minimum length of input

<SizeMax> (1 –255) Maximum length of input

<HelpInfo>

0

1

No help information available

Help information available

<TextInfo> Text information in ASCII format

Values when Cmd=4 (Setup Call )

<Type>

0

1

2

Set up call but only if not currently busy on another call

Set up call, putting all other calls (if any) on hold

Set up call, disconnecting all other calls (if any)

Called party number in ASCII format

<SubAdress>

<Class>

0

Voice

1 Data

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 94

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Values when Cmd=5 (Play tone )

<ToneType>

0 Tone

1

Tone

2 Tone

3

4

5

Tone Error ack

Tone

6

Tone Call waiting

7 Tone Ringing

8

Tone General beep

9 Tone Positive beep

10

Tone Negative beep

<TimeUnit>

0

Time unit used is minutes

1 Time unit used is seconds

2

Time unit used is tenths of seconds

<TimeInterval> (1 –255) Time required expressed in units

<TextInfo>

Values when Cmd=6 (Sel Item )

<DefaultItem> (1 –255) Default Item Identifier

<Alpha Identifier menu>

Alpha identifier of the main menu

<Idx> (1 –255) Identifier

<NbItems> (1 –255)

Number of items in the menu

<Alpha Idx Label> Alpha identifier label of items in ASCII format

<HelpInfo>

0

1

No help information available

Help information available

Values when Cmd=7 (Refresh )

<RefreshType>

0

1

2

3

4

SlM initialization and full file change notification

File

SIM initialization and file change notification

SIM

SIM

Values when Cmd=8 (Send SS )

Values when Cmd=9 (Send SMS )

Values when Cmd=10 (Send USSD )

Values when Cmd=11 (Setup Event List )

<Evt>

1

2

3

4

Note:

Reporting asked for an.Idle Screen. Event

Reporting asked for an User Activity. Event

Reporting asked for .Idle Screen .And .User Activity .Events

Cancellation of reporting event

For the Unicode format, texts are displayed in Hexadecimal ASCII format. For example, when the SIM sends a Text String containing 0x00 0x41, the text displayed is .0041.

Error Codes:

+ CME ERROR: 3

+CME ERROR: 4

+CME ERROR: 518

Operation not allowed . This error is returned when a wrong parameter is detected.

Operation not supported . This error is returned when the user wants to get information about a SIM ToolKit pro-active command (with SIM ToolKit functionality not activated.)

SIM ToolKit indication not received . This error is returned when the SIM

Toolkit indication (+STIN) has not been received.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 95

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Example:

Initially, all facilities are activated, the PIN is not required and SIM toolkit functionality is activated.

AT+CMEE=1

OK

Enable the reporting of mobile equipment errors

AT+WIND=15

OK

AT+STSF?

Set indications

SIM ToolKit functionality activated with all facilities. +STSF: 1,”5FFFFFFF7F”,3

OK

+STIN: 0

AT+STIN?

+STIN: 0

OK

AT+STGI=0

+STGI: “SIM TOOLKIT MAIN MENU”

The main menu has been sent from the SIM.

Get information about the main menu

Main menu contains 3 items.

+STGI: 1,3,”BANK”,0

+STGI: 2,3,”QUIZ”,0

+STGI: 3,3,”WEATHER”,0

OK

AT+STIN?

+CME ERROR: 4

Unsolicited Result: SIM ToolKit Control Response

+STCR)

Description: When the customer application makes an outgoing voice or SMS call when the call control facility is activated, CALL CONTROL and SMS CONTROL responses can be identified. This is also applicable to SS calls.

Response syntax: +STCR: <Result>[,<Number>,<MODestAddr>,<TextInfo>]

<Result>

Control response not allowed

1

Called number, Service Center Address or SS String in ASCII format

<MODestAddr>

SIM ToolKit Give Response +STGR

Description:

This command allows the application/user to select an item in the main menu or to answer the following proactive commands:

GET INKEY Key pressed by the user.

GET INPUT

SELECT ITEM

SETUP CALL

DISPLAY TEXT

Message entered by the user.

Selected item.

User confirmation.

User confirmation to clear the message.

It is also possible to terminate the current proactive command session by sending a Terminal Response to the SIM with the following parameters:

BACKWARD MOVE Process a backward move

BEYOND CAPABILITIES Command beyond ME capabilities

UNABLE TO PROCESS ME is currently unable to process command

NO RESPONSE No response from the user

END SESSION User abort.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 96

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Values: <CmdType>

User confirmation to clear displayed Text.

2

Response for a ‘Get Input

4

Response for a ‘Sel Item

95

ME currently unable to process command

98

Values when CmdType=0 (Select an item from the main menu)

<Result>

Item selected by the user

2

<Data> Contains the item identifier of the item selected by the user

Values when CmdType=1 (Confirm the display text clearing)

Values when CmdType=2 (Get Inkey)

<Result>

Response given by the user

2

Values when CmdType=3 (Get Input)

<Result>

Response given by the user

2

Contains the string of characters entered by the user. For inputs in Unicode format, the data are entered in ASCII format. Example: 8000410042FFFF entered, the SIM receives 0x00 0x41 0x00

0x42 with UCS2 DCS.

Values when CmdType=4 (Setup call)

<Result>

User refuses the call

1

Values when CmdType=6 (Select Item)

<Result>

Item selected by the user

2

Return to the back item

<Data>

Sending a Terminal Response to the SIM:

Values when CmdType=95 (Backward Move)

Values when CmdType=96 (Command beyond ME capabilities)

Values when CmdType=97 (ME currently unable to process command)

Values when CmdType=98 (No response from the user)

Values when CmdType=99 (SIM Toolkit Session aborting by the user)

No values. It is possible to send a Terminal Response after the +STIN indication or after the +STGI command.

For the SETUP MENU Proactive Command, it is only possible to send a Terminal Response after the

+STIN: 0 indication, not after a +STGI=0 request. All of the Terminal Responses are not possible with all of the Proactive Commands. If a Terminal Response is attempted during an incompatible Proactive

Command session, a +CME ERROR: 3 will be returned.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 97

Chapter 14 – SIM ToolKit

Possible Error Codes:

+ CME ERROR: 3

+CME ERROR: 4

Operation not allowed. This error is returned when a wrong parameter is detected.

Operation not supported. This error is returned when the user gives a response with SIM ToolKit functionality not activated. Or if the SIM Toolkit indication (+STIN) has not been received.

Syntax: Command syntax:

+STGR=<CmdType>[,<Result>,<Data>]

Command Possible Responses

+STGR=<CmdType>[,<Result>,<Data>]

For Get Input with <Result>=1:

+STGR=3,1<CR>

<Data><Ctrl Z>

OK

+CME ERROR: <err>

OK

+CME ERROR: <err>

For GetInkey with <Result>=1

+STGR=2,1<CR>

<Data><Ctrl Z>

+STGR=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

OK

+CME ERROR: <err>

OK

Example:

Initially, all facilities are activated, the PIN is not required and the SIM toolkit functionality is activated.

+STIN: 0

AT+STGI=0

+STGI: 1,3,”BANK”,0

The main menu has been sent from the SIM.

Get information about the main menu

The main menu contains 3 items.

+STGI: 2,3,”QUIZ”,0

+STGI: 3,3,”WEATHER”,0

OK

AT+STGR=0,1,1

OK

+STIN: 6

AT+STGI=6

+STGI: 1,”BANK”.

The item 2 of the main menu has been selected.

The Sel item menu has been sent from the SIM.

Get information about the BANK menu

The BANK menu contains two items.

+STGI: 1,2,”PERSONAL ACCOUNT ENQUIRY”,1

+STGI: 2,2,”NEWS”,0

OK

AT+STGR=6,1,1

OK

+STIN: 3

AT+STGI=3

+STGI: 0,0,4,4,0”

OK

AT+STGR=3,1<CR>

>0000<Ctrl Z>

OK

+STIN:1

AT+STGI=1

+STGI: 0,”

OK

+STIN: 9

Select Item 1.

User request to enter Password sent.

Get information about this request.

Enter Account Password:”

The user enters the Password.

A text info has been sent from the SIM.

Get information about this text.

Password correct, please wait for response”,0

SIM requests a bank account update from bank server via the network (SEND SMS)

AT+STGI=9

+STGI:

OK

********* After a short period of time. ********

+STIN: 5

+STGI=5

+STGI: 9,1,1

+STIN: 1

AT+STGI=1

+STGI: 0,”

OK

Get all information about the SEND SMS

“Send account balance of user, authorization ok”

Transaction is complete: BEEP

Get information about the Tone

Display text indication

Your account balance is 1000 $”,0

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 98

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT

Commands

Introductory Note

This chapter covers general CDMA provisioning commands; provisioning commands let you setup your service programming code, your mobile directory number, your browser gateway, your service options, etc. Some of the commands that follow will be useful for the average wireless user; others will be useful to programmers only.

Some parameters or commands discussed in this chapter may be re-defined by your network carrier. Your carrier will provide these commands for you. See also the printed Activation Notices that accompany the Multi-Tech wireless products.

What is Provisioning?

The Difference Between a Pre-Provisioned CDMA Module and a Generic CDMA Module

Pre-Provisioned CDMA Modules

Multi-Tech offers several pre-provisioned CDMA modules. Pre-provisioned builds are pre-programmed to operate only on a designated CDMA carrier’s network; for example, the MTSMC-C-N2 is pre-programmed

(provisioned) for use on the Sprint network in the USA.

Generic CDMA Modules

Multi-Tech also offers generic CDMA modules, for example, the MTSMC-C-N1 (Random A-Key) and MTSMC-C-

N9 (Zero A-Key)

. These generic SocketModems are not pre-programmed to operate on any designated CDMA carrier’s network.

Overview of the Provisioning Process

Requirements

• A generic CDMA module.

• CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide , Chapter 15.

• A developer software tool called WPST.

Procedures

Step 1.

Get the PRI and PRL from your wireless carrier.

Step 2. Set the provisioning commands, which are described in the AT Commands Reference Guide using the provisioning information provided by the CDMA wireless network carrier.

Step 3.

Using the WPST tool, download the carrier’s specific PRI (Provisioning Information) and PRL

(Preferred Roaming List) into the CDMA module.

The wireless modem is now provisioned and can be activated on your wireless carrier’s network, according to the carrier’s activation instructions.

See the Activation directions that accompany Multi-Tech wireless modems.

Provisioning Terminology

A-Key

The A-Key is a 64-bit cryptographic key variable stored in the semi-permanent memory of the mobile station and also known to the Authentication Center of the wireless carrier's system. The generation of the A-Key is the responsibility of the wireless service provider. It is established and entered when the mobile station is first put into service.

The CDMA network carrier you choose for you CDMA product will let you know whether it uses the Random

A-Key or the Zero A-Key in its authentication process. That will determine whether you purchase the -N1 or the –N9 build.

Provisioning

Provisioning is the programming of a CDMA wireless modem to set the PRI and PRL provided by wireless network carrier that you are have chosen as your CDMA wireless network carrier. After the modem is provisioned, it can then be activated on the wireless network for which it is provisioned.

PRI stands for Provisioning Information. Provisioning Information is your wireless network carrier’s profile of parameter settings that must be programmed into your wireless modem in order for it to operate on the carrier’s wireless network.

PRL stands for Preferred Roaming List. The PRL is a list of the wireless network service provider’s preferred roaming partners. This list is downloaded from your network service provider during the provisioning process.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 99

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Service Programming Code +WSPC

Description:

This command allows for entry of the service programming code (either MSL or OTKSL). Upon successful entry of this code, all other service provisioning AT commands may be used. If this code is not properly entered prior to attempting other provisioning AT commands, all provisioning commands will return ERROR.

If the OTKSL is used to enter provisioning mode, only the +WIMI, +WMDN, and +WCMT commands will be allowed. All other commands will return ERROR.

This command supports five attempts to enter the correct service programming code. If five incorrect attempts are performed, the ME will power down.

Once the correct SPC code is entered, the modem transitions to the Service Programming state. This state is not exited until a commit is done (+WCMT). While in the Service Programming state, subsequent validations of the SPC code are ignored until the Service Programming state is reset.

Values: <lock type>

0 OTKSL – One Time Key Subsidy Lock

1

MSL – Master Subsidy Lock

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WSPC=<lock type>,<code>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WSPC?

Note: Service programming code request

AT+WSPC=?

ERROR

Note: Invalid request

ERROR

Note: Invalid request

AT+WSPC=1,111111

Note: Enter service programming code 111111

AT+WSPC=1,000000

Note: Enter service programming code 000000

ERROR

Note: Code invalid

OK

Note: Code valid

Mobile Directory Number +WMDN

Description:

This command is used to enter a new mobile directory number. Valid numbers are between 10 and 15 digits in length. For support of Wireless Number Portability in all non-RUIM software versions, changes to the

MDN will update the IMSI_M portion (least significant 10 digits) of the IMSI. Changes to the MDN will also automatically update the Access Overload Class values unless specifically modified using the +WAOC command. Also, for non-RUIM software loads, the lock code value (+WPIN) is updated to the last 4 digits of the specified MDN value. The new IMSI_M and Access Overload Class values will not be visible in the WIMI and WAOC commands until after the changes are committed with the WCMT command.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WMDN=<number>

Command

AT+WMDN?

Note: Get current mobile directory number

AT+WMDN=8585551212

Note: Set mobile directory number to 8585551212

Possible Responses

+WMDN: 8581111111

OK

OK

Note:

For RUIM software releases, this command can be used without the need to have previously entered the

SPC (+WSPC command). The value for <number> can be up to 15 digits and does not effect the IMSI.

Set IMSI +WIMI

Description: This command is used to set the IMSI. Valid IMSI is 15 digits in length, MCC (3), MNC (2), MIN2 (3), MIN1

(7). For support of Wireless Number Portability, changes to the IMSI will NOT update the MDN. Changes to the IMSI will automatically update Access Overload Class values unless specifically modified using +WAOC.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WIMI=<number>

Command

AT+WIMI?

Note: Get current IMSI

AT+WIMI=310008585551212

Note: Set IMSI to 310008585551212

Possible Responses

+WIMI: 310008581111111

OK

OK

Note: For RUIM software releases, this command is not valid and will return “Error 3”.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 100

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

SID and NID +WSID

Description: This command is used to set the home SID and NID for 800Mhz CDMA operation only. The new SID/NID values are committed to NV with the +WCMT command.

Values: <index>

The location in the SID/NID list to store the values. A maximum of 20 entries (0-19) are supported. Error 22 is returned if the specified index value is not in the valid range.

<SID number>

SID value range – 0 to 32767.

<NID number> NID value range – 0 to 65535. Defaults to 65535 if not specified.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+ WSID=<index>,<SID number>,<NID number>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WSID?

Note: Get current SID and NID

+WSID: 1, 45, 84

OK

Note: The SID/NID pair 45,84 in location 1 is selected.

AT+WSID=3, 4145, 2102

AT+WSID?

Note: Set SID to 4145 and NID to 2102.

Store in location 3 of the SID/NID list.

OK

+WSID: 3, 4145, 2102

OK

Note: The SID/NID pair 4145,2102 in location 3 is selected.

AT+WSID=2

AT+WSID?

Note: Set SID to 0 and NID to 0. Store in location 2 of the SID/NID list.

AT+WSID=4, 64

AT+WSID?

Note: Set SID to 64 and NID to 0. Store in location 4 of the SID/NID list.

AT+WSID=, 64, 1024

AT+WSID?

Note: Set SID to 64 and NID to 1024.

Store in the currently selected location of the SID/NID list.

OK

+WSID: 2, 0, 0

OK

Note: The SID/NID pair 0,0 in location 2 is selected.

OK

+WSID: 4, 64, 0

OK

Note: The SID/NID pair 64,0 in location 4 is selected.

OK

+WSID: 4, 64, 1024

OK

Note: The SID/NID pair 64,1024 in location 4 is selected.

Access Overload Class +WAOC

Description:

This command is used to set the Access Overload Class.

Values: <number>

Access overload value range – 0 to 15.

Command

AT+WAOC?

Note: Get current Access Overload Class

AT+WAOC=7

Note: Set Access Overload Class to 7

Possible Responses

+WAOC: 5

OK

OK

Note:

For RUIM software releases, this command is not valid and will return “Error 3”.

Slot Cycle Index +WSCI

Description:

This command is used to set the slot cycle index.

Values:

<number> Slot cycle index, ranges from 0 to 7.

Syntax: Command

Command Possible Responses

AT+WSCI?

Note: Read the current slot cycle index

AT+WSCI=1

Note: Set the slot cycle index

+WSCI: 2

OK

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 101

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Primary Browser Gateway +WBGP

Description: This command is used to set the primary browser gateway IP address (Ipv4). If a browser is not natively supported by the modem, this command will return ERROR.

Values: <num>

0-255

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WBGP=<num>,<num>,<num>,<num>

Possible Responses

AT+WBGP?

Note: Get current gateway

AT+WBGP=255,255,255,0

Note: Set primary gateway to 255.255.255.0

+WBGP: 127,0,0,1

OK

OK

Secondary Browser Gateway +WBGS

Description:

This command is used to set the secondary browser gateway IP address (Ipv4). If a browser is not natively

Values: supported by the modem, this command will return ERROR.

<num>

0-255

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WBGS=< num >,< num >,< num >,< num >

Command Possible Responses

AT+WBGS?

Note: Get current primary gateway

AT+WBGS=255,21,255,0

Note: Set secondary gateway to 255.21.255.0

+WBGS: 127,0,0,1

OK

OK

Packet Dial String +WPDS

Description: This command is used to set the packet dial string.

Values: <string>

A string of length 1 to 15 characters.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WPDS=<string>

Command

AT+WPDS?

Note: Get current Packet Dial String

AT+WPDS=”#999”

Note: Set the Packet Dial String to #999

Possible Responses

+WPDS: ”#777”

OK Note: Current Packet Dial String is #777

OK

Primary CDMA Channels +WPCC

Description:

This command is used to set the primary CDMA channels for 800Mhz CDMA operation only. Values entered must be valid CDMA 800Mhz Channel numbers.

Values: <channel a number>

<channel b number>

Value range: 0 – 2047

Value range: 0 – 2047

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WPCC=<channel a number>,<channel b number>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WPCC?

Note: Get current primary CDMA channels

AT+WPCC=211,432

Note: Set the primary CDMA channels

+WPCC: 283,384

OK

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 102

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Secondary CDMA Channels +WSCC

Description:

This command is used to set the secondary CDMA channels for 800Mhz CDMA operation only. Values entered must be valid CDMA 800Mhz Channel numbers.

Values: <channel a number> Value range: 0 – 2047

<channel b number>

Value range: 0 – 2047

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WSCC=<channel a number>,<channel b number>

Command Possible responses

AT+WSCC?

Note: Get current secondary CDMA channels

AT+WPCC=511,632

Note: Set the secondary CDMA channels

+WPCC: 691,777

OK

OK

Service Option Management +WSOM

Description: This command is used to manage Service Options for EVRC. It will allow the user to enable EVRC, set home page, home origination, and roam origination voice service options for the current NAM. It is only available for software builds, which include EVRC Service Option Management feature.

Values: <enable> enable EVRC

<home page SO>

0

1

2

IS96A

EVRC

13k

IS96

3

4

WILDCARD

<home orig SO> & <roam orig SO>

0

IS96A

1

2

3

EVRC

13k

IS96

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WSOM=<enable>,<home page SO>,<home orig SO>,<roam orig SO>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WSOM?

Note: Get the Service Options of the current NAM

+WSOM: 0, 1, 2, 0

OK

Note: EVRC disabled, home page is set to EVRC, home

AT+WSOM=1,4,2,2

Note: Set current NAM Service

Options orig is set to 13k, roam orig is set to IS96A

OK

Note: EVRC enabled, set home page to WILDCARD, set home orig to 13k, set roam orig to 13k

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 103

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Commit Changes +WCMT

Description: This command is used to commit or to undo/revert any changes done during the service programming session. Changes performed during this session will not take place until a commit command has been sent

(AT+WCMT=1). Commission of these changes will force a software reset of the modem. Sending this command indicates this service provisioning session is complete. In order to perform any subsequent provisioning, the service programming code must be entered using the +WSPC command.

Values: <val>

0 undo changes

1 commit changes

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+WCMT=<val>

Command

AT+WCMT=0

Note: Undo any changes performed during this provisioning AT session

AT+WCMT=1

Note: Commit all changes performed during this provisioning AT session to non-volatile memory.

Possible Responses

OK

OK

Note: software reset is performed

Read SID/NID Entries +WSNR

Description:

This command is used to read the current SID/NID list entries. The displayed entry will always be the current value; including those changes made with the +WSID command prior to being committed to NV with the

+WCMT command.

Values: <index>

0-19

: Location in SID/NID list to read.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WSNR=<index>

Command

AT+WSNR=5

Note: Display entry 5 of SID/NID list.

AT+WSPC=1,000000

AT+WSNR=5

Note: Display entry 5 of SID/NID list.

AT+WSNR?

Note: Show last read SID/NID list index. Default: 0.

AT+WSNR=?

Note: Show SID/NID list index range.

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Service provisioning code not yet entered.

OK

Note: Service code successfully entered.

+WSNR: 5, 123, 65535

OK

Note: Entry 5 of SID/NID list contains 123,65535.

+WSNR: 5

OK

+WSNR: (0-19)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 104

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Download PRL +DPRL

Description:

This command is used to download a Preferred Roamer List (PRL) to the module. The PRL must be formatted in accordance with TIA/EIA-683-A. The PRL download process consists of a sequence of one or more +DPRL commands. Each command appends its associated PRL data to an internal buffer where it is held until the +WCMT command is issued. The maximum PRL size that is supported by the Q24x8 module is 8192 bytes.

The +DPRL command is part of the Wavecom suite of service programming commands. The module service programming code must be successfully entered (see +WSPC) prior to using this command.

Syntax:

The +DPRL command consists of parameters, a carriage return (0x0d) character, and PRL data bytes.

Required parameters include the target NAM number, current sequence number, last sequence number, and length of the PRL data in the sequence.

The host application must not use other AT commands until the number of bytes specified by the length parameter has been sent to the module and an OK or ERROR response is returned. There is no mechanism available to abort an in progress +DPRL command once it is started. The <length> specified number of

<PrlData> bytes must be sent.

An error will occur if the <nam> number changes or the sequence number is out of order. The <PrlData> associated with a failed +DPRL command is discarded. However, the <PrlData> associated with previously sent sequences remains valid. If the PRL is downloaded using a single +DPRL command, <cur_seq> and

<last_seq> should be set to zero.

Once the PRL has been successfully downloaded to the module, the +WCMT=1 command must be used to save the PRL to NV Ram and activate it. The PRL is validated as part of the commit operation and the results of this validation is returned using the +DPRL unsolicited response. A downloaded PRL that fails validation is not activated and the old PRL, if any, remains in effect.

To discard download PRL data prior to final commit, use the AT+WCMT=0 command. To re-start the download sequence, set the current sequence number (<cur_seq>) to zero. 16.15.2

Command syntax: AT+DPRL=<nam>,<cur_seq>,< last_seq>,<length><cr><PrlData>

Command

AT+WSPC=1,0000

Note: Enter service programming code.

AT+DPRL=1,0,0,4096<cr><byte1 … byte4096>

Note: Send complete Nam1 PRL.

AT+WCMT=1

Note: Activate new Nam1 PRL.

AT+WSPC=1,0000

Note: Enter service programming code.

AT+DPRL=2,0,2,99<cr><byte1 … byte99>

Note: Send Nam2 PRL part 1 of 3.

AT+DPRL=2,1,2,99<cr><byte1 … byte99>

Note: Send Nam2 PRL part 2 of 3.

AT+CGSN

Note: Other AT commands permitted after +DPRL

OK or ERROR response.

AT+DPRL=2,2,2,57<cr><byte1 … byte57>

Note: Send Nam2 PRL part 3 of 3.

AT+WCMT=1

Note: Activate new Nam2 PRL.

AT+DPRL=?

Note: Display parameter ranges.

AT+DPRL?

Note: Display last used parameter values.

Possible responses

OK

Note: Code successfully entered.

OK

Note: PRL stored in module.

+DPRL:0

Note: PRL validated.

OK

Note: Module software reset begins.

+WIND: 8

Note: Module software reset complete.

OK

Note: Code successfully entered.

OK

Note: Part 1 (99 bytes) stored in module.

OK

Note: Part 2 (99 bytes) stored in module.

+CGSN: FE7A7704

OK

OK

Note: Part 3 (57 bytes) stored in module.

+DPRL:0

Note: PRL validated.

OK

Note: Module software reset begins.

+WIND: 8

Note: Module software reset complete.

+DPRL: (1-2),(0-255),(0-255),(1-4096)

OK

Note: Valid parameter ranges.

+DPRL: 1,0,0,57

OK

Note: Parameter values displayed.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 105

Chapter 15 – Provisioning AT Commands

Defined values :

<nam>

NAM to receive the <PrlData>.

<cur_seq>

<last seq>

Sequence number of this PRL data packet. An error is returned if this value is greater than <last_seq> or is non-sequential with the previous <cur_seq> value. When set to zero, the current internal buffer contents is discarded prior to appending the <PrlData> bytes.

Sequence number of the last PRL data packet. The PRL is considered complete when <cur_seq> is equal to

<last_seq>. If the +WCMT=1 command is issued prior to <cur_seq> equal to <last_seq>, the downloaded

<length>

<cr>

PRL data will be discarded.

Length of <PrlData> expressed as a decimal number.

Carriage return character. Value 13 decimal or 0x0d hexadecimal.

PRL binary data. Once <length> bytes have been received by the module, the OK response is returned.

<PrlData>

Service Programming Example

Command

AT+WBGP=255,255,255,255

Note: Attempt to set the primary browser gateway

AT+WPDS?

Note: Get current Packet Dial String

AT+WSPC=1,000000

Note: Enter service programming code

AT+WPDS?

Note: Get current Packet Dial String

AT+WPDS=”#999”

Note: Set the Packet Dial String to #999

AT+WCMT=1

Note: Commit all changes performed during this provisioning

AT session to non-volatile memory.

AT+WSPC=1,000111

Note: Enter service programming code

AT+WSPC=1,000000

Note: Enter service programming code

AT+WPDS?

Note: Get current Packet Dial String

AT+WPDS=”#555”

Note: Set the Packet Dial String to #555

AT+WSCI?

Note: Read the current slot cycle index

AT+WSCI=1

Note: Set the slot cycle index

AT+WCMT=0

Note: Undo any changes performed during this provisioning

AT session.

AT+WSPC=1,000000

Note: Enter service programming code

AT+WPDS?

Note: Get current Packet Dial String

AT+WSCI?

Note: Read the current slot cycle index

Response

ERROR

Note: Service Programming code not yet entered

ERROR

Note: Service Programming code not yet entered

OK

Note: Service Programming code entered properly

+WPDS: ”#777”

OK

Note: Current Packet Dial String is #777

OK

OK

Note: software reset is performed

ERROR

Note: Service Programming code incorrect

OK

Note: Service Programming code entered properly

+WPDS: ”#999”

OK

Note: Current Packet Dial String is #999

OK

+WSCI: 2

OK

OK

OK

Note: No software reset since this is an undo command.

OK

Note: Service Programming code entered properly

+WPDS=”#999”

OK

Note: Current Packet Dial String is #999 (changes not committed from last write)

+WSCI: 2

OK

Note: Slot cycle index is 2 (changes not committed from last write)

OK AT+WMDN=8585551212

Note: Set mobile directory number to 8585551212

AT+WCMT=1

Note: Commit all changes performed during this provisioning

AT session to non-volatile memory.

OK

Note: software reset is performed

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 106

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Chapter 16 – Extended AT

Commands in IS707.3

Multi-Tech CDMA modem also implements the CDMA AT commands as specified in the TIA/EIA/IS-707.3. Refer to IS707.3 for more information about these commands (range, parameter definition, result codes, etc.).

Note: Some of the AT commands may not be supported by the network; please verify with your carrier as to its support of

IS707.3 commands.

Remote Async Command X

Description:

This command sends a CONNECT message when a connection is established by blind dialing and enables the additional result codes.

Syntax: Command syntax: ATX<n>

Command

ATX0

Note: Ignores dial tone and busy signal.

ATX1

Note: Disable dial tone and busy detection.

ATX2

Note: Disable busy detection & enable dial tone detection.

ATX3

Note: Enable busy detection & disable dial tone detection.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

ATX4

Note: Enable busy and dial tone detection.

OK

Note: Command is valid

Reset to Default Configuration Z0

Description: This command is used to reset to the default configuration.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATZ0

ATZ0

Note: reset to default configuration.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command is valid

Select Tone Dialing T

Description: This command is used to select tone dialing. Not relevant to CDMA data services; “T” is not sent in dial string.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

ATT

Possible Responses

ATT

Note: select tone dialing.

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 107

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Select Pulse Dialing P

Description:

This command is used to select pulse dialing. Not relevant to CDMA data services; “P” is not sent in dial string.

Syntax: Command syntax: ATP

Command

ATP

Note: select pulse dialing.

Possible Responses

OK

Note: Command is valid

Basic S-Registers S

Description:

The S-registers store configuration parameters that are used for dialing or during an established call. The value of an S-register may be set by using the syntax: ATSn=<value> where n is the register number and

Syntax

:

<value> is a decimal value.

Values: <n> ATS command index. Ranges from 0-11.

<value>

Command syntax:

Command

ATS<n>=<value>

Possible Responses

ATS<n>=<value>

Note: set S-registers value

OK

ATS0?

Note: Disable or enable automatic answering (value: 0-255)

0: Disable;

1-255: Enable after [(value-1)x6 sec.]

ATS3?

Note: Carriage return character

ATS4?

Note: Line feed character

ATS5?

Note: Backspace character

ATS6?

Note: Pause before blind dialing (value: 2-10)

002

OK

Note: always 3 characters padded with zeros

013

OK

010

OK

008

OK

002

OK

050

OK

ATS7?

Note: Number of seconds to establish end-to-end data connection (value: 1-255)

ATS8?

Note: Number of seconds to pause when “,” is encountered in dial string (value: 0-255)

ATS9?

Note: Carrier detect threshold in increments of 0.1 seconds

(value: 0-255)

ATS10?

Note: Number of tenths of a second from carrier loss to disconnect (value: 1-254)

Value 255: disable carrier detect

ATS11?

Note: DTMF tone duration and spacing in milliseconds

(value: 50-255)

002

OK

006

OK

014

OK

095

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 108

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Error Control Operation +EB

Description: This command is used for break handling in error control operations. The extended-format compound parameter is used to control the manner of V.42 operation on the PSTN line (if present in IWF). The command is not relevant for packet service.

Values: <Break_selection>

0

Ignore break (do not signal to remote DCE)

1 Non-expedited, non-destructive

2

Expedited, non-destructive

3 Expedited and destructive

<timed>

0 Any transmitted V.42 L-SIGNAL shall not indicate break signal length

1

Any transmitted V.42 L-SIGNAL shall indicate break signal length

<default_length>

0

Do not deliver break to DTE

1-254 Default break length of .01 to 2.54 seconds

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+EB=[<Break_selection>[,<timed>[,<default_length>]]]

Command Possible Responses

AT+EB?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+EB=2

Note: Set value to 2.

+EB: 1,0,30

OK

Note: This is the default setting

OK

Note: Command is valid

Numeric Parameter Control +EFCS

Description:

The extended-format numeric parameter is used to control the use of 32-bit frame check sequence option in

V.42 on the PSTN link (if present in IWF). The command is not relevant for packet service.

Values: <Val>

0

Use 16-bit FCS

1 Use 32-bit FCS if available in remote DCE; otherwise use 16-bit FCS

2

Use 32-bit FCS if available in remote DCE; otherwise disconnect

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+EFCS=[<Val>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+EFCS?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+EFCS=2

Note: Set value to 2.

+EFCS: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Error Control Report +ER

Description:

The extended-format numeric parameter is used to control whether the extended-format +ER intermediate result code is transmitted from the IWF over the interface.

Values: <Val>

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+ER=[<Val>]

Command

AT+ER?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+ER=1

Note: Set value to 1.

Possible Responses

+ER: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 109

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Error Control Selection +ES

Description: The extended-format compound parameter is used to control the manner of operation of the V.42 protocol on the PSTN link (if present in IWF). The command is not relevant for packet service.

Values: <orig_rqst>

Direct mode

2

3

<orig_fbk>

0 Error control optional; If error control not established maintain DTE-DCE data rate

1

Error control optional; If error control not established change DTE-DCE data rate to match line rate

2 Error control required; If error control not established, disconnect

3

Error control required (only LAPM acceptable); If error control not established, disconnect

4 Error control required (only alternative protocol acceptable); If error control not established, disconnect

<ans_fbk>

0 Direct mode

1

Error control disabled, use Buffered mode

2 Error control optional; If error control not established maintain DTE-DCE data rate

3

Error control optional; If error control not established change DTE-DCE data rate to match line rate

4 Error control required; If error control not established, disconnect

5

Error control required (only LAPM acceptable); If error control not established, disconnect

6 Error control required (only alternative protocol acceptable); If error control not established, disconnect

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+ES=[<orig_rqst>[,<orig_fbk>[,<ans_fbk>]]]

Possible Responses

AT+ES?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+ES=1

Note: Set value to 1.

AT+ES?

Note: Display the setting after change.

+ES: 3, 0, 2

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

+ES: 1, 0, 2

OK

Note: Command is valid

Error Control Selective Repeat +ESR

Description:

The extended-format numeric parameter is used to control the use of selective repeat (SREJ) option in V.42 on the PSTN link (if present in IWF). The command is not relevant for packet service.

Values: <Val>

0

Do not use SREJ

1 Use SREJ if available in remote DCE; continue without it if not

2

Use SREJ if available in remote DCE; disconnect if SREJ is not available

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+ESR=[<Val>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+ESR?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+ESR=1

Note: Set value to 1.

+ESR: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 110

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Error Control Selection +ETBM

Description:

The extended-format compound parameter is used to control the handling of data remaining in IWF buffers upon service termination. The command is not relevant for packet service.

Values: <pending_TD>

Attempt until all data is delivered and acknowledged (ignore timer)

2

<pending_RD>

Attempt until all data is delivered (ignore timer)

2

<timer>

0-30

Other: Higher values may be supported at manufacture’s option

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+ETBM=[<pending_TD>[,<pending_RD>[,<timer>]]]

Command Possible Responses

AT+ETBM?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+ETBM=1

Note: Set value to 1.

AT+ETBM?

Note: Display the current setting.

+ETBM: 0, 1, 20

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

+ETBM: 1, 1, 20

OK

Note: Command is valid

Request Manufacture Identification +GMI

Description:

The command is used to cause the DCE to transmit one or more lines of information text, determined by the manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the DCE to identify the manufacturer.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+GMI

Possible Responses

AT+GMI?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+GMI

Note: Display the manufacturer

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

+GMI: MODEM

OK

Note: Command is valid

Request Manufacture Identification +GMM

Description:

The command is used to cause the DCE to transmit one or more lines of information text, determined by the manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the DCE to identify the specific model of device.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+GMM

Command Possible Responses

AT+GMM?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+GMM

Note: Display the model

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

+GMM: Model 72

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 111

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Request Revision Identification +GMR

Description:

The command is used to cause the DCE to transmit one or more lines of information text, determined by the manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the DCE to identify the version, revision level or date, or other pertinent information of the device.

Note: When there is no stored PRL, the value displayed for the PRL ID will be 0.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+GMR

Command

AT+GMR?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+GMR

Note: Display the revision

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

+GMR: S/W VER: WISMOQ WQ1.8, 10015

OK

Note: Command is valid

Request Product Serial Number Identification +GSN

Description: The command is used to cause the DCE to transmit one or more lines of information text, determined by the manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the DCE to identify the individual alphanumeric string.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+GSN

Possible Responses

AT+GSN?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+GSN

Note: Display the serial number.

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

+GSN: F607A117

OK

Note: Command is valid

Request Global Object Identification +GOI

Description:

The command is used to cause the DCE to transmit one or more lines of information text, determined by the manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the DCE to identify the device, based on the ISO system for registering unique object identifiers.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+GOI

Possible Responses

AT+GOI?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+GOI

Note: Display the responses to the command

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

+GOI:

OK

Note: Command is valid

Note: Currently, no information text is provided.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 112

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Modulation Selection +MS

Description: The extended-format compound parameter is used to control the manner of operation of the modulation capabilities in the DCE.

Values: <carrier> manufacturer specific

<automode>

Disabled

1

<min_rate> & <min_rx_rate>

set to 0 if unspecified

<max_rate> & <max_rx_rate>

Syntax:

set to 0 if unspecified

Command syntax:

AT+MS=[<carrier>[,<automode>[,<min_rate>[,<max_rate>[,<min_rx_rate>

[,<max_rx_rate>]]]]]]

Command Possible Responses

AT+MS?

Note: Display the parameter information.

AT+MS=?

Note: Display the range of parameters

AT+MS=V21,1,1200,2400,1200,2400

Note: Display the range of parameters

+MS: V32B,1,1200,14400

Note: Command is valid

+MS: (V21,V22),(0,1,),(0,300-14400),(0,300-14400)

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Modulation Automode Control +MA

Description:

The extended-format compound parameter is a list of modulations that the DCE may use to connect with the remote DCE in automode operation, for answering or originating data calls.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+MA=[<carrier>[,<carrier>[,<carrier>[,…]]]]

Possible Responses

AT+MA?

Note: Display the parameter information.

+MA: V32, V32B

Note: Command is valid

AT+MA=?

Note: Display the range of parameters

+MA: (V32B,V32,V26B,V22B,V22,V21)

Note: Command is valid

AT+MA=V32

Note: Set to V32

OK

Note: Command is valid

Modulation Reporting Control +MR

Description:

The extended-format numeric parameter controls whether the extended-format +MCR:<carrier> and

+MRR:<rate> intermediate result codes are transmitted from the IWF to the mobile station.

Values: <Val>

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+MR=[<Val>]

Command

AT+MR?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+MR=?

Note: Display the range of setting.

AT+MR=1

Note: Enable reporting.

Possible Responses

+MR: 0

Note: Command is valid

+MR: (0,1)

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 113

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

V.18 Reporting Control +MV18R

Description:

The extended-format numeric parameter controls whether the extended-format +MV18R: result code is transmitted from the IWF to the mobile station.

Values: <Val>

Syntax : Command syntax: AT+MV18R=[<Val>]

Command Possible Responses

AT+MV18R?

Note: Display the current setting.

+MV18R: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

AT+MV18R=1

Note: Enable reporting.

OK

Note: Command is valid

V.18 Selection +MV18S

Description: The extended-format numeric parameter is used to control the manner of operation of the V.18 capabilities

(if present) in the DCE.

Values: <mode>

Disables V.18 connection

1

V.18 operation, connect in DTMF mode

4

V.18 operation, connect in V.21 mode

6

7

<dflt_ans_mode> disables V.18 answer operation

1

V.18 operation, connect in 5-bit mode

3

4

<fbk_time_enable> disable

1

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+MV18S=[<mode>[,<dflt_ans>[,<fbk_time_enable>]]]

Possible Responses

AT+MV18S?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+MV18S=1,1,1

Note: Set mode value to 1.

AT+MV18S?

Note: Display the current setting.

+MV18S: 0, 0, 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

+MV18S: 1, 1, 1

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 114

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Cellular Extension +CXT

Description

: The numeric parameter is used for cellular extension.

Values: <Val>

0

When detecting an unrecognized AT command, open transport layer connection and pass unrecognized command to the IWF.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CXT=<Val>

Possible Responses

AT+CXT?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CXT=?

Note: Display the range of setting.

AT+CXT=1

Note: Enable extension.

+CXT: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

+CXT: (0-1)

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Configuration String +CFG

Description: The string command is used to set configuration string. The string will be stored by the DCE and sent to the base station prior to dialing. Each transmission of an AT+CFG command from DTE replaces the contents of the previous string. The string may be up to 248 characters in length.

Syntax : Command syntax:

Command

AT+CFG?

AT+CFG=<string >

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CFG=””

Note: Reset the configuration string.

AT+CFG=”data”

Note: Set the configuration string.

Possible Responses

+CFG: “”

OK

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Query Service +CAD

Description: The numeric parameter is used to query analog or digital service.

Values: The command should return one of the following codes:

0

If CDMA digital service is available

2

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CAD

Command

AT+CAD?

Note: Display the current service.

AT+CAD=1

Note: Set the current service.

AT+CAD=?

Note: Display the available service values.

Possible Responses

+CAD: 1

OK

Note: Command is valid

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

+CAD:

OK

Note: Command is valid but no value ranges are returned.

Note:

This is a read-only command.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 115

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

U

m

Interface Data Compression Reporting +CDR

Description:

The extended-format numeric parameter is used to control whether the extended-format +CDR: intermediate result code is transmitted by the DCE. The result code is the same as for the TIA/EIS/IS-131 +DR:<result code>.

Values: <val>

Disable reporting.

1

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CDR=<val>

Possible Responses

AT+CDR?

Note: Display the current code

AT+CDR=1

Note: Reporting enabled

AT+CDR=?

Note: Display the range of code

+CDR: 0

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command valid

+CDR: (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

U

m

Interface Data Compression +CDS

Description: This command is an overloaded command that serves as an unsolicited SMS command and also as a data compression command (the unsolicited SMS command is explained in Chapter 21). This command has an extended-format numeric parameter that is used to control the V.42bis data compression function on the U m interface. The command format is the same as for the TIA/EIS/IS-131 +DS command.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CDS=<Val>

Possible Responses

AT+CDS?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CDS=0,1,1024,10

Note: Set the data compression.

+CDS: 0, 1, 2048, 6

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Specified values beyond the initial one are validated but ignored.

Note:

AT+CDS=?

Note: Display the range of setting.

+CDS: (0-0),(1-1),(512-65535),(6-250)

OK Note: Command is valid

Currently, modem accepts only 0 as a valid setting.

Set Rm Interface Protocol +CRM

Description: The numeric parameter is used for set the Rm interface protocol. The Rm interface protocol value is effected by the current $QCMIP setting. The Rm interface protocol can be set by the +CRM command only if

$QCMIP is set to zero (Mobile IP disabled, Single IP only).

Values: <Val>

Packet data service, Relay Layer Rm interface

2

Note: The values 3 and 4 are currently not supported.

3

Syntax:

Note:

Command syntax: AT+CRM=<Val>

Command

AT+CRM?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CRM=?

Note: Display the range of setting.

AT+CRM=1

Note: Set to 1.

Possible Responses

+CRM: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

+CRM: (0-2)

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

This default value for the +CRM parameter shall be 0 if this value is supported by the DCE.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 116

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Battery Charge +CBC

Description:

This command is used to query the current state of the modem power source. An estimate of the remaining capacity is included if a battery connection is in use.

Values : <BCS> Battery Charge Status:

0

Mobile connected to external power

2

Recognized power fault. Calls inhibited.

<BCL>

0 – 100 Remaining battery capacity is 0 – 100%.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CBC Read-only. Returns <BCS>,<BCL>

Possible Responses

AT+CBC?

Note: Display the current status

AT+CBC

+CBC: 0, 77

OK

Note: Command is valid

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

Command State Inactivity Timer +CQD

Description:

The numeric parameter is used to query and set the Command State Inactivity Timer.

Values: <val>

Ignored

1-255

Note: The default <val> shall be 10, corresponding to 50 seconds.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CQD=<val>

Possible Responses

AT+CQD?

Note: Display the current setting.

+CQD: 10

OK

Note: Command is valid

AT+CQD=0

Note: Set the value to 0.

OK

Note: Command is valid

Mobile Station IP Address +CMIP

Description: This read-only command is used to display the mobile station’s temporary IP address. The value displayed is in standard IP address format.

Note:

This command returns an IP value only during a data call when a temporary IP address has been assigned.

When not in a data call, this command returns “OK”.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CMIP?

AT+CMIP

Note: Display the current setting

Possible Responses

+CMIP: 198.229.142.90

OK

Note: Command is valid

AT+CMIP?

Note: Display the current setting

AT+CMIP

OK

Note: When no IP address assigned.

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 117

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Base Station IP Address +CBIP

Description:

This read-only command is used to display the base station’s temporary IP address. The value displayed is

Note

: in standard IP address format.

This command returns an IP value only during a data call when a temporary IP address has been assigned.

When not in a data call, this command returns “OK”.

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CBIP

Possible Responses

AT+CBIP?

Note: Display the current setting

AT+CBIP?

Note: Display the current setting

AT+CBIP

+CBIP: 198.229.142.65

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: No IP address assigned.

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

Serving System +CSS

Description: The numeric parameter is used to query the serving system.

Values: <Class>

800Mhz

2

<Band>

Cellular 800

PA – PF

PCS 1900

The mobile station is not registered

Note second will be the block (‘A’ – ‘F’).

<SID>

0 – 32767 The mobile station is registered with the system indicated.

99999

IS-95A

3

N/A

5

IS-2000

7

IS-2000A

(Base Station Protocol Revision In Use – Band Class 1/PCS)

1

2

3

IS-95B

6

<CHANNEL>

0 – Max RF Channel Number

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CSS Returns: <Class>,<Band>,<SID>,<BS_P_REV>,<CHANNEL>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CSS?

Note: Display the current setting.

+CSS: 2, PA, 4, 6, 384

OK

Note: Command is valid

AT+CSS=?

Note: Display the parameter range.

+CSS:

OK

Note: Command is valid however range display is not supported for this command due to carrier-specific requirements.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 118

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Select Multiplex Option +CMUX

Description:

The numeric parameter is used to select multiplex option. This command is used to set the maximum number of multiplex options on the forward and reverse links for MDR calls. If a reverse parameter value is not specified, it is set to the forward parameter value.

Values: <forward>

Hexadecimal value: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, A, B, C, D, F

<n>

Multiplex Option 1

2

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CMUX=<forward>,[<reverse>]

Possible Responses

AT+CMUX?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CMUX=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

AT+CMUX=1

Note: Set multiplex option 1.

+CMUX: C, 2

OK

Note: Command is valid

+CMUX: (1-9,A-D,F), (1,2)

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Hang-up Voice +CHV

Description:

The numeric parameter is used to Hang-up a voice call. It terminates a voice connection previously established up +CDV (dial voice) or $QCCAV (answer voice). The only valid parameter is zero, which is optional.

Values: <n>

Hang-up voice call

1-255

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+CHV<n>

Possible Responses

AT+CHV

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CHV0

Note: Hang up the call.

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 119

Chapter 16 – Extended AT Commands in IS707.3

Dial Command for Voice Calls +CDV

Description:

The numeric parameter is used to dial command for voice calls. The format of <dialstring> is identical to that for the ATD command. This command does not cause the DCE to change to the online state.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT+CDV=<dial_string>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CDV?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CDV=8583693450

Note: Dial for voice call.

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

OK

+WORG: 8583693450

+WCNT: 3

Note: Command is valid

U

m

Packet Data Inactivity Timer +CTA

Description:

This command is used to Set, Read, and Test the U m

Values: <val>

packet data inactivity timer.

Traffic Channel not released during inactivity periods.

1-255 or receiving RLP data frames on the U m

interface.

Syntax

:

Command syntax:

Command

AT+CTA=<val>

Possible Responses

AT+CTA ?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT+CTA=?

Note: Display valid parameter range.

AT+CTA=1

Note: Set to one second.

+CTA: 0

OK

Note: Command is valid

+CTA: (0-255)

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 120

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm

Defined AT Commands for

CDMA Operation

This section contains AT commands that are specified and developed by Qualcomm.

Note:

Mobile IP related AT commands work only on the modems that supported the MIP features.

Transition to Diagnostics Monitor $QCDMG

Description:

This command returns “OK” and then transitions the phone serial port to DM mode. DM mode runs at 38.4

Kbps and uses a proprietary half-duplex protocol.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCDMG

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCDMG

Note: Transition to DM port

OK

Note: Command is valid

Quick Net Connect $QCQNC

Description: This command is used to enable or disable the Quick Net Connect (QNC) feature.

Values: <Val>

Disable QNC capability. This means that packet Originations will use the Packet Data Service Option number.

Enable QNC capability. This means that Packet Originations will use the Async Data Service Option number.

Syntax : Command syntax: AT$QCQNC=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCQNC?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCQNC: 0

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCQNC=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCQNC=1

Note: Enable QNC compatibility

$QCQNC: (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Protocol Revision in Use $QCPREV

Description:

This command is used to query the protocol revision in use.

Values: The command will return one of the following codes:

1

IS-95A

4

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCPREV

Command

AT$QCPREV?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCPREV

Note: Display the of value

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCPREV: 6

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 121

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Originate M-to-M Packet Data Call $QCMTOM

Description:

This command is used to originate a Mobile-to-Mobile Packet Data call using the QUALCOMM proprietary

Service Option number.

Values: <number>

<number> is the phone number to dial. This command will originate a Mobile-to-Mobile Packet data call using the QUALCOMM-proprietary Service Option number 0x8003. This is a Rate Set 1 call.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCMTOM = ‘’<number>’’

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMTOM?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMTOM: “”

OK

Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMTOM =?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMTOM =”#777”

Note: Packet data call to the number

$QCMTOM: (20,21,23-7E)

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Dump RLP Protocol Statistics $QCRLPD

Description:

This command is used to dump the RLP statistics in ASCII format to the DTE. This does not apply to RLP 3 statistics (see $QCRL3D).

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCRLPD

Command

AT$QCRLPD?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCRLPD

Note: Dump RLP statistics data

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCRLPD:

Rx Data Cnt :0000 Tx Data Cnt :0000

….

OK

Note: Command is valid

Reset RLP Protocol Statistics $QCRLPR

Description:

This command is used to zero all the RLP statistics counters. This does not apply to RLP 3 statistics (see

$QCRL3R).

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCRLPR

Command

AT$QCRLPR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCRLPR

Note: Reset RLP statistics counter

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCRLPR:

OK

Note: Command is valid

Dump PPP Protocol Statistics $QCPPPD

Description: This command is used to dump the PPP statistics in ASCII format to the DTE.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCPPPD

Command

AT$QCPPPD?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCPPPD

Note: Dump PPP statistics information

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCPPPD:

In LCP :0000 Out LCP :0000

….

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 122

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Reset PPP Protocol Statistics $QCPPPR

Description: This command is used to zero all of the PPP statistics counters.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCPPPR

Command

AT$QCPPPR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCPPPR

Note: Reset PPP statistics counter

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCPPPR:

OK Note: Command is valid

Dump IP Protocol Statistics $QCIPD

Description:

This command is used to dump the IP statistics in ASCII format to the DTE.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCIPD

Command

AT$QCIPD?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCIPD

Note: Dump IP statistics information

Possible responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCIPD:

IP:

InReceives :0000 InHdrErrors :0000

….

OK Note: Command is valid

Reset IP Protocol Statistics $QCIPR

Description:

This command is used to zero all of the IP statistics counters.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCIPR

Command

AT$QCIPR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCIPR

Note: Reset IP statistics counter

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCIPR:

OK Note: Command is valid

Dump UDP Protocol Statistics $QCUDPD

Description: This command is used to dump the UDP statistics in ASCII format to the DTE.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCUDPD

Command

AT$QCUDPD?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCUDPD

Note: Dump UDP statistics information

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCUDPD:

InDatagrams :0000 OutDatagrams :0000

….

OK Note: Command is valid

Reset UDP Protocol Statistics $QCUDPR

Description: This command is used to zero all of the UDP statistics counters.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCUDPR

Command

AT$QCUDPR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCUDPR

Note: Reset UDP statistics counter

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCUDPR:

OK Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 123

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Dump TCP Protocol Statistics $QCTCPD

Description:

This command is used to dump the TCP statistics in ASCII format to the DTE.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCTCPD

Command

AT$QCTCPD?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCTCPD

Note: Dump TCP statistics information

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCTCPD:

ActiveOpens :0000 PassiveOpens

:0000

….

OK Note: Command is valid

Reset TCP Protocol Statistics $QCTCPR

Description

: This command is used to zero all of the TCP statistics counters.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCTCPR

Command

AT$QCTCPR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCTCPR

Note: Reset TCP statistics counter

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCTCPR:

OK Note: Command is valid

Set Data Service Option $QCSO

Description: This command is used to Set Data Service Option number set; saves to non-volatile memory.

Values: <Val>

Syntax: proprietary SO numbers (RS 1: Async 4, packet 7; RS 2: Async 0x8021, packet 0x8020)

2

Command syntax:

AT$QCSO =<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCSO?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCSO =?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCSO =1

Note: Set proprietary SO numbers.

$QCSO: 2

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCSO: (0-2)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Clear Mobile Error Log $QCCLR

Description: This command is used to clear the mobile error log.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCCLR

Command

AT$QCCLR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCCLR

Note: Clear the mobile error log

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCCLR:

OK Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 124

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Answer Incoming Voice Call $QCCAV

Description:

This command is used to provide a means to answer an incoming voice call via an AT command.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCCAV

Command

AT$QCCAV

Note: Answer incoming voice call

Possible Responses

OK

+WCNT: 3 Note: Command is valid

Automatic Packet Detection $QCPKND

Description: This command is used to enable or disable Automatic Packet Detection after a dial command.

Values: <Val>

0

(that is, ATD#nnn e.g. ATD#777), then the mobile will originate a Packet (or QNC) data call.

Enable Packet No Dial. Reception of a PPP packet without a just prior dial command will NOT

Originate a PPP packet (or QNC) call.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCPKND=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCPKND?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCPKND: 0

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCPKND=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCPKND=1

Note: Enable Packet No Dial

$QCPKND: (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Pre-arrangement Setting $QCVAD

Description:

This command is used to respond to a page message that has a voice service option with a page response that has a data service option.

Values: <Val>

0

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCVAD= <Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCVAD?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCVAD=?

Note: Display the range of values

$QCVAD: 0

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCVAD: (0-4)

OK Note: Command is valid

Set DM Baud Rate $QCDMR

Description:

This command is used to set the DM baud rate.

Values: <Val> value should be one of the following: 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCDMR= <Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCDMR?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCDMR: 19200

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCDMR=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCDMR=115200

Note: Set DM baud rate to 115200

$QCDMR: (19200, 38400, 57600, 115200, 230400, 460800)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 125

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Set Medium Data Rate $QCMDR

Description: This command is used to Set Medium Data Rate (MDR); also known as HSPD setting.

Values: <Val>

0 any other service option if SO 22 and SO 25 are unavailable.

1

Speed Packet service option if MDR is not available. The mobile will not negotiate to SO 33.

2

SO 22, SO 25, or SO 33.

3 is not available.

Syntax : Command syntax: AT$QCMDR=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMDR?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMDR=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMDR=1

Note: Set value to 1

$QCMDR: 3

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCMDR: (0-3)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Dump RLP 3 Protocol Statistics $QCRL3D

Description:

This command is used to dump the RLP 3 statistics in ASCII format to the DTE. This does not apply to other versions of RLP (see $QCRLPD).

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCRL3D

Command

AT$QCRL3D?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCRL3D

Note: Dump RLP 3 statistics information

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCRL3D:

Rx Data Cnt :00000000 Tx Data Cnt :00000000

….

OK Note: Command is valid

Reset RLP 3 Protocol Statistics $QCRL3R

Description:

This command is used to reset the RLP 3 protocol statistics.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCRL3R

Command

AT$QCRL3R?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCRL3R

Note: Reset TCP statistics counter

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCRL3R:

OK Note: Command is valid

SCRM’ing Selection $QCSCRM

Description: This command is used to enable or disable the mobile from SCRM’ing.

Values: <Val>

0

Note:

Syntax:

Command only applies to SO 33 calls. This value is stored in NV. The default is 1.

Command syntax:

AT$QCSCRM= <Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCSCRM?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCSCRM =?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCSCRM =0

Note: Set value to 0

$QCSCRM: 1

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCSCRM: (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 126

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

R-SCH Throttling Selection $QCTRTL

Description: This command is used to enable or disable mobile R-SCH throttling.

Values: <Val>

0

: Mobile never throttles R-SCH

1 : Mobile can throttle R-SCH as needed.

Note: Command only applies to SO 33 calls. This value is stored in NV. The default is 1. For MSM500, MSM5105, and MSM5100 ASICs only.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCTRTL=<Val>

Command

AT$QCTRTL?

Note: Display the current setting

Possible Responses

$QCTRTL: 1

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCTRTL =?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCTRTL =0

Note: Set value to 0

$QCTRTL: (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

R-SCH IP Selection $QCMIP

Description : This command is used to enable or disable mobile IP.

The default value is carrier-specific.

Values:

Note 1:

<Val>

Mobile IP disabled, Simple IP only.

1 mobile automatically reverts to Simple IP (force a PPP renegotiation by sending a LCP C-Req).

However, if a Mobile IP session is registered, and then enters a network that does not support Mobile

IP, the mobile will drop the session and inform the upper layers of the failure (for example, by dropping DCD to a laptop).

Mobile IP only. The mobile will make data calls only when Mobile IP is supported in the network.

During a MIP session, if the mobile hands off to a network that does not support MIP, then the mobile will drop the session and inform the upper layers of the failure (for example, by dropping DCD to a laptop). This value is stored in NV. The default value is 0.

When the AT$QCMIP value is changed to 1 or 2, this modifies the value of AT+CRM to 2. AT+CRM with a value of 2 enables network model operation. Changing the value to 0 will reset the AT+CRM to its original value.

Note 2:

Note 3:

This change is not supported by DMSS 5105 Release 1.0 Commercial.

When the AT$QCMIP value is changed to 1 or 2, this modifies the value of AT$QCMDR to 3.

AT$QCMDR=3 means that the mobile tries Service Option 33 when it is in a cdma2000 network that advertises P_REV 6 or higher. When AT$QCMIP >0 and an attempt is made to set AT$QCMDR to less than

3, the mobile will return ERROR.

Note 4:

Note 5:

Syntax:

When the AT$QCMIP value is set to 1 or 2, this changes the value of AT$QCPKND to 0. This means that the mobile must see a dial string (such as ATDT#777) on the serial interface before it will originate packet data calls. When AT$QCMIP >0 and an attempt is made to set AT$QCPKND to 1, the mobile returns

ERROR.

This AT command is for test purposes only and should not be changed by the mobile phone user.

Command syntax: AT$QCMIP=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIP?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMIP: 1

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMIP=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIP=0

Note: Set value to 0

$QCMIP: (0-2)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 127

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

MIP Selection $QCMIPP

Description:

This command is used to select and activate an MIP user profile.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPP

Command

AT$QCMIPP?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPP=2

Note: Set to user profile 2

AT$QCMIPP=?

Note: Display the range of values

Possible Responses

$QCMIPP: 0

Note: User profile 1 is currently used

OK

Note: Command is valid

$QCMIPP: (0-5)

OK Note: Command is valid

Note: Takes a profile number between 0 and 5. This value is stored in NV. This AT command is used to configure

Dial-Up Networking.

RFC2002bis Selection $QCMIPT

Description:

This command is used to enable or disable the use of rfc2002bis authentication.

Values: <Val>

Use of rfc2002bis authentication is disabled. Rfc2002 style authentication is used instead.

1

Note:

This AT command is for test purposes only and should not be changed by the mobile phone user.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPT=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPT?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPT=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPT=0

Note: Set value to 0

$QCMIPT: 1

OK

Note: Command is valid

$QCMIPT: (0-3)

OK

Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Current Active Profile $QCMIPEP

Description: This command is used to enable or disable the currently active profile.

Values: <Val>

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCMIPEP=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPEP?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMIPEP: 1

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMIPEP=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPEP=0

Note: Set value to 0

$QCMIPEP: (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 128

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Return Profile Information $QCMIPGETP

Description:

This command is used to return all information corresponding to the specified profile number.

Values: <Val>

Note:

Syntax:

If no profile number is entered, all information corresponding to the currently active profile is returned. If there is no profile associated with the specified number, an error is returned.

Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPGETP=<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPGETP?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPGETP=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$ CMIPGETP=0

Note: Set value to 0

ERROR

Note: Command is not valid

$QCMIPGETP: (0-5)

OK Note: Command is valid

Profile:0 Enabled

…..

OK Note: Command is valid

Set NAI for Active Profile $QCMIPNAI

Description: This command is used to set the network access identifier (NAI) for the currently active profile.

Values: <String> The network access identifier text to be stored.

<Val>

Do not commit to NV

1

Note 1:

Note 2:

Double quotes are only required if the string contains a command.

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted at the end of the following call if $QCMIPP is called.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPNAI=<String>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPNAI?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPNAI=?

Note: Display the range of accepted character values.

[email protected],0

Note: Non-committed value set

[email protected],1

OK

Note: Command is valid

$QCMIPNAI: (20,21,23-7E),(0-1)

OK

Note: ASCII hexadecimal character range supported by this command. (All non-control codes.)

OK

Note: NAI is now: [email protected]

Set Reverse Tunneling $QCMIPRT

Description:

This command is used to set the reverse tunneling currently active profile.

Values: <Val1>

Do not request reverse tunneling

1

<Val2>

Note:

Syntax: f the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted at the end of the following call if $QCMIPP is called.

Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPRT=<Val1>, <Val2>

Command

AT$QCMIPRT?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPRT=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPRT=1,1

Note: Set value to 1 and commit

Possible Responses

$QCMIPRT: 1,1

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCMIPRT: (0-1), (0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 129

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

$QCMIPMASS

Description:

This command is used to set MN-AAA shared secrets for the currently active profile.

Values:

Note 1:

Note 2:

Syntax:

<String> The shared secret text to be stored.

<Val>

Do not commit to NV

1

Double quotes are only required if the string contains a command.

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted at the end of the following call if $QCMIPP is called.

Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPMASS =<String>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPMASS?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMIPMASS: Set

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMIPMASS=?

Note: Display the range of accepted character values.

AT$QCMIPMASS= my5ecretC0de,0

Note: Non-committed value set

$QCMIPMASS: (20,21,23-7E),(0-1)

OK Note: ASCII hexadecimal character range supported by this command. (All non-control codes.)

OK

Note: MN-AAA is now: my5ecretC0de

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

$QCMIPMHSS

Description:

This command is used to set MN-HA shared secrets for the currently active profile.

Values: <String>

The shared secret text to be stored.

<Val>

Note 1:

Note 2:

Syntax:

Double quotes are only required if the string contains a command.

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted at the end of the following call if $QCMIPP is called.

Command syntax:

AT$QCMIPMHSS =<String>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPMHSS?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMIPMHSS: Set

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMIPMHSS=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPMHSS=20,0

Note: Set value to 20, 0

$QCMIPMHSS: (20,21,23-7E),(0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in HEX Active Profile

$QCMIPMASSX

Description: This command is used to set MN-AAA shared secret for the currently active profile in HEX.

Values:

Note:

Syntax:

<HEX> Hex value from 0 to FFFFFFFF

<Val>

Do not commit to NV

1

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted at the end of the following call if $QCMIPP is called.

Command syntax: AT$QCMIPMASSX =<HEX>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPMASSX?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPMASSX=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPMASSX=FF,0

Note: Set value to 0xFF, but not commit

$QCMIPMASSX: Set

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCMIPMASSX: (0-FFFFFFFF),(0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 130

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in HEX Active Profile

$QCMIPMHSSX

Description :

Values:

This command is used to set MN-HA shared secret for the currently active profile in HEX.

<HEX>

Hex value from 0 to FFFFFFFF

<Val>

Note: If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted at the end of the following call if $QCMIPP is called.

Syntax:

Command

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPMHSSX?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMIPMHSSX: Set

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMIPMHSSX=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPMHSSX=FF,0

Note: Set value to 0xFF, but not commit

$QCMIPMHSSX: (0-FFFFFFFF),(0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

$QCMIPMASPI

Description:

This command is used to set MN-AAA SPIs for the currently active profile.

Values: <SPI>

SPI value from 0 to 4294967295

<Val>

Note:

Syntax:

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted if the modem is power cycled or if the $QCMIPP command is used.

Command syntax: AT$QCMIPMASPI =<SPI>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPMASPI?

Note: Display the current setting

AT$QCMIPMASPI=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPMASPI=2300,0

Note: Set value to 2300, but not commit

$QCMIPMASPI: 1234,1

OK Note: Command is valid

$QCMIPMASPI: (0-4294967295),(0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

$QCMIPMHSPI

Description: This command is used to set MN-HA SPIs for the currently active profile. Two arguments – SPI value and one of the values: 0 and 1.

Values: <SPI>

<Val>

SPI value from 0 to 4294967295

Do not commit to NV

1

Note:

Syntax:

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted if the modem is power cycled or if the $QCMIPP command is used.

Command syntax: AT$QCMIPMHSPI =<SPI>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPMHSPI?

Note: Display the current setting

$QCMIPMHSPI: 1234,1

OK Note: Command is valid

AT$QCMIPMHSPI=?

Note: Display the range of values

AT$QCMIPMHSPI=5500,0

Note: Set value to 5500, but not commit

$QCMIPMHSPI: (0-4294967295),(0-1)

OK Note: Command is valid

OK

Note: Command is valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 131

Chapter 17 – Qualcomm Defined AT Commands for CDMA Operation

Set Primary HA IP Address $QCMIPPHA

Description: This command is used to set the primary HA address of the mobile for the currently active profile. The command takes two arguments, a string corresponding to the IP address of the HA to be stored and a number (either 0 or 1) indicating whether or not to commit this value to NV. The IP address should be formatted in standard dotted-decimal notation, e.g. “10.1.1.20”.

Values: <IP> IP address in standard dotted-decimal notation, e.g. “10.1.1.20”.

<Val>

Do not commit to NV

1

Note: If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted if the modem is power cycled or if the $QCMIPP command is used.

Syntax : Command syntax: AT$QCMIPPHA =<IP>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPPHA?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT$QCMIPPHA =?

Note: Display the range of values.

AT$QCMIPPHA =10.1.2.15,1

Note: Set to 10.1.2.15, and commit to NV.

$QCMIPPHA: 10.1.1.20, 0

OK

$QCMIPPHA: ((0-255).(0-255).(0-255).(0-255)),(0-1)

OK

OK

Set Secondary HA IP Address $QCMIPSHA

Description: This command is used to set the secondary HA address of the mobile for the currently active profile. The command takes two arguments, a string corresponding to the IP address of the HA to be stored and a number (either 0 or 1) indicating whether or not to commit this value to NV. The IP address should be formatted in standard dotted-decimal notation, e.g. “10.1.1.20”.

Values: <IP> IP address in standard dotted-decimal notation, e.g. “10.1.1.20”.

<Val>

Do not commit to NV

1

: Commit to NV

Note: If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted if the modem is power cycled or if the $QCMIPP command is used.

Syntax: Command syntax: AT$QCMIPSHA =<IP>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPSHA?

Note: Display the current setting.

AT$QCMIPSHA =?

Note: Display the range of values.

AT$QCMIPSHA =10.1.2.15,1

Note: Set to 10.1.2.15, and commit to NV.

$QCMIPSHA: 10.1.1.20, 0

OK

$QCMIPSHA: ((0-255).(0-255).(0-255).(0-255)),(0-1)

OK

OK

Set Home HA IP Address $QCMIPHA

Description: This command is used to set the home HA address of the mobile for the currently active profile. The command takes two arguments, a string corresponding to the IP address of the HA to be stored and a number (either 0 or 1) indicating whether or not to commit this value to NV. The IP address should be formatted in standard dotted-decimal notation, e.g. “10.1.1.20”.

Values:

Note:

Syntax:

<IP>

IP address in standard dotted-decimal notation, e.g. “10.1.1.20”.

<Val>

Do not commit to NV

1

If the value provisioned is not committed to NV, the temporary value will be deleted if the modem is power cycled or if the $QCMIPP command is used.

Command syntax: AT$QCMIPHA =<IP>,<Val>

Command Possible Responses

AT$QCMIPHA?

Note: Display the current setting.

$QCMIPHA: 10.1.1.20, 0

OK

AT$QCMIPHA =?

Note: Display the range of values.

AT$QCMIPHA =10.1.2.15,1

Note: Set to 10.1.2.15, and commit to NV.

$QCMIPHA: ((0-255).(0-255).(0-255).(0-255)),(0-1)

OK

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 132

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT

Commands

This section details the AT commands that are available with the TCP App feature. This feature provides functionality for establishing multiple TCP and UDP compliant non-blocking socket connections over an IP network while retaining AT command level control of the modem.

The TCP App feature includes a set of AT commands and unsolicited responses for host application initialization and control of its functionality. The following table summarizes the AT commands and responses that are used with the TCP App feature.

Command

AT+WPPP

AT+WOSK

Description

Start or end a PPP session

Open a socket

AT+WCSK

AT+WSTX

AT+WSRX

AT+WGSS

AT+WTMO

AT+WCRX

AT+WIPC

AT+WDNS

AT+WFDM

Close a socket

Transmit socket data

Receive polled socket data

Display connection status

Configure socket transmit timeout

Configure receive data mode

Show current module IP address

IP address lookup

Force dormant mode

Response

+WPPP

+WSKS

+WSKE

+WSTX

Description

PPP session status

Socket state change

Socket open/close error

Socket data transmission status

+WSTE

+WSRX

+WSRE

Socket data transmission error

Received socket data

Socket data error

A number of standard AT commands are not available when the TCP App feature is in use; that is, a AT+WPPP session has been successfully started. See Chapter 20 for a list of these restricted AT commands. The ERROR result will be returned in their attempted use.

+WDOR

+WDNS

Dormant mode status change

DNS lookup indication

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 133

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Start/End PPP Connection +WPPP

Description:

This command is used to open or close a PPP session with the carrier. This includes the starting or stopping of the associated CDMA 1xRTT data call. The module must be in the idle state (no call in progress) when a new PPP session is requested; otherwise, an error will be returned. When closing the PPP session, all open sockets are also closed.

Values: <mode>

Initiates a 1xRTT data call, either MIP or SIP, with no userID or password. If SIP is used, then the userID and password provisioned in the module NVRAM are used.

Initiates a 1xRTT data call, either MIP or SIP, using the specified userID and password. If SIP is used, then the specified userID and password is used.

Closes the PPP session and ends the data call. All open TCP/UDP sockets must be closed prior to issuing this command.

<userID> The user identification string to be used to authenticate the SIP connection.

<password>

Note: A MIP data call does not require a userID or password.

Syntax: Command

AT+WPPP=<mode>,<userID>,<password>

Command

AT+WPPP=0

Note: Start a data call and initiate a PPP session.

AT+WPPP=2

Note: End the PPP session.

AT+WPPP=1,”johndoe”,”mypassword”

Note: Start a PPP session using the specified account information.

AT+WPPP?

Note: Show last used command parameters.

Possible responses

OK

+WPPP:201 (negotiating)

+WPPP:200 (connected)

Note: PPP session started.

OK

+WPPP:203 (closing)

+WPPP:202 (disconnected)

Note: PPP session ended.

OK

+WPPP:201 (negotiating)

+WPPP:202 (disconnected)

Note: PPP session failed. Possible invalid account.

+WPPP: 1,”johndoe”,”mypassword”

OK

Note: Last used command parameters displayed.

Open Socket +WOSK

Description: This command is used to open a socket connection to a server. A PPP session must be established prior to issuing this command using the AT+WPPP=0 command. The socket connection type, IP address, and IP port number must be specified. The +WOSK command returns an immediate response that indicates the socket number that will be associated with the connection request.

A total of four concurrent open socket connections are supported. Any combination of the supported socket types are permitted. The +WSKE unsolicited response is used to report errors associated with opening socket connections.

For TCP sockets, once the connection with the server is actually established or has failed, the +WSKS unsolicited response will be returned to the host application.

For UDP sockets, the +WSKS unsolicited response is returned immediately to the host application following socket initialization. UDP socket connections are open ended and connectivity with the target server is not verified as part of the open socket command. A subsequent application layer step is necessary to verify socket connectivity.

Values: <type>

0

Not to be distributed or divulged without prior written agreement. Ce document est la propriété exclusive de WAVECOM. Il ne peut être communiqué ou divulgué à des tiers sans son autorisation préalable.

1

<ip1 – ip4> The IP address to use for this socket connection. The valid range for each portion of the IP address is 0 – 255. Ip1 is the MSB and ip4 is the LSB of the IP address. Note that the four IP address parts must be comma separated.

<port> range 0 to 65535.

Response Values

<type>

0

UDP

<socket>

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 134

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Syntax: Command

AT+WOSK=<type>,<ip1 – ip4>,<port>

Immediate response syntax:

Command

+WOSK: <type>,<socket>

Possible responses

AT+WOSK=0,123,66,0,43,78

Note: Start a TCP socket connection to IP address

123.66.0.43 using port 78.

AT+WOSK=1,127,75,8,101,3298

Note: Start a UDP socket connection to IP address 127.75.8.101 using port 3298. Two other

UDP sockets are already open.

AT+WOSK?

Note: Show last used command parameters.

AT+WOSK=0,123,16,98,6,28

Note: Attempt a TCP socket connection.

AT+WOSK=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

+WOSK: 0,0

OK

+WSKS: 0,0,1

Note: TCP socket zero is open.

+WOSK: 1,2

OK

+WSKS: 1,2,1

Note: UDP socket two is open.

+WOSK: 1,127,75,8,101,3298

OK

Note: Last used command parameters displayed.

+WOSK: 0,1

OK

+WSKE: 0,1,115

Note: Connection refused.

+WOSK: (0-1),(0-255),(0-255),(0-255),(0-255),(0-65535)

OK

Close Socket +WCSK

Description:

This command is used to close an open or initializing socket connection. A valid socket type and number must be specified. If a valid open socket is specified, shutdown of the specified socket is initiated. Once the socket is actually closed, the +WSKS unsolicited response will be returned.

Values: <type>

0

1

Syntax Command syntax:

AT+WCSK=<type>,<socket>

Command Possible responses

AT+WCSK=0,1

Note: Close TCP socket connection one.

AT+WCSK=1,2

Note: Close UDP socket connection two.

AT+WCSK?

Note: Show last used command parameters.

OK

+WSKS: 0,1,4

Note: TCP socket closed.

OK

+WSKS: 1,2,4

Note: UDP socket closed.

+WCSK: 1,2

OK

Note: Last used command parameters displayed.

AT+WCSK=0,7

Note: Close TCP socket connection seven.

AT+WCSK=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

ERROR

+WSKE: 0,7,100

Note: Invalid socket number specified.

+WCSK: (0-1),(0-3)

OK

Transmit Socket Data +WSTX

Description:

This command is used to transmit data to a socket connection. The socket must be opened prior to issuing this command. The socket type, socket number, and the number of bytes to transmit must be specified. The maximum number for bytes for the payload portion of this command is dependent on the socket type; TCP sockets: 536 bytes, UDP sockets: 1330 bytes.

A carriage return character is required after the <type>, <socket>, and <length> parameters. The <cr> character (0x0d) causes the module to change modes and process <length> number of payload bytes from the serial port. Once <length> number of payload bytes have been processed, an OK is returned and the

<payload> is then transmitted on the specified socket connection. All bytes received on the module serial port will be interpreted as payload until <length> bytes are processed. If <length> bytes are not sent, a timeout and ERROR return will occur after the AT+WTMO specified time value (default 500 milliseconds).

Partial payload data for a timed out AT+WSTX command will be discarded.

Values: <type>

TCP

1

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 135

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

The number of bytes in the payload parameter not including the required <cr> character. This value is an ASCII character decimal number. TCP range 1 – 536, UDP range 1 – 1330.

Required separator character; value 0x0d.

<payload> document is the sole and exclusive property of WAVECOM. Not to be distributed or divulged without prior written agreement. Ce document est la propriété exclusive de WAVECOM. Il ne peut être communiqué ou divulgué à des tiers sans son autorisation préalable.

Note:

This command functions only when a traffic channel is present or the module is not dormant.

Syntax: Command

AT+WSTX=<type>,<socket>,<length><cr><payload>

Command Possible responses

AT+WSTX=0,0,4<cr>0x54 0x45 0x53 0x54

Note: Transmit “TEST” on TCP socket zero.

AT+WSTX=0,1,4<cr>0x54 0x45 0x53 0x54

Note: Transmit “TEST” on TCP socket one.

AT+WSTX=1,2,4<cr>0x54 0x45 0x53 0x54

Note: Transmit “TEST” on UDP socket two.

OK

+WSTX: 0,0,4

Note: Payload transmitted.

ERROR

+WSTE: 0,1,114

Note: Socket not connected error.

OK

+WSTX: 1,2,4

Note: Payload transmitted.

AT+WSTX?

Note: Show last used command parameters.

+WSTX: 1,2,4

OK

Note: Last used command parameters displayed.

Read Receive Data +WSRX

Description:

This command is used to read and clear the socket receive data buffer when received data polling has been specified by the +WCRX command for the socket type. A valid socket type and socket number must be specified and the socket must be open. The +WSRX unsolicited response is used to return the received socket data to the host application.

Values:

The software returns payload data up to approximately 600 bytes using a single +WSRX unsolicited response. This limit does not effect TCP sockets since the maximum TCP packet size is 536 bytes. For UDP sockets, where the payload packet size can be larger, multiple +WSRX unsolicited responses will be used as necessary to return the packet data to the host application. Each response will contain the next sequential part of the received UDP packet data. When using received data polling and a large UDP packet size, the host application must be designed to handle multiple +WSRX responses for each AT+WSRX command that is issued.

<type>

TCP

1

Syntax: Command AT+WSRX=<type>,<socket>

Command Possible responses

+WSKS: 0,1,2

AT+WSRX=0,1

Note: Read the pending TCP data.

Note: Data available on TCP socket one.

+WSRX: 0,1,536:TEST …

OK

Note: Data “TEST” read from TCP socket one input buffer.

Input buffer cleared.

AT+WSRX=1,2

Note: Read the pending UDP data.

AT+WSRX?

Note: Show last used command parameters.

AT+WSRX=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

+WSKS: 1,2,2

Note: Data available on UDP socket two.

+WSRX: 1,2,600:TEST …

+WSRX: 1,2,300: …

OK

Note: A 900 byte packet beginning with “TEST” read from

UDP socket two input buffer. Input buffer cleared.

+WSRX: 1,2

OK

Note: Last used command parameters displayed.

+WSRX: (0-1),(0-3)

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 136

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Display Connection Status +WGSS

Description:

Values:

This command is used to display the current status of the specified socket type. This information includes the PPP link state, the receive data mode, and the connection state of each potential socket. 20.6.2

<type>

0

Response Values

<type>

0

<PPPstate>

PPP Closed

1

PPP Open

<RxMode>

Unsolicited; the +WSRX response is sent when socket data is received.

<SocketState>

Socket Closed

1

Syntax: Command AT+WGSS=<type>

Immediate response:

+WGSS: <type>,<PPPstate>,<RxMode>,<SocketState>[,<SocketState>, …]

Command Possible responses

AT+WGSS=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

AT+WGSS=0

Note: Display the TCP connection status.

+WGSS: (0-1)

OK

Note: Parameter ranges displayed.

+WGSS: 0,2,1,2,1,0,0

OK

Note: PPP layer is open, unsolicited receive data mode, TCP socket zero is open, TCP socket one is initializing, TCP sockets 3 and 4 are closed.

AT+WGSS=1

Note: Display the UDP connection status.

+WGSS: 1,2,0,2,0,0,0

OK

Note: PPP layer is open, polled receive data mode,

UDP socket zero is open.

Configure Socket Transmit Timeout +WTMO

Description: This command is used to configure the socket transmit timeout value. This value is used whenever the

AT+WSTX command is issued by the host application. The timeout value specifies the maximum amount of time to wait for the data portion of the AT+WSTX command. An ERROR is returned to the host application if the timer expires.

Syntax Command syntax:

AT+WTMO=<time>

Command

AT+WTMO=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

AT+WTMO=1000

Note: Set timeout value to 1 second.

AT+WTMO?

Note: Show configured timeout value.

Possible responses

+WTMO: (500-65535)

OK

Note: Parameter ranges displayed.

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+WTMO: 1000

OK

Note: Timeout value set to 1 second.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 137

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Configure Receive Data Mode +WCRX

Description: This command is used to configure the receive data mode for each socket type. The specified configuration is used for all sockets of the specified type. This command may be used only when a PPP connection is not active.

Values: <type>

0:

<RxMode>

Polled; received data must be read using the +WSRX command.

1:

Syntax: Command

AT+WCRX=<type>,<RxMode>

Command

AT+WCRX=?

Note: Display command parameter ranges.

AT+WCRX=0,0

Note: Set TCP receive data mode to polled.

AT+WCRX?

Note: Show last used command parameters.

Possible responses

+WCRX: (0-1),(0-1)

OK

Note: Parameter ranges displayed.

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+WCRX: 1,1

OK

Note: Last used command parameters displayed.

Force Dormant Mode +WFDM

Description: This command is used to immediately force the Q24x8 module into dormant mode. The module normally enters dormant mode after a carrier specific time of no traffic channel activity during a data call. In dormant mode, the module releases CDMA traffic channel resources to conserve power and minimize carrier network loading. For some applications, this command can help reduce carrier network charges.

Values:

None.

Syntax: Command

AT+WFDM

Command

AT+WFDM

Note: Force module into dormant mode.

Possible responses

OK

+WDOR: 1

Note: Command accepted.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 138

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

IP Address Lookup +WDNS

Description:

Note:

Values

This command is used to display the IP address for a specified domain name. A DNS server is used to perform the lookup of the domain name and return its associated IP address. Since there is a variable time delay between the DNS server lookup request and the returned IP address, a multiple step process is used to display the results of the DNS lookup. Refer to the following examples. An open PPP session is required.

The +WDNS command must be issued twice for each domain name lookup attempt.

<domain name> The domain name string to lookup. The quotes around the name are required. The same domain name must be specified in the second command.

Syntax: Command

AT+WDNS=”<domain name>”

Command

AT+WDNS=”www.wavecom.com”

Note: Lookup IP address for specified domain name.

AT+WDNS=”www.wavecom.com”

Note: Re-issue command to display results.

AT+WDNS?

Note: Display last used domain name.

AT+WDNS=”bad.dns.name”

Note: Lookup IP address.

A/

Note: Re-issue last command.

Possible responses

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+WDNS: 0

Note: Lookup on DNS server completed.

+WDNS: 213.41.30.26

OK

Note: IP address displayed.

+WDNS: ”www.wavecom.com”

OK

OK

Note: Command accepted.

+WDNS: 0

Note: Lookup on DNS server completed.

ERROR

+WDNS: 125

Note: Domain name not found.

Display IP Address +WIPC

Description:

Values:

This command is used to display the IP address that is currently assigned to the module. An open PPP session is required.

None.

Syntax: Command AT+WIPC

Command

AT+WIPC

Note: Display current IP address.

Possible responses

+WIPC: 68.25.209.28

OK

Note: IP address displayed.

PPP Session Status +WPPP

Description: This unsolicited response indicates a change in the PPP session status. The new PPP session status is included in this response.

Response Values:

PPP session status.

200

PPP initialization in progress

202

Possible responses

+WPPP: 200

Note: PPP Session established and available.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 139

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Socket State Change +WSKS

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates a change in a socket state. This response is used to report socket

“Receive data is available” only when the corresponding socket type receive data mode is set to ‘polled’

(+WCRX command).

Response Values:

The socket type associated with this state change.

0

UDP

<socket>

The current socket state;

1

Receive data is available.

4

Possible responses

+WSKS: 0,0,1

Note: TCP socket zero has opened.

+WSKS: 0,0,2

Note: TCP socket zero has received data available.

+WSKS: 1,0,2

Note: UDP socket zero has received data available.

+WSKS: 1,1,4

Note: UDP socket one has closed.

Socket Open/Close Error +WSKE

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates that an error has occurred during a socket open or close operation.

Response Values:

TCP

1

The error indication of the socket. See sections 21.12 and 21.13 for a list of the returned codes and their meanings.

Possible responses

+WSKE: 0,0,100

Note: Invalid descriptor for TCP socket zero.

+WSKE: 1,1,117

Note: Connection reset on UDP socket one.

Socket Data Transmission Status +WSTX

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates the number of bytes transmitted for the most recently used +WSTX command on the indicated socket.

Response Values:

TCP

1

The socket number associated with this transmission status.

<length>

Syntax: Response syntax:

+WSTX: <type>,<socket>,<length>

Possible responses

+WSTX: 0,0,536

Note: 536 bytes sent on TCP socket zero.

+WSTX: 1,1,600

Note: 600 bytes sent on UDP socket one.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 140

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Socket Data Transmission Error +WSTE

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates that an error has occurred during a socket data transmission.

Response Values:

The socket type associated with this error.

0

UDP

<socket>

The error indication of the socket. See sections 21.12 and 21.13 for a list of the returned codes and their meanings.

Possible responses

+WSTE: 0,0,102

Note: Blocked transmission for TCP socket zero.

+WSTE: 1,1,117

Note: Connection reset on UDP socket one.

Received Socket Data +WSRX

Description: This unsolicited response returns received data from the indicated socket to the host application. Each

+WSRX response contains the next sequential portion of the received socket data. Depending on network congestion, the payload size may vary from response to response.

Response Values:

TCP

1

The socket number associated with this data reception.

<length> the response.

:

Possible responses

+WSRX: 0,0,536:0x54 0x45 0x53 0x54 …

Note: 536 bytes received on TCP socket zero.

+WSRX: 1,1,300:TEST …

Note: 300 bytes received on UDP socket one.

Socket Data Error +WSRE

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates that an error has occurred during the reception of socket data.

Response Values

The socket type associated with this error.

0

UDP

<socket> the sole and exclusive property of WAVECOM. Not to be distributed or divulged without prior written agreement. Ce document est la propriété exclusive de WAVECOM. Il ne peut être communiqué ou divulgué à des tiers sans son autorisation préalable.

<error> and their meanings.

Possible responses

+WSRE: 0,0,119

Note: Broken pipe for TCP socket zero.

+WSRE: 1,1,117

Note: Connection reset on UDP socket one.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 141

Chapter 18 – TCP/IP App AT Commands

Dormant Mode Status Change +WDOR

Description: This unsolicited response is used to indicate a change in the module dormant mode status. The module enters dormant mode after a carrier specific amount of time (about 10 seconds) of no activity during a data call. In dormant mode, the module releases CDMA traffic channel resources to conserve power and minimize carrier network loading. The module exits dormant mode when activity requiring CDMA traffic channel resources is again necessary.

Response Values:

<status>

Normal mode; CDMA traffic channel is active.

1

Possible responses

+WDOR: 0

Note: Module not in dormant mode.

+WDOR: 1

Note: Module in dormant mode.

DNS Lookup Indication +WDNS

Description : This unsolicited response is used to indicate the result of each step of a domain name lookup operation using the +WDNS command. See the +WDNS command for more information. 20.20.2

Response Values:

<status>

DNS lookup results available. confidential © Page : 260/ 313 This document is the sole and exclusive property of WAVECOM. Not to be distributed or divulged without prior written agreement. Ce document est la propriété exclusive de WAVECOM. Il ne peut être communiqué ou divulgué à des tiers sans son autorisation préalable.

<ip

+WDNS: <ip address>

Possible responses

+WDNS: 0

Note: DNS lookup step one complete.

+WDNS: 213.41.30.26

Note: DNS lookup step two complete.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 142

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Chapter 19 – Reference

Information

MS Error Result Code : +CME ERROR: <err>

<err> Meaning

1-2

3

4

5-9

10

Reserved

Operation not allowed

11

12

13

Operation not supported

Reserved

UIM not inserted

UIM PIN1 required

UIM PUK1 required

UIM failure

14-15 Reserved

20

21

22

23

16

17

18

19

UIM wrong password

UIM PIN2 required

UIM PUK2 required

Reserved

Phone Book full

Invalid Index for Phone Book

Phone Book entry not found

Reserved

24

25

Text string too long

Reserved

26 Dial string too long

27-29 Reserved

30 No network service

31-40 Reserved

41 Software resource not available

42

43

44

45

Invalid parameter

Non-Volatile Memory failure

Invalid WPIN code or WPIN required

Invalid WSPC provisioning code

46 OTKSL provisioning code access restricted +

47-49 Reserved

Resulting from the following commands

All GSM 07.07 commands (+CME ERROR: 3)

All GSM 07.07 commands (+CME ERROR: 4)

+CPIN

+CPIN

+CPIN, +CPIN2

+CPIN, +CPIN2

+CPIN, +CPIN2

+CPIN, +CPIN2

+CPIN, +CPIN2

+CPBF, +CPBW

+CPBF

+CPBF, +CPBP, CPBS

For example:

+WPRV, +CICB, +WFSH, +CCFC, +WNAM,

+COPS, +WRMP, +WPRL

All commands

All commands

All commands except ATD

+WSPC, +WMDN, +WIMI, +WSID, +WAOC,

+WSCI, +WBGP, +WBGS, +WPDS, +WCMT

WMDN, +WSCI, +WBGP, +WBGS, +WPDS

50 Session already in progress gpsOne

51

52

53

54

Invalid PD parameter

PD parameter not supported

Tracking mode requires +WPDFR setup

No active session gpsOne gpsOne gpsOne gpsOne

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 143

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Message Service Failure Result Code: +CMS ERROR: <err>

<error>

55-147

148

149

Meaning

Reserved

Unsupported serial port baud rate

Socket transmit timeout

150-239 Reserved

240 FDN is active and number is not in FDN

241-301 Reserved

302

303

304

305

Operation not allowed

Reserved

Invalid mode parameter

Invalid text mode parameter

306-320 Reserved

321 Invalid memory index

322-339 Reserved

340

341

No +CNMA acknowledgement expected

Non Volatile Memory failure

342-499 Reserved

Resulting from the Following Commands

+WPPP

+WSTX

+CMGS, +CMSS

All SMS commands (+CMSS, +CMGL, +CPMS…

+CMGS, +CMGW

+CMGS, +CMGW, +CMSS

+CMGR, +CMSS, +CMGD

+CNMA

All SMS commands

Specific Error Result Codes

<error> Meaning

500 unknown error.

501-512 Reserved

513

514

515

Lower layer failure (for SMS)

Reserved

Please wait. Initialization or command processing in progress.

516-518 Reserved

519 Reset the product to activate or change a new echo cancellation.

520-530 Reserved

531 Only FDN phonebook entries can be sent when the

FD facility is enabled.

532-599 Reserved

Resulting from the Following Commands

All commands

+CMGS, +CMSS (+CMS ERROR: 513)

Phonebook Initialization

+ECHO, +VIP

+CMGS, +CMSS

Extended Error Report (+CEER) Call Processing Codes

7

8

9

10

11

3

4

5

6

Cause Value

0

1

2

Diagnostic

No error detected in call processing

No CDMA service detected

Modem is in a call, operation not allowed

Modem is not in a call, operation not allowed

Modem is in an unknown call state

Call Barring is ON

Invalid or Not allowed CDMA Service Option

Invalid Parameter

Operation only allowed during an incoming call

Invalid Mode Selection

Invalid Roam Selection

Invalid Band Selection

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 144

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Final Result Codes

Verbose Result Code

+CME ERROR: <err>

+CMS ERROR: <err>

BUSY

ERROR

NO ANSWER

NO CARRIER

OK

RING

4

8

3

0

2

Numeric (V0 set)

As verbose

As verbose

7

Description

Error from GSM 07.05 commands

Error from SMS commands (07.07)

Busy signal detected

Command not accepted

Connection completion timeout

Connection terminated

Acknowledges correct execution of a command line

Incoming call signal from network

Intermediate Result Codes

Verbose Result Code

+COLP :<number>,<type>

+CR : <type>

+ILRR: <rate>

CONNECT 300

CONNECT 1200

CONNECT 1200/75

CONNECT 2400

CONNECT 4800

CONNECT 9600

CONNECT 14400

+CSSI: <code1>[,<index>]

10

11

12

13

Numeric (V0 set) as verbose as verbose as verbose

14

15

16

As verbose

Description

Outgoing Call Presentation

Outgoing Call report control

Local TA-TE data rate

Data connection at 300 bauds

Data connection at 1200 bauds

Data connection at 1200/75 bauds

Data connection at 2400 bauds

Data connection at 4800 bauds

Data connection at 9600 bauds

Data connection at 14400 bauds

Supplementary service notification during a call setup

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 145

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

gpsOne Error Result Code: +WPDER: <code>

The following table lists the numeric status codes that can be returned by the +WPDER unsolicited response.

<code> Description <code> Description

19

20

31

32

33

13

14

15

16

17

18

34

35

36

37

38

7

8

9

10

11

12

4

5

6

0

1

2

3

GPS session started

Phone offline

No service

No connection with PDE

No data available

Session manager busy

Phone is CDMA locked

Phone is GPS locked

Connection failure with PDE

PDSM ended session because of error

User ended the session

End key pressed

Network session was ended

Timeout for GPS search

Conflicting info for session and privacy

Error in fix

Reject from PDE

Ending session due to traffic channel exit

Ending session due to E911 call

Added protocol specific error type

Ending because base station info is stale

Invalid client ID parameter

Bad service parameter

Bad session type parameter

Bad privacy parameter

Bad download parameter

Bad net access parameter

Bad operation parameter

Bad number of fixes parameter

63

64

65

66

67

68

52

53

54

61

62

80

81

82

83

46

47

48

49

50

51

39

40

41

42

43

44

45

Wrong server Information parameters

Error in timeout parameter

Error in quality of service parameter

No session active while trying to end session

Session active for this client

Session busy status

Phone is offline

Phone is CDMA locked

GPS is locked

The command is invalid in this state.

Connection failure with PDE.

Internal software communication problem

Communication problems with search engine

GPS results cannot be reported at this time

Mode not supported

Unknown problem was found

No buffers available

Invalid client ID

Error in parameter to set

Error in lock type

Phone is offline state

An active command is running

Wrong app info

Unknown problem was found

Begin a GPS session

End of the GPS session

Begin a data download session

End of the download session

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 146

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Parameters Storage

The Immediate Save column denotes parameters that are saved to NVRAM when the associated command is issued.

Command

General commands

+CMEE

+CRSL

+CSCS

+WIND

Call Control Commands

%D

AT&W

X

Immediate Save

X

X

AT&F

X

Default Values

X X

X X X 1

X

RUIM: 0xC9; TE:0xC8

+CICB

+CSNS

+ECHO

+SIDET

+SPEAKER

+VGR

+VGT

ATS0

Network Commands

+COPS

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

(n,0 mode)

X 5

0,0

+CREG

SMS Commands

+WUSS

X

0: status change

+WSCL

Supplementary Service Commands

+CLIP X

+CLCK

Data Commands

+CRC

+DS

+DR

+ILRR

V24-V25 Commands

&C

&D

+ICF

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

+IFC

+IPR

E

Phonebook

+WAIP

Specific AT Commands

+ADC

X

X

X

+CMER

+CPHS

+W32K

+WCCS

+WCDM

+WPAD

+WRIM

+WSVG

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

2

2

3,3

2,2

115200

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

0

0: Vbatt

0: no report

1,1

0: disable

No translation

0

0: disable

0: pulse

0: handset

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 147

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Codes for SMS Status Report (+CDS and +CMGR)

1

2

3

4

5

Code

Network Problems (IS-41D)

0

Terminal Problems (IS-41D)

32

33

34

35

36

37

97

98

99

100

101

102

103

104

38

39

Radio Interface Problems (IS-41D)

64

65

66

General problems (IS-41D)

96

Meaning

Address vacant

Address translation failure

Network resource shortage

Network failure

Invalid Teleservice id

Other Network Problem

No page response

Destination busy

No acknowledgment

Destination resource shortage

SMS delivery postponed

Destination out of resources

Destination no longer at this address

Other terminal problem

Radio IF resource shortage

Radio IF incompatible

Other Radio IF problem

Unexpected parameter size

SMS Origination denied

SMS Termination denied

Supplementary service not supported

SMS not supported

Reserved

Missing expected parameters

Missing mandatory parameters

105

106

Unrecognized parameter value

Unexpected parameter value

User data size error

107 Other General problems

General Codes (Not defined in IS-41D)

32768

32769

32770

32771

32772

32773

SMS OK. Message successfully delivered to base station

Waiting for transport layer acknowledgment

Out of resources (e.g. out of memory buffer)

Message too large to be sent over access channel

Message too large to be sent over data traffic channel

Network not ready

32774 Phone not ready

32775

32776

32777

Cannot send message in analog mode

Cannot send broadcast message

Invalid transaction id

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 148

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

AT Commands Supported When SIM Card Removed

The following lists the AT commands that are supported in a RUIM modem (the modem needs a SIM card to operate) when the SIM card is not present.

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

6

7

8

9

10

11

12

# List

1

2

3

4

5

AT Command

+IPR

+CMEE

+CCLK

+CBC

+WIND

ATE

+CPOF

+CFUN

+WGMI

+WGMM

+CGMR

+CGSN

+CSCS

+CPAS

+CRMP

+CRSL

+CSQ

+CREG

$QCDMG

ATIx

Note and Explanation

Set modem fixed baud rate

Display the error code

Clock management

Battery charge

General status indication

Set modem local echo

Modem Offline mode

Reset the modem

Manufacturer identification

Model identification

Revision identification

Electronic serial number

TE character set selection

Phone activity status

Ring melody playback

Ringer sound level

Signal quality

Network registration and roaming

Transition to diagnostics monitor

Request Modem Information (x = 0-7)

AT Commands for AMPS Operation

In the AMPS mode, only the voice call is applicable. Although you can issue almost all AT commands, most of the commands are not applicable for AMPS operation; e.g., data commands, SMS, RUIM commands, service programming etc.

10

11

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

6

7

8

9

2

3

4

5

The following table lists the AT commands that are meaningful for AMPS operation. Please note that these commands are also applicable in CDMA operations.

# List

1

AT command

+COPS

ATD

ATA

ATDL

+VGR

+VGT

+CMUT

A/

ATS0

ATH

ATIx

+IPR

+CNUM

+CGSN

+CMEE

+WPRL

+CPOF

+CFUN

Note and Explanation

+COPS=2,n (n=0,1)

Making a voice call

Answer a voice call

Redial last #

Change the receiving voice volume

Change the transmitting voice volume

Mute the microphone

Repeat last command

Set auto answer

Hang up a voice call

Request Module Information (x = 0-7)

Set module baud rate

Display module directory #

Display module ESN # (in hex format)

Display the error code

Read the PRL version

Module OFF mode

Reset the module

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 149

TCP App Socket Status Events

Code

1

2

4

Description

Socket is open

Receive data is available

Socket is closed

TCP App Socket Error Codes

117

118

119

120

121

122

123

124

110

111

112

113

114

115

116

Code

0

100

101

102

103

104

105

106

107

108

109

Description

End Of File (EOF); server is done sending data

Invalid socket descriptor

Invalid buffer or argument

Operation would block

Address family not supported

Wrong protocol for socket type

Socket parameter not supported

Protocol not supported

No more sockets available for opening

Operation not supported

Address already in use

Destination address required

Connection establishment in progress

Connection already established

IP address changed, causing TCP reset

Socket not connected

Connection attempt refused

Connection attempt timed out

Connection reset

Connection aborted

Broken pipe

Network subsystem unavailable

No more applications available

Invalid application ID

There are existing sockets

Invalid operation

TCP App DNS Server Codes

Code Description

125

126

127

128

Domain Name Error or not found

Domain Name not found

Network is not opened

Out of memory

129

130

131

132

133

DNS Server busy

Reserved

Reserved

Unrecoverable error

No address for the domain name

TCP App PPP Network Codes

Code Description

200 PPP established and available

201 PPP initialization in progress

202

203

PPP closed or unavailable

PPP is closing

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 150

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

TCP App Restricted AT Commands

The following table lists AT commands that should not be used when the TCP App feature is active; that is, a AT+WPPP session has been successfully started.

AT command

+++

+CCFC

+COPS

+ICF

+IFC

+IPR

+VTS

+WBND

+WFSH

+WIOTA

+WNAM

+WOSO

+WRMP

+WSDT

+WSPC

+WSSS

+WVSS

AT&F

ATA

ATD

ATDL

ATH

ATZ

Note and explanation

Switch online/offline mode

Call forwarding

Mode preference

DTE character framing

DTE flow control

DTE baud rate

DTMF burst

Band preference

Flash with/without information

IOTA control

Set NAM

CDMA origination

Roam preference

DTMF continuous

Service programming code and all associated provisioning commands.

Sprint system selection

Verizon system selection

Reset to factory defaults

Answer call

Call origination

Call origination using last entered number

Call termination

Reset to default configuration

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 151

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

Phonebook UCS2 Unicode

Text strings that contain UCS2 Unicode characters must be in one of the three supported record structures detailed in this section. If the ME supports Unicode formatted text strings in the SIM, the ME will support all three record structures for character sets that contain 128 or less characters. For Unicode character sets containing more than 128 characters, the ME will at a minimum support the ‘80’ record structure. A record structure should not be used for non-Unicode character text strings. Within a text string only one scheme, either non-Unicode or one of the three supported record structures described in this section, shall be used.

In the following examples, an octet is 8 bits in length. The most significant bit is identified as bit 7 and the least significant bit is identified as bit 0. When two octets are combined to form a sixteen bit word value, the most significant bit is identified as bit 15 and the least significant bit is identified as bit 0.

Unicode character sets: http://www.unicode.org/charts/

Record Structure ‘80’:

This record structure is identified by a value of ‘80’ in the first octet of the text string. The remaining octets are interpreted as sixteen bit UCS2 Unicode characters with the most significant octet (MSO) preceding the least significant octet (LSO) for each

UCS2 Unicode character in the string. An octet pair with a value of 'FFFF' is ignored.

Octet 1 Octet 2 Octet 3 Octet 4 Octet 5 Octet 6 Octet 7 Octet 8 Octet 9

'80' 'FF'

In the above example, the text string contains four UCS2 Unicode characters. The final character in octets 8 and 9 is ignored.

Record Structure ‘81’:

This record structure is identified by a value of ‘81’ in the first octet of the text string. The second octet of this structure contains a value indicating the number of characters in the string. The third octet value is used to specify the Unicode character set base pointer. This base pointer is used with some or all of the remaining octets in the text string.

The fourth and subsequent octets in the text string are interpreted as follows. If bit 7 of the octet is zero, then bits 6 through 0 define a standard non-Unicode character. If bit 7 of the octet is one, then bits 6 through 0 are combined with the base pointer to define a UCS2 Unicode character.

Octet 1 Octet 2 Octet 3 Octet 4 Octet 5 Octet 6 Octet 7 Octet 8 Octet 9

'81' '05' '13' '53' '95' 'A6' '8F' 'FF' ' FF'

In this example:

• Octet 2 indicates that there are five characters in the text string. The base pointer (octet 3) is not included in this count.

• Octet 3 is used to define bits 14 through 7 of a base pointer. This octet is inserted into the binary bit pattern 0xxx xxxx x000 0000 to become a sixteen bit value. In this example, ‘13’ specifies the first UCS2 character of the Bengali character set which starts at code position 0980 (0000 1001 1000 0000).

• Octet 4 contains a value with bit 7 equal to zero. Bits 6 through 0 (101 0011) of this octet correspond to the character

‘S’.

• Octet 5 contains a value with bit 7 equal to one. Bits 6 through 0 (001 0101) of this octet are combined with the base pointer value. The resulting sixteen bit value 0000 1001 1001 0101 ('0995') is the UCS2 Bengali letter ‘KA’.

• Octet 8 contains the value 'FF' and since the string length is 5, this a valid character in the text string. Bit 7 of this character equals one. Bits 6 through 0 (111 1111) of this octet are combined with the base pointer value. The resulting sixteen bit value 0000 1001 1111 1111 (‘09FF’) is the last UCS2 Bengali character.

• Octet 9 is ignored since it is beyond the octet 2 specified number of characters.

Record Structure ‘82’:

This record structure is identified by a value of ‘82’ in the first octet of the text string. The second octet of this structure contains a value indicating the number of characters in the string. The third and fourth octets are used to specify the Unicode character set base pointer. This base pointer is used with some or all of the remaining octets in the string.

The fifth and subsequent octets in the string are interpreted follows. If bit 7 of the octet is zero, then bits 6 through 0 define a standard non-Unicode character. If bit 7 of the octet is one, then bits 6 through 0 are combined with base pointer to define a

UCS2 Unicode character.

Octet 1 Octet 2 Octet 3 Octet 4 Octet 5 Octet 6 Octet 7 Octet 8 Octet 9

'82' '05' ‘ 05’

MSO

‘30’

LSO

2D' '82' 'D3' '2D' '31'

In this example:

• Octet 2 indicates that there are 5 characters in the text string. The base pointer (octets 3 and 4) are not included in this count.

• Octets 3 and 4 specify a sixteen bit base pointer '0530' which is the first UCS2 character of the Armenian character set.

• Octet 5 contains a value with bit 7 equal to zero. Bits 6 through 0 (010 1101) of this octet correspond to the character dash ‘ - ‘.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 152

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

• Octet 6 contains a value with bit 7 equal to one. Bits 6 through 0 (000 0010) of this octet are combined with the base pointer value. The resulting sixteen bit value '0532' is the UCS2 Armenian character ‘capital BEN’.

• Octet 7 contains a value with bit 7 equal to one. Bits 6 through 0 (001 0011) of this octet are combined with the base pointer value. The resulting sixteen bit value '0583' is the UCS2 Armenian Character ‘small PIWR’.

• Octets 8 and 9 are processed in a manner similar to octet 5. The values in this example correspond the characters dash ‘ - ‘ and ‘ 1 ’.

Commands Over DM Port (MuxLite)

This functionality provides the ability to send a limited set of AT commands to the Q24x8 module over the diagnostic port.

Referred to as MuxLite, this functionality is only available during a data call. The use of this functionality requires a host application capable of processing the HDLC protocol described in the MuxLite application note [13].

The diagnostic port is normally used for the transmission of unsolicited diagnostic messages during module operation. The

MuxLite feature adds the supported AT commands and responses to this existing diagnostic message data stream. The host application is required to extract the AT command response data from the diagnostic message data stream.

The following table summarizes the AT commands that are currently supported by the MuxLite feature. Refer to the appropriate section in this manual for command usage details. Note that the parameter range display variation (=?) of these commands (e.g. AT+WSTR=?) are not available using MuxLite and will result in ERROR. With the exception of +CLCC, all AT commands in this table will result in ERROR if used with MuxLite and a data call is not active.

MuxLite Supported AT Commands:

Command

AT+CLCC

AT+WSTR

AT+CSQ

AT+CNMA

AT+CNMI

AT+CPMS

AT+CMGR

AT+CMGS

AT+CMGD

AT+CCED

AT+CREG

Description

List current call state. Note: This is the only command that is not active data call dependent. It can be used at any time on the diagnostic port.

Wavecom status request

Signal quality

SMS message acknowledgement. This message will be acknowledged when accepted for processing. The resulting data will be returned in a separate unsolicited response.

SMS new message indication

Used to select the message storage area used by the +CMGR command. The “MT” area holds received SMS messages.

SMS read message. This message will be acknowledged when accepted for processing. The resulting data will be returned in a separate unsolicited response.

Send SMS message. Two HDLC packets are required. The first packet must contain the SMS message destination data (everything up to and not including the <cr> character in the normal +CMGS command). The second packet must contain the

SMS message text; Unicode is supported. The +CMGS control characters (<cr>,

<ctrl-Z>, and <ESC>) are not required and ignored if included. Do not send any other

HDLC packets between the two +CMGS packets.

Delete SMS message

Cell environment

Registration and roaming

Unsolicited Messages General unsolicited status or indication messages from the module.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 153

Chapter 19 – Reference Information

MuxLite Example

The following provides a usage example for the MuxLite feature. It assumes that the module data port is connected to COM1 and the module diagnostic port is connected to COM2. Though individual AT commands are shown in this example, HDLC packet encoding/decoding must be performed on all diagnostic port (COM2) commands and responses as described in the

MuxLite application note [13].

COM1:

AT+CMEE=1

OK

…Host configured…

ATD#777

CONNECT

…PPP negotiation…

Enable detailed reporting of mobile equipment errors.

Host application configured for PPP dial up access.

Initiate a data call. Number string is carrier specific.

Data call connected.

PPP layer startup and data exchange.

COM2:

AT+CLCC

+CLCC: 1,1,0

OK

WROM: 1

Display current call state.

Active data call.

AT+CSQ?

+CSQ: 27,99

OK

AT+CNMI=2,2,0,0,0

OK

AT+CPMS=”MT”

OK

+CMGS: 1

Unsolicited response, roaming status has changed.

Display signal quality and frame error rate.

Set SMS message reception procedure; acknowledge using +CNMA

Set “Mobile Terminated” as preferred SMS memory storage

+CMT:"8585551212","02/05/17,10 :43 :07",129,1,2,0,”5550000”,0

Unsolicited response, SMS message received.

AT+CNMA

OK

Acknowledge received SMS message to the network.

AT+CMGR=0 Read the SMS message.

+CMGR:"REC UNREAD","8585552222","02/05/15,15 :54 :04",1,2,0,”5550000”,15

Don, give me a call. Kathy

OK

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”

I’ll be home in 5 minutes.

OK

Send a SMS message (part in a separate HDLC packet)

Message text (part in a separate HDLC packet)

Message accepted by SMS Service Center

+CDS:2,1,"8582431439",129,"02/05/17,10 :14 :17","02/05/17,10 :14 :27",32768

Message delivery report.

COM1:

…PPP layer shutdown…

NO CARRIER

AT

OK

COM2:

AT+CSQ?

+CME ERROR: 3

AT+CLCC

+CLCC: 0,9,0

OK

Host application terminates PPP session

Data call terminated

Module re-enters command mode

Display signal quality and frame error rate.

Error returned from module.

Display current call state.

Error return cause; module not in an active data call.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 154

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT

Result Codes

This section describes unsolicited AT codes that are sent to the modem as the result of an AT command or network notification. These commands are used throughout the sections of this document. Refer to this section for an explanation on any unsolicited command that is mentioned in the subsequent sections for result code range and value definitions.

Cell Broadcast Message Directly Displayed +CBM

Description:

This response indicates a Cell Broadcast message has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be directly displayed.

Values: <oa>

Originator Address

Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

Type-of-Address of <oa>

<lang>

Encoding method

<length>

Syntax:

Response syntax: +CBM: <oa>, <scts>, [<tooa>,]<lang>,<encod>[,<length>]

<CR><LF><data>

Example Result

+CBM: “123456”,”98/10/01,12 :3000+00”,129,1,2,5<CR><LF>

Hello

Note: Cell broadcast message received

Cell Broadcast Message Stored in Memory +CBMI

Description: This response indicates a Cell Broadcast message has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be stored in memory.

Values: <mem>

NVRAM storage area (always “BC” for this response)

<index>

Syntax:

Location of message within storage area

Response syntax: +CBMI: <mem>,<index>

Example Result

+CBMI: “BC”,5

Note: Cell broadcast message received and stored in “BC” memory at index 5

Cell Environment Description Indication +CCED

Description: This response is used to return to retrieve information that has been requested by the +CCED AT command.

Refer to the +CCED AT command in Chapter 13 for more information and a definition of the returned values.

Syntax:

Response syntax: +CCED: <requested dump>

Example Result

+CCED: 1,725,4,65535,6,,0,,,-104,-35,-63

Note: Cell environment description indication in response to AT+CCED=0,1

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 155

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Call Waiting Indication +CCWA

Description: This response indicates that another incoming call is occurring during an existing call. See +WFSH for information about handling call-waiting situations

Values: <caller_id>

Caller identification number

Syntax:

Response syntax: +CCWA: <caller_id>, <type>

Example Result

+CCWA: 18005551212,129

Note: Incoming call from 1-800-555-1212, type always equals 129.

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS

Description: This response indicates an SMS status report has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be directly displayed. +CDS is also used in the data compression functionality as an active command. Refer to Chapter 16 (U usage for data compression. m

Interface Data Compression) for an explanation of +CDS

Values: <mr>

Message Reference

Type-of-Address of <ra>

<scts>

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

<dt>

(Year [00-99], Month [01-12], Day [01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour] )

Syntax: Response Syntax: +CDS: <mr>, [<ra>] , [<tora>], <scts>,<dt>,<st> (Text mode)

Example Result

+CDS : 2, 116, ”3146290800”, 129, “98/10/01,12 :30 :07+04”, “98/10/01 12 :30 :08+04”, 0

Note: SMS status report received

SMS Status Report Indication Stored in Memory +CDSI

Syntax: preferences (+CNMI), is to be stored in memory .

Values: <mem> NVRAM storage area (always “SR” for this response)

<index>

Response syntax: +CDSI: <mem>,<index>

Example Result

+CDSI: “SR”,5

Note: SMS status report received and stored in “SR” memory at index 5

Key Press or Release +CKEV

Description: This response indicates that a key has been pressed or released.

Values: <key>

Key input (0-9, *, #)

<press>

0

: key release

Syntax:

1

: key press

Response syntax: +CKEV: <key>,<press>

Example Result

+CKEV: 9,0

Note: Indicates key 9 has been released

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 156

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Caller ID Presentation +CLIP

Description:

This response indicates that caller ID information is available for the current incoming call. See +CLIP,

Calling Line Identification Presentation for enable and disabling this result.

Values: <caller_id> Caller identification number

<type>

Syntax:

Response syntax: +CLIP: <caller_id>, <type>

Example Result

+CLIP: 18005551212,129

Note: Incoming call from 1-800-555-1212, type always equals 129.

Incoming Message Directly Displayed +CMT

Description: This response indicates that an incoming message has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be directly displayed.

Values: <oa>

Originator Address.

Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

<lang>

Type-of-Address of <oa>

Language

Encoding method

<priority>

Message priority:

0

1

2

3

– Normal

– Interactive

– Urgent

– Emergency

Call Back Number

<length>

Syntax: Response syntax: +CMT: <oa>, <scts>, <tooa>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority> [,<cbn>],

<length> <CR><LF> <data> (text mode)

Example Result

+CMT: “123456”,”98/10/01,12 :3000+00”,129,1,2,0,”5550000”,5<CR><LF>

Hello

Note: Incoming message received

Incoming Message Stored in Memory +CMTI

Description: This response indicates that an incoming message has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be stored in memory.

Value: <mem>

NVRAM storage area (always “MT” for this response)

<index>

Syntax:

0 – Normal

1

– Interactive

2 – Urgent

3

– Emergency

Response syntax: +CMTI: <mem>,<index>,<priority>

Example Result

+CMTI: “MT”,5

Note: Normal priority incoming message received and stored in “MT” memory at index 5

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 157

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Mode Preference +COPS

Description:

This response indicates that a change in mode preference has taken place. See +COPS, Mode

Preferences, in Chapter 5 for information about Changing Mode Preference.

Values: <mode> (For System Determination 2.0)

0

Automatic.

1

2

CDMA only.

CDMA or AMPS only.

3 Analog only.

<term>

0 Permanent – this mode persists until another +COPS command is issued

1

Power cycle – this mode persists until power cycle is performed

Syntax:

Response syntax: +COPS: <mode>,<term>

Example Result

+COPS:0,0

Note: Unsolicited +COPS result confirms Automatic mode is requested.

+COPS:2,0

Note: Unsolicited +COPS result confirms CDMA or AMPS only mode is requested.

Registration & Roaming +CREG

Description: This response indicates the current state of roaming. See +COPS, Mode Preferences, in Chapter 5 for information about Changing Mode Preference

Values: <stat>

not registered, MS is not currently searching for a new operator.

1

registered, home network.

2 not registered, MS currently searching for a base station.

4

unknown.

5 registered, roaming

Syntax: Response syntax: +CREG: <stat>

Example Result

+CREG : 1

Note: Modem has found the home network and is registered.

Incoming Call +CRING

Description:

This response indicates an incoming call. See +CRC, Cellular Result Codes, in Chapter 9 for information about enabling this result.

Values: <type>

VOICE normal voice call

DATA all types of data calls

OTAPA over the air parameter administration call

TEST markov, loopback, or test call

UNKNOWN unknown/undefined call type

Syntax: Response syntax: +CRING: <Type>

Example Result

+CRING:VOICE

Note: Incoming normal voice call.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 158

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

RxLev Indication +CSQ

Description:

This response is used to return information that has been requested by the +CCED AT command. Refer to the +CCED AT command in Chapter 13 (Cell Environment and RxLev Indication) for command usage information.

Values: <rssi>

0-31

Valid value ranges. The lowest value is 0 and the highest is 31.

0 = -110dBm, 31 = -75dBm. 1.09375dBm per step.

Note

: Certain models use a range other than 0-31.

99 Represents an unknown signal quality.

<fer>

99 Not known or not detectable Currently always returns 99.

Syntax: Response syntax: +CSQ: <rssi>,<fer>

Example Result

+CSQ: 29, 99

Note: RSSI notification

Incoming Call +RING

Description: This response indicates an incoming call.

Syntax: Response syntax: +RING

Example Result

+RING

+RING

Note: Incoming Call

Call Answered +WANS

Description:

This response indicates that a voice call has been answered.

Values: <call type>

0 incoming call

1

outgoing call answered by other party (only available on networks supporting answering supervision for payphone applications)

Syntax: Response syntax: +WANS:<call type>

Command Possible Responses

ATA +RING

OK

+WANS:0

Note: Incoming call answered

+WCNT:3

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 159

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Call Connected +WCNT

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates that an incoming or outgoing voice call has been connected into a traffic channel state. If the service option is not available, +WCNT: will output “NULL”.

Values: <so> Service option of call.

Speech: 3, 17, 32768

Syntax:

Loopback: 2, 9, 55

OTAPA: 18, 19

Position Determination: 35, 36

Response syntax: +WCNT: <so>

Command

ATD18005551212;

Possible Responses

OK

+WORG:18005551212

+WCNT:3

Note: Call Connected with service option 3

Call Ended +WEND

Description:

This response indicates that a voice call or attempt to establish a voice call has ended.

Values: <reason>

0

: Phone is offline

20 : Phone is CDMA locked

21

: Phone has no service

22 : Call Faded/Dropped

23

: Received Intercept from Base Station

24 : Received Reorder from Base Station

25

: Received a Release from Base Station (This is a normal call termination).

26 : Service Option rejected by Base Station

27 : Received Incoming Call

28

: Received an alert stop from Base Station

29 : Software ended the call (Normal release).

30

: Received End Activation – OTASP calls only.

31 : Internal Software aborted the origination/call.

32

: Maximum Access probes exhausted (The modem failed to contact the Base Station)

34 : RUIM not present

35

: Origination already in progress

36 : General Access Failure

37

: Received retry order (IS-2000 only).

Syntax: Response syntax: +WEND: <reason>

Command

ATD18005551212;

ATH

ATD18005551212;

Possible Responses

OK

+WORG:18005551212

+WCNT:3

OK

+WEND:29

Note: Call Ended with a normal release

OK

+WORG:18005551212

+WEND:22

Note: Call failed because the signal faded.

Feature Notification Message +WFNM

Description:

This response displays a broadcast message that the carrier may send to all mobiles in an emergency. This

Syntax: event is required for CDMA specifications.

Response Syntax: +WFNM=”<message>”

Command Possible Responses

+WFNM=”Help, I have fallen and I can’t get up!”

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 160

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Flash Indication +WFSH

Description:

This response confirms that a flash has been sent to the base station. See +WFSH command for more

Syntax: information on using flash commands.

Response Syntax: +WFSH

Command Possible Responses

AT+WFSH OK

+WFSH

General Indicator +WIND

Description:

This is a general mechanism to send unsolicited non-standardized indications to the application. The identified unsolicited non-standardized indications are:

Indication during mobile originated call setup that the calling party is ringing.

Indication of the availability of the product to receive AT commands after boot.

The +WIND is overloaded with two functionalities:

1. posts non-standardized indications and

2. allows the user to specify indication level. For each of these indications, a “bit flow” has to be

Values: indicated.

<IndLevel>

1

(bit-0):

2

(bit-1):

4

(bit-2):

8 (bit-3):

16

(bit-4):

32 (bit-5):

64

(bit-6):

R-UIM Presence

Reserved

Reserved

Indication that the product is ready to process all AT commands

Reserved

Reserved

Network service available indication

128 (bit-7):

256

(bit-8):

Network lost indication

Reserved

512 (bit-9): Reserved

1024

(bit-10): Corrupted RF calibration values (checksum mismatch)

Note 1: If <IndLevel> is equal to 0, no unsolicited “+WIND: <IndNb>” will occur.

Note 2:

If <IndLevel> bit 10 is set, the modem will transition to OFFLINE mode.

A combination (addition of the values) is used to allow more than one indication flow.

0 < Ind Level < 2047

For example: 128 (network lost indication) + 64 (network service available indication) = 192.

The response is OK if the values are in the previous range.

The unsolicited response will then be: +WIND : <event>

Example Result

+WIND:8 Note: General indication that AT commands are ready to be accepted supported

<event>

0 :

1

:

2 :

4

:

8 :

16

:

Syntax:

R-UIM not present

R-UIM present

Reserved

Reserved

Product is ready to process all AT commands

Reserved

32 :

64

:

128 :

256

:

512 :

Reserved

The network service is available for an emergency call.

The network is lost.

Reserved

Reserved

1024 : Corrupted RF calibration values (checksum mismatch)

Command syntax: AT+WIND=<IndLevel>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WIND?

Note: Show current setting.

AT+WIND=?

Note: Show <IndLevel> range.

WIND: 8

OK Note: Default 8. (9 if RUIM is present)

+WIND: (0-2047)

OK

AT+WIND=128 Note: Turn on Network lost indication only. OK Note: Command accepted.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 161

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Call Originated +WORG

Description:

This response indicates that an attempt to establish a voice call has occurred.

Syntax:

Response Syntax: +WORG: <number>

Command

ATD18005551212;

Possible Responses

OK

+WORG:18005551212

+WCNT:3

OK

Note: <number> is the dialing string sent to the base station. You may see extra numbers before the intended dialing string, this is a result of pre-pended numbers or other call options such as +CLIR.

Call Privacy Indication +WPRV

Description: This response confirms that the call privacy level has changed during a call.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WPRV: <prv>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WPRV=1 OK

+WPRV: 1

<prv>

0 : Indicates normal privacy

1

: Indicates enhanced privacy

Roaming Indication +WROM

Description: This response indicates that the roaming status has changed.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WROM: <roam>

Command Possible Responses

+WROM:1

<roam>

0

1

:

:

Home.

Roam Icon ON (affiliated network)

2 : Roam Icon Blink (foreign network)

The following values apply to enhanced roaming:

3 :

4

:

5 :

6

:

Out of Neighborhood

Out of Building

Roaming - Preferred System

Roaming - Available System

7 :

8

:

9 :

10

:

Roaming - Alliance Partner

Roaming - Premium Partner

Roaming - Full Service Functionality

Roaming - Partial Service Functionality

11 :

12

:

Roaming Banner On

Roaming Banner Off

13 - 63 : Reserved for Standard Enhanced Roaming Indicator Numbers

64 - 127

: Reserved for Non-Standard Enhanced Roaming Indicator Numbers

128 - 255

: Reserved

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 162

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Emergency Mode +WSOS

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates a change in the status of Emergency Mode has taken place. In the event that Emergency Mode is entered as the result of an emergency call, this response will be sent to indicate that the modem is now in emergency mode. After this point, to exit the modem out of Emergency Mode, an

AT+WSOS or AT+COPS command must be sent, which will result in a +WSOS response to confirm that

Emergency Mode has been exited. See +WSOS, section for more information about Emergency Mode.

Values:

Syntax:

The parameters values are the following ones:

<flag>

0

Emergency Mode Exited

1 Emergency Mode Entered

Response Syntax: +WSOS: <flag>

Command Possible Responses

ATD911;

Note: Make emergency call

AT+WSOS

Note: Exit Emergency Mode

AT+COPS=0,0

Note: While in Emergency Mode, the mode preference is changed, resulting in Emergency

Mode being exited

OK

+WSOS:1

+WORG:911

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms Emergency

Mode is entered

OK

+WSOS:0

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms Emergency

Mode is exited

OK

+WSOS:0

+COPS:0,0

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms emergency mode exited and unsolicited +COPS result confirms

Automatic mode is requested

Current NAM Change +WNAM

Description:

This response indicates that the current NAM has changed.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WNAM: <nam>

Command Possible Responses

+WNAM:2

<nam>

1

NAM

2 NAM 2

3

NAM 3

4 NAM 4

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 163

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Voice Mail Indicator +WVMI

Description:

This response indicates the status of the Voicemail Inbox.

Syntax: Response syntax: +WVMI: <LineId>,<Num>

Command Possible Responses

OK

Note: 2 messages are in your voicemail box.

Values: <LineId>

<Num> The number of messages waiting in the inbox. Maximum value is 99.

0

No message waiting.

1

3

One message is waiting

Three messages are waiting

Example:

AT+CPHS?

+CPHS: 1,0

OK

Interrogate the status of CPHS functionality

The voice mail indicator functionality is deactivated

AT+CPHS=3,1 Syntax error

+CME ERROR: 3

AT+CPHS=1,1 Activate the voice mail indicator functionality

OK

AT+CPHS?

+CPHS: 1,1

OK

Interrogate the status of CPHS functionality

The voice mail indicator functionality is activated

**** the message box contains 1 message *****

+WVMI: 1,1 A message is waiting on Line 1

AT+CPHS=2,1

OK

+WVMI: 1,1

AT+CPHS?

+CPHS: 1,1

OK

Interrogate the status of voice mail indicator functionality

A message is waiting on LINE 1

Interrogate the status of CPHS functionality

The voice mail indicator functionality is activated

SMS Message Storage Full +WMGF

Description:

This response indicates that the SMS Service Center has attempted to send an SMS message but it was rejected because SMS Message Storage is Full. No new SMS messages will be received until some room is created by deleting old messages from SMS storage. Message deletion can be done using AT+CMGD.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WMGF

Example Result

+WMGF

Note: Incoming message rejected. Message center notified with “out of resources” message. Message center will attempt to re-send the message at a later time.

Power Save +WSPS

Description:

This response is output whenever a change occurs in the power save status. The +WSPS: 1 response indicates that the module is unable to obtain a radio network connection and is temporarily suspending its search. This suspend mode lasts for about 3 minutes. The +WSPS: 0 response indicates that the module is

Syntax: again actively searching for a radio network connection. This feature helps to conserve battery power in cases where coverage is marginal.

Note: This response is not used in Verizon software versions.

Response Syntax: +WSPS: <state>

Command Possible responses

1

Note: Entering power save mode.

+WSPS: 0

Note: Leaving power save mode.

AT+WSPS?

Note: Display current power mode state.

<state>

0

1

Leaving power save

Entering power save

+WSPS: 0

OK Note: Not in power save mode.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 164

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Position Determination Start Session Result +1

Description:

This unsolicited response is used by the gpsOne feature to return position determination data. The content of this response is dependent on the services specified in the +WPDSS command.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WPDSS: uncertainty>,<perpendicular axis uncertainty>,<fix>,<mask>, <elevation>,<elevation uncertainty>,<heading>,<horizontal velocity>, <vertical velocity>

Command

AT+WPDSS=”P”

Note: Ask for position only.

Possible responses

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,0,0,#,#,#,#,#

Note: Unsolicited result with position only.

AT+WPDSS=”PH”

Note: Ask for position and elevation.

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,0,1,#,#,#,#,#

Note: Unsolicited result with position and elevation.

. +WPDSS:GPS Session Failed

+WPDER:15

Note: gpsONE session failure.

Defined values:

<latitude>

32-bit signed integer.

This value represents the position North (positive) or South (negative) of the equator. The returned value must be divided by 186413.5111 to convert it to degrees.

<longitude>

32-bit signed integer

This value represents the position East (positive) or West (negative) of the Greenwich meridian. The returned value must be divided by 186413.5111 to convert it to degrees.

<timestamp> 64-bit integer

This value is the CDMA system time for the reported position data.

<position uncertainty angle>

4-bit integer

This value is the number of 5.625 degrees increments. The range is from 0 to 15 (84.375 degrees). A value of 0 is true north and the angle increases toward the east.

<axis uncertainty>

8-bit integer

This is the uncertainty value for the axis along the Position Uncertainty Angle. The value returned is a table lookup key that corresponds to the actual uncertainty value in meters.

<perpendicular axis uncertainty>

8-bit integer

This is the uncertainty value for the perpendicular axis along the Position Uncertainty

Angle. The value returned is a table lookup key that corresponds to the actual uncertainty value in meters.

<fix> 1-bit integer

0

1 3D fix – velocity available

<mask> 3-bit integer. This value is used to indicate which fields contain valid information. Bits 3 through 7 are not used. bit 0 elevation fields are valid when set to 1 bit 1 heading fields are valid when set to 1 bit 2 velocity fields are valid when set to 1

GPS position data is always valid.

<elevation>

16-bit signed integer. This value is the number of meters above or below the WGS-84 reference ellipsoid. The range of this value is -500 to 15883.

<elevation uncertainty>

8-bit integer. The value returned is a table lookup key that corresponds to the actual elevation uncertainty value in meters.

<heading>

16-bit unsigned integer. This value is the heading in units of 0.3515625 degree. A value of

0 is true north and the angle increases toward the east. The value is in the range 0 to

1024.

<velocity horizontal> 16-bit unsigned integer. This value is the horizontal speed in units of 0.25 meters per second. The value is in the range from 0 to 511 (127.75 meters per second).

<velocity vertical> 8-bit signed integer. This value is the vertical speed in units of 0.5 meters per second.

The value is in the range 0 to 255 (-64 to +63.5 meters per second).

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 165

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

Uncertainty Lookup Table:

The value returned in a +WPDSS response uncertainty field is in the left hand column of the table. The corresponding uncertainty value in meters is contained in the right hand column.

Value Uncertainty in Meters Value Uncertainty in Meters

0

1

2

3

0.5

0.75

1

1.5

16

17

18

19

128

192

256

384

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

2

3

4

6

8

12

16

20

21

22

23

24

25

26

512

768

1024

1536

2048

3072

4096

11

12

13

14

15

24

32

48

64

96

27

28

29

30

31

6144

8192

12288

>12288

Cannot be computed

Position Determination Error +WPDER

Description:

Syntax:

This unsolicited response is used by the gpsOne feature to return an error code.

Response Syntax: +WPDER:<code>

Example Result

+WPDSS:GPS Session Failed

+WPDER:15

Note: gpsOne Session failure. Error in Fix reported.

Response Values:

Code Description Code Description

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

31

32

33

6

7

8

9

10

11

12

13

0

1

2

3

4

5

35

36

37

38

GPS session started

Phone offline

No service

No connection with PDE

No data available

Session manager busy

Phone is CDMA locked

Phone is GPS locked

Connection failure with PDE

PDSM ended session because of error

User ended the session

End key pressed

Network session was ended

Timeout for GPS search

Conflicting info for session and privacy

Error in fix

Reject from PDE

Ending session due to traffic channel exit

Ending session due to E911 call

Added protocol specific error type

Ending because base station info is stale

Invalid client ID parameter

Bad service parameter

Bad session type parameter

Bad download parameter

Bad net access parameter

Bad operation parameter

Bad number of fixes parameter

53

54

61

62

63

64

65

66

67

68

80

81

82

83

45

46

47

48

49

50

51

52

39

40

41

42

43

44

Wrong server Information parameters

Error in timeout parameter

Error in quality of service parameter

No session active while trying to end session

Session active for this client

Session busy status

Phone is offline

Phone is CDMA locked

GPS is locked

The command is invalid in this state.

Connection failure with PDE.

Internal software communication problem

Communication problems with search engine

GPS results cannot be reported at this time

Mode not supported

Unknown problem was found

No buffers available

Invalid client ID

Error in parameter to set

Error in lock type

Phone is offline state

An active command is running

Wrong app info

Unknown problem was found

Begin a GPS session

End of the GPS session

Begin a data download session

End of the download session

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 166

Chapter 20 – Unsolicited AT Result Codes

gpsOne Session Prompt +WPUST

Description:

This unsolicited response is used to indicate that user input is required for a network initiated gpsOne session. This response is output when the AT+WPDCT specified value is 2 (prompt). User input must be entered with 20 seconds of this response output. If user input is not received, the network initiated gpsOne session is refused.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WPUST: <message>

Example Result

+WPUST: GPS User Consent Required

Note: User input requested to accept/reject network initiated gpsOne session.

+WPUST: GPS User Consent Timed Out

Note: No user input within 20 seconds. gpsOne session rejected.

Download PRL Status +DPRL

Description: This response is used to report the validation status of a downloaded PRL. Validation of the downloaded

PRL data is performed when the +WCMT=1 command is issued to save the PRL to NV Ram. See the

‘Download PRL’ command (+DPRL) in section 16 for additional information about the process used to download and activate a PRL using the AT command interface.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +DPRL: <status>

Example Result

+DPRL: 0

Note: Downloaded PRL validation successful.

<status>

0

Validation successful

1 Validation unsuccessful

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 167

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

Chapter 21 – AT Command

Examples

This chapter gives illustrative examples of general AT command usage.

General Examples

Status and Module Information Commands

AT+WGMI

+WGMI: WAVECOM MODEM

OK

AT+WHWV

Display module manufacturer

+WHWV: 240.82,0

OK

AT+CGMR

+CGMR: S/W VER: WISMOQ

OK

AT+CGSN

+CGSN: F6918AD6

OK

AT+CIMI

+CIMI: 310008588354034

OK

AT+GCAP

Display module hardware revision information

MSM 6050 chipset, hardware version not set

Display module software revision information

WZ2.04V May 05 2004 15:43:21

Display module electronic serial number (ESN)

Display module IMSI number

Display module capabilities

+GCAP: +CGSM, +CIS707-A, +MS, +ES, +DS, +FCLASS

OK

AT+CMEE=1 Enable detail reporting of mobile equipment errors

OK

Network and Capabilities Commands

AT+CPAS

+CPAS: 0

OK

AT+WSTR

Display module activity status

Module is ready to receive commands

Display initialization status and network availability

Initialization in progress and network available +WSTR:1,2

OK

AT+CREG

+CREG:0,2

OK

AT+CSS?

+CSS: 1,CB,4,6,510

OK

AT+CCED

+CSQ:99, 99

+CCED:0,1,738,0,0,6,,0,,,-99,-37,-63

OK

AT+WIND=200

OK

Display network registration and roaming

Display serving system parameters

Display cell environment information

Signal quality and frame error rate

Mode=0, Band Class=1, Channel=738, etc.

Set module to display network and AT command ready indications

Voice/Data Call Examples

Originate Voice Call

AT+CLCC

+CLCC: 0,9,0

OK

AT+CLIR=0

OK

ATD18001234567;

OK

+WORG:18001234567

+WCNT:3

....Conversation

ATH

OK

+WEND:10

Display current call state

No call in progress

Enable out going caller id

Make a voice call (final semicolon character required for voice call)

ATD Command is being processed

Indication of call origination sent to the Base Station with dialing string 18001234567

Call connected with CDMA Service Option 3, Traffic channel established

Release the call

ATH command is being processed

Call end, reason 10 (Normal Release)

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 168

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

Incoming Voice Call

AT+CLIP=1

OK

AT+CNUM

+CNUM: “Phone”,”8585551212”,129

OK

…Incoming call…

+RING

+CLIP: "8585552323",129

ATA

OK

+WANS

+WCNT:3

…Conversation…

Enable incoming caller id presentation

Display module phone number

Incoming call indication

Identification of the remote party

Answer the call

ATA command is being processed

Call has been answered

Call Connected with CDMA Service Option 3, Traffic channel established

+WEND:6 Call ended, end reason 6 (Normal Release), call released by the remote party

Call Waiting

ATD8585551212;

OK

+WORG:8585551212

+WCNT:3

…Conversation…

+CCWA:”8582701234”,129

AT+WFSH

OK

+WFSH

…Conversation…

AT+WFSH

OK

+WFSH

Make a voice call (final semicolon character required for voice call)

ATD Command is being processed

Indication of call origination sent to the Base Station with dialing string 18001234567

Call Connected with CDMA Service Option 3, Traffic channel established.

Conversation with party

Indication of another incoming call, Audio beep sound in the earpiece

Send a flash to the Base Station (toggle to the second incoming call).

AT command is being executed.

Flash sent to the Base Station. Call switches to the second call; this is not 100% guaranteed because the there is no confirmation from the Base Station.

Conversation with party

Send a flash to the Base Station (toggle back to the first call).

AT command is being executed.

Flash sent to the Base Station. Call switches to the first call; this is not 100% guaranteed because the there is no confirmation from the Base Station.

Conversation with party …Conversation… repeat as necessary

ATH

OK

+WEND:10

Release all of the calls

ATH command is being executed

Calls End

Originate Data Call

…Host configured…

ATD#777

CONNECT

…PPP negotiation…

…PPP layer shutdown…

NO CARRIER

AT

OK

Host application configured for PPP dial up access

Initiate data call (no final semicolon character), number string is carrier specific

Data call connected

PPP layer startup and data exchange

Host application terminates PPP session

Data call terminated

Module re-enters command mode

Originate Data Call Failure

…Host configured…

ATD#777

Host application configured for PPP dial up access initiate data call (no final semicolon character), number string is carrier specific

Depending on the PPP session failure point, the module may not enter back into command mode until a network server timeout forces

PPP session shutdown. For a broken data pipe situation, the “+++” command can be used to force the module back into command mode.

NO CARRIER

AT

OK

Data call terminated

Module re-enters command mode

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 169

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

Short Message Examples

Receive Short Message

AT+CNMI=2,1,1,1,0

OK

+CMTI:"MT",0

AT+CNMI=2,2,1,1,0

OK

+CMT:"8585551212","02/05/17,10 :43 :07",129,1,2,0,”5550000”,17

Test SMS Message

AT+CNMA

OK

SMS-DELIVER stored in NV, SMS-STATUS-REPORT routed to TE

New message received and stored in “MT” memory at index 0

SMS-DELIVER routed to TE

Received message.

Acknowledge the received message to the network.

Send Short Message

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”

This is the first text line

This is the last text line

+CMGS: 1

Send a SMS-SUBMIT to mobile phone <CR> (0x0D)

Enter first line and press carriage return <CR> (0x0D)

Enter last line and send message by press <ctrl-Z> (0x1A)

Success: message reference 1 is returned from the SMS Service Center

+CDS:2,1,"8582431439",129,"02/05/17,10 :14 :17","02/05/17,10 :14 :27",32768

Success: report of successful message delivery received. Time of sending of the message and receiving of the acknowledgment from the SMS Service Center is reported along with the status code.

Send Unicode Short Message

AT+WSCL=6,4

OK

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”

Specify SMS in Chinese language and Unicode format

<Unicode formatted record>

<Unicode record terminator>

+CMGS: 2

Send a SMS-SUBMIT to mobile phone

0x81 0x05 0x13 0x53 0x95 0xA6 0x8F 0xFF (See section 20.11)

Record must end with 0x00 0x1A

Success: message reference 2 is returned from the SMS Service Center

+CDS:2,1,"8585551212",129,"02/05/17,10 :14 :17","02/05/17,10 :14 :27",32768

Success: report of successful message delivery received. Time of sending of the message and receiving of the acknowledgment from the SMS Service Center is reported along with the status code.

Send Short Message with Priority and Call Back Number

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”,24,2,”2345678901”

This is the message line

Store SMS message in mobile phone, length 24 characters, priority 2, call back number

“2345678901”

The SMS will be stored when 24 characters are entered

The SMS message is stored in the first location +CMGW: 0

OK

AT+CMSS=0 Send the SMS message stored at location index 0

+CMSS: 3 Success: message reference 3 is returned from the SMS Service Center

OK

+CDS:2,1,"8582431437",129,"03/04/11,14 :10 :56","03/04/11,14 :11 :02",32768

Success: report of successful message delivery received. Time of sending of the message and receiving of the acknowledgment from the SMS Service Center is reported along with the status code.

Read Short Message

AT+CPMS=”MT”

OK

AT+CPMS?

+CPMS:2,10,1,10

OK

Set Mobile Terminated as preferred memory storage

Display current message status

There are 2 MT and 1 MO messages stored

AT+CMGL=”ALL” List all stored messages

+CMGL:0,"REC READ","8585551111",1,2,15

Test message #1

+CMGL:1,"REC UNREAD","8585552222",1,2,15

Test message #2

+CMGL:0,"STO UNSENT","8585551212",1,2,24

Test message to be sent.

OK

AT+CMGR=1 Read the first message in currently selected memory storage (previously set by AT+CPMS).

+CMGR:"REC UNREAD","8585552222","02/05/15,15 :54 :04",1,2,0,”5550000”,15

Test message #2

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 170

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

GpsOne Examples

Single-Shot Data Burst gpsOne

AT+WPDST=1

OK

AT+WPDOM=3

OK

AT+WPPRV?

Session type is single-shot

Accuracy optimal operation mode

Display privacy setting

Privacy is set to allow all +WPPRV: 0

OK

AT+WPTLM=1

OK

AT+WPDSS=“PVH”,60,50

OK

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,1,7,#,#,#,#,#

Set gpsOne transport level (DBM); carrier specific capability

Starts the gpsOne session

The result is returned in a +WPDSS unsolicited response

Single-Shot TCPIP gpsOne

AT+WPDST=1

OK

AT+WPDOM=2

OK

AT+WPPRV?

+WPPRV: 0

OK

AT+WPTLM=0

OK

AT+WPDIP=“xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”

OK

AT+WPDPT=xxxx

OK

AT+WPDSS=“P”,60,50

OK

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,0,0,#,#,#,#,#

Session type is single-shot

Speed optimal operation mode

Display privacy setting

Privacy is set to allow all

Set gpsOne transport level (TCPIP); carrier specific capability

Set the IP address; carrier specific value

Set the IP port; carrier specific value

Starts the gpsOne session

The result is returned in a +WPDSS unsolicited response

Continuous Data Burst gpsOne

AT+WPDST=3

OK

AT+WPDOM=3

OK

AT+WPPRV=0

OK

AT+WPTLM=1

OK

AT+WPDFR=5,30

OK

AT+WPDSS=“PV”,60,50

OK

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,1,6,#,#,#,#,#

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,1,6,#,#,#,#,#

AT+WPDES

OK

Session type is continuous

Accuracy optimal operation mode

Set privacy setting to allow all

Set gpsOne transport level (DBM); carrier specific capability

Configure the fix rate settings; five fixes at 30 second intervals

Starts the gpsOne session

The results are returned in +WPDSS unsolicited responses

Can be used to cancel the gpsOne session before all fix results are returned

Mobile Station Based gpsOne Session

The module receives data from the location server to aid in calculation of position. To perform a MS-based gpsOne session, a data download session must happen first (and periodically) to get the latest ephemeris and timing information from the network.

AT+WPPRV=0

OK

AT+WPTLM=1

OK

AT+WPDOM=3

AT+WPDFR=180,10

OK

Set privacy setting to allow all

Set gpsOne transport level (DBM); carrier specific capability

Accuracy optimal operation mode

Configure the fix rate settings; 180 fixes at 10 second intervals; 30 minutes duration.

Ephemeriis and timing information should be updated once every 30 to 120 minutes to maintain positioning accuracy.

< begin loop>

AT+WPDST=4 Set data download session type

OK

AT+WPDDD=0,10 Single-shot data download of latest ephemeris and timing information; 2 nd parameter ignored

Set session type is continuous

OK

AT+WPDST=3

OK

AT+WPDSS=“PVH”,60,50

OK

+WPDSS:#,#,#,#,#,#,1,7,#,#,#,#,#

...

< end loop>

Starts the gpsOne session

Host application processes the data of each +WPDSS unsolicited response.

Repeat loop after last response (180 th in this example) is processed.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 171

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

TCP Connection, Polled Bi-Directional Data Transfer

AT+CMEE=1

OK

AT+WGSS=0

+WGSS: 0,0,1,0,0,0,0

OK

AT+WCRX=0,0

OK

AT+WGSS=0

+WGSS: 0,0,0,0,0,0,0

Enable detailed reporting of mobile equipment errors.

Display TCP connection status.

TCP status, PPPstate “closed”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, All sockets “closed”.

Set TCP receive mode; polled received data.

Display TCP connection status.

TCP status, PPPstate “closed”, RxMode “Polled”, All sockets “closed”.

OK

AT+WPPP=0

OK

+WPPP: 201

+WPPP: 200

AT+WGSS=0

+WGSS: 0,2,0,0,0,0,0

OK

AT+WIPC

+WIPC: 68.25.209.28

OK

AT+WOSK=0,12,57,125,2,24

+WOSK: 0,0

OK

+WSKS: 0,0,1

AT+WGSS=0

+WGSS: 0,2,0,2,0,0,0

OK

AT+WSTX=0,0,5,<cr>HELLO

OK

+WSTX: 0,0,5

+WSKS: 0,0,2

AT+WSRX=0,0

+WSRX: 0,0,5:WORLD

OK

...

AT+WCSK=0,0

OK

+WSKS: 0,0,4

AT+WPPP=2

OK

+WPPP: 203

+WPPP: 202

Start a MIP data call and open a PPP session.

Unsolicited response; PPP session startup in progress.

Unsolicited response; PPP session established and available.

Display TCP connection status.

TCP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Polled”, All sockets “closed”.

Display module IP address.

Open a TCP socket to IP address 12.57.125.2 port 24.

TCP socket zero allocated.

Unsolicited response; TCP socket zero is open.

Display TCP connection status.

TCP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Polled”, Socket zero “open”.

Send “HELLO” to TCP socket zero.

Unsolicited response; five bytes transmitted on TCP socket zero.

Unsolicited response; Received data available on socket zero.

Read and clear TCP socket zero data buffer.

Socket zero data “WORLD”.

Close TCP socket zero.

Unsolicited response; TCP socket zero is closed.

Close the PPP session and end the data call.

Unsolicited response; PPP session shutdown in progress.

Unsolicited response; PPP session closed.

TCP Connection, Unsolicited Received Data

For this example, we’ll assume that TCP socket zero has been previously opened for some other non-related purpose and TCP

“Unsolicited” receive mode is set.

AT+WOSK=0,168,0,0,2,42

+WOSK: 0,1

OK

+WSKS: 0,1,1

Open a TCP socket to IP address 168.0.0.2 port 42.

TCP socket one allocated.

Unsolicited response; TCP socket one is open.

AT+WGSS=0

+WGSS: 0,2,1,2,2,0,0

OK

Display TCP connection status.

TCP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, Socket zero “open”,

Socket one “open”.

AT+WSTX=0,1,5,<cr>HELLO

OK

+WSTX: 0,1,5

+WSRX: 0,1,5:WORLD

OK

+WSKS: 0,1,4

Send “HELLO” to TCP socket one.

Unsolicited response; five bytes transmitted on TCP socket one.

Unsolicited response; 5 bytes of data received on TCP socket one.

“WORLD”

AT+WCSK=0,1 Close TCP socket one.

AT+WGSS=0

+WGSS: 0,2,1,2,0,0,0

OK

Unsolicited response; TCP socket one is closed.

Display TCP connection status.

TCP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, Socket zero “open”,

Socket one “closed”.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 172

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

UDP Connection, DNS Lookup, Unsolicited Received Data

AT+WCRX=1,1

OK

AT+WPPP=1,user,password

OK

+WPPP: 201

Set UDP receive mode; unsolicited received data.

Start a SIP data call and open a PPP session.

+WPPP: 200

AT+WGSS=1

+WGSS: 1,2,1,0,0,0,0

OK

Unsolicited response; PPP session startup in progress.

Unsolicited response; PPP session established and available.

Display UDP connection status.

UDP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, All sockets “closed”.

AT+WDNS=”www.myurl.org"

OK

+WDNS: 0

AT+WDNS=”www.myurl.org”

+WDNS : 216.37.68.117

OK

Look up IP address on DNS server.

Unsolicited response; Communication with DNS server completed.

Display DNS server lookup result.

IP address of ”www.myurl.org".

AT+WOSK=1,216,37,68,117,250

+WOSK: 1,0

OK

+WSKS: 1,0,1

AT+WGSS=1

+WGSS: 1,2,1,2,0,0,0

OK

AT+WSTX=1,0,5,<cr>HELLO

OK

+WSTX: 1,0,5

+WSRX: 1,0,5:WORLD

+WPPP: 202

Open a UDP socket to IP address 216.37.68.117 port 250.

UDP socket zero allocated.

Unsolicited response; UDP socket zero is open.

Display UDP connection status.

UDP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, Socket zero “open”.

Send HELLO to UDP socket zero.

Unsolicited response; Five bytes transmitted on UDP socket zero.

Close the PPP session and end the data call.

Unsolicited response; PPP session closed.

Unsolicited response; PPP session shutdown in progress.

Unsolicited response; 5 bytes of data received on UDP socket zero.

“WORLD”

AT+WCSK=1,0 Close UDP socket zero.

OK

+WSKS: 1,0,4

AT+WGSS=1

Unsolicited response; UDP socket zero is closed.

Display UDP connection status.

UDP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, Socket zero “closed”. +WGSS: 1,2,1,0,0,0,0

OK

AT+WPPP=2

OK

+WPPP: 203

UDP Connection, Blocked Data Transmission

AT+WPPP=0

OK

+WPPP: 201

Start a MIP data call and open a PPP session.

+WPPP: 200

AT+WOSK=1,216,37,68,117,250

+WOSK: 1,0

OK

+WSKS: 1,0,1

AT+WGSS=1

+WGSS: 1,2,1,2,0,0,0

OK

AT+WSTX=1,0,500,<data>

OK

+WSTX: 1,0,500

Unsolicited response; PPP session startup in progress.

Unsolicited response; PPP session established and available.

Open a UDP socket to IP address 216.37.68.117 port 250.

UDP socket zero allocated.

Unsolicited response; UDP socket zero is open.

Display UDP connection status.

UDP status, PPPstate “open”, RxMode “Unsolicited”, Socket zero “open”.

Send 500 bytes of data on UDP socket zero.

Unsolicited response; 500 bytes transmitted on UDP socket zero.

… Other +WSTX commands and +WSTX responses for data transfers.

Send 500 bytes of data on UDP socket zero. AT+WSTX=1,0,500,<data>

+CME ERROR : 3

+WSTE: 1,0,102

AT+WGSS=1

+WGSS: 1,2,1,2,0,0,0

OK

Blocked data transmission on UDP socket zero.

Display UDP connection status.

UDP status: PPPstate “open” and Socket zero “open”. Blocking condition due to full socket buffer.

+WSKS: 1,0,1

AT+WSTX=1,0,500,<data>

OK

+WSTX: 0,500

UDP socket zero available for data transmission.

Resend the failed 500 bytes of data on UDP socket zero.

Unsolicited response; resend good. 500 bytes transmitted on UDP socket zero.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 173

AT+WSTX=1,0,500,<data>

+CME ERROR : 3

+WSTE: 0,114

AT+WGSS=1

+WGSS: 1,2,1,0,0,0,0

OK

AT+WOSK=1,216,37,68,117,250

+WOSK: 1,0

OK

+WSKS: 1,0,1

Chapter 21 – AT Command Examples

Other +WSTX commands and +WSTX responses for data transfers.

Send 500 bytes of data on UDP socket zero.

Lost UDP socket zero connection.

Display UDP connection status.

UDP status: PPPstate “open” and Socket zero “closed”.

Re-open a UDP socket to IP address 216.37.68.117 port 250.

UDP socket zero allocated.

Unsolicited response; UDP socket zero is open.

Host application specific recovery process.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 174

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Chapter 22 – Verizon ® Specific

AT Commands

This chapter details AT commands that are Verizon® specific. The detail presented in this chapter should replace the referenced section in the main document.

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS

Description:

This response indicates an SMS status report has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be directly displayed. +CDS is also used in the data compression functionality as an active command. Refer to Chapter 16 for an explanation of +CDS usage for data compression.

For Verizon®, the +CDS response has a secondary format that is used to indicate that a SMS message was delivered to the recipient (SMS message delivery ACK on). This form of the +CDS message is not stored in

NV memory. In the case of delivery acknowledgement, the +CNMI setting will not have an effect and delivery acknowledgements will always be reported with the +CDS response.

Values: <ind> Message type indicator

0

Status report

1 MO delivery acknowledge message

<mr>

Message Reference

<ra> Recipient Address

<tora>

Type-of-Address of <ra>

<scts> Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

<dt> Discharge Time in string format: “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz” (Year [00-99], Month

[01-12], Day [01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour])

<st> Status of a SMS-STATUS-REPORT (See chapter 19)

Message reference. The Id of the sent message.

“<date>,<time>”

Syntax:

MO message delivery acknowledgment.

Response Syntax:

+CDS: <ind>, <mr>, [<ra>], [<tora>], <scts>, <dt>, <st> (Text mode)

Example Result

+CDS: <ind>, <msg id>,”<date>,<time>”,<delivery ack body>

+CDS: 0, 2, 116, ”3146290800”, 129, “98/10/01,12 :30 :07+04”, “98/10/01 12 :30 :08+04”, 0

Note: SMS status report received

+CDS: 1, 3, "03/09/11,14 :52 :53", Message to 8582431438 delivered

Note: SMS acknowledge report received. "Message to 8582431438 delivered" is the ack message body.

Incoming Message Directly Displayed +CMT

Description:

This response indicates that an incoming message has been received and, according to the message

Values: storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be directly displayed.

<oa>

Originator Address. <oa> will be displayed only if the message <privacy> value is normal (0).

Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

Type-of-Address of <oa>

<lang>

Encoding method

<priority>

0 Normal

1 Interactive

2 Urgent

3 Emergency

Call Back Number

<length>

<data>

Syntax: Response syntax:

+CMT: <oa>, <scts>, <tooa>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority> [,<cbn>], <length> <CR><LF>

<data> (text mode)

Example Result

+CMT: “123456”,”98/10/01,12 :3000+00”,129,1,2,0,”5550000”,5<CR><LF>

Hello

Note: Incoming message received

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 175

Roaming Indication +WROM

Description

: This response indicates that the roaming status has changed.

Values: <roam>

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Roam Icon Off (Home)

2

The following values apply to enhanced roaming:

3

Out of Building

5

Roaming - Available System

7

Roaming - Premium Partner

9

10

11

Syntax:

13 – 63 Reserved for Standard Enhanced Roaming Indicator Numbers

64 – 93

Enhanced Roaming Indicator (+WERI response)

94 – 255 Reserved

Response Syntax:

+WROM: <roam>

Possible Responses

+WROM:1

Enhanced Roaming Indication +WERI

Description:

This response indicates that the enhanced roaming status has changed.

Values: <indicator>

64-93

<icon image>

0-15

<icon mode>

0-3

<call prompt> indicator. This field is set to a value of ZERO when no call prompt is used. Note that this field is currently not implemented in the Verizon®. user interface specs. It may be used in the future.

<alert/call id>

Verizon®. defined value that identifies the Alert Sound that is used for the indicator. The value in this field reflects the ID of the Alert Sound that the mobile annunciates to the end user.

<chari type>

Syntax: the <text> field. (Usually set to 2.)

Type Bit Length Character Encoding

0

1

8 see IS-91

Octet, unspecified

IS-91 Extended Protocol Message

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

10-31

7

7

16

8 or 16

8 or 16

8

8

7 x

7-bit ASCII (ANSI x3.4)

IA5 (Table 11 of ITU-T T.50)

UNICODE (ISO/IEC 10646-1:1993)

Shift-JIS

Korean (KS x 1001:1998)

Latin/Hebrew (ISO 8859-8:1988)

Latin (ISO 8859-8:1988)

GSM 7-bit default alphabet

Reserved

Verizon® defined variable length field that contains the text data used for the banner. The text format is specified in the Character Encoding Type. Text field limit: 32 character max length.

Response Syntax: +WERI: <indicator>, <icon image>, <icon mode>, <call prompt>, <alert/call id>, <chari type>, <text>

Command Possible Responses

Note: Example of acquiring service with enhanced roaming.

Note: Example of acquiring service without enhanced roaming.

+WERI: 69,2,0,0,4,2,”Extended Network”

+WROM:2

Note: Both +WERI and +WROM responses.

+WROM:1

Note: No +WERI response.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 176

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Emergency Mode +WSOS

Description:

This unsolicited response indicates that a change in the status of Emergency Mode has taken place. In the event that Emergency Mode is entered as the result of an emergency call, this response will be sent to indicate that the modem is now in emergency mode. After this point, to exit out of Emergency Mode, an

Values:

AT+WSOS or AT+COPS command must be sent, which will result in a +WSOS response to confirm that

Emergency Mode has been exited. See +WSOS, section for more information about Emergency Mode.

<flag>

Syntax:

Emergency Mode Entered

For Verizon® releases, the +WSOS:0 result code will also be sent to indicate that emergency mode has been exited in the following cases:

After an emergency call is released and five minutes have passed without another emergency call.

After an emergency call is released and the user dials a non-emergency number.

Response Syntax:

+WSOS: <flag>

Command Possible Responses

ATD911;

Note: Make emergency call

OK

+WSOS:1

+WORG:911

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms Emergency Mode is entered

AT+WSOS

Note: Exit Emergency Mode

AT+COPS=0,0

Note: While in Emergency Mode, the mode preference is changed, resulting in Emergency Mode being exited

OK

+WSOS:0

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms Emergency Mode is exited

OK

+WSOS:0

+COPS:0,0

Note: Unsolicited +WSOS result confirms emergency mode exited and unsolicited +COPS result confirms Automatic mode is requested

Read Message +CMGR

Description:

This command allows the application to read stored messages. The messages are read from the memory selected by +CPMS command. A message read with status “REC UNREAD” will be updated in memory with the status “REC READ”.

Note:

Values:

The <stat> parameter for SMS Status Reports is always “READ”. tat>

Status of message in memory. Possible values are as follows:

Possible Values

Status of Messages in Memory

“UREAD”

“READ”

“USENT” received unread messages received read messages stored unsent messages

“SENT”

“ALL” stored sent messages all messages

Note:

For SMS Status Reports, only “ALL” and “READ” values of the <stat> parameter will list messages ; other values will only return OK.

<oa/da> message <privacy> value is 0 (Normal).

<mr>

Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

Discharge Time in string format: “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz” (Year [00-99], Month [01-12], Day

[01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour] )

Status of a SMS-STATUS-REPORT (See Chapter 19)

<lang>

Encoding

<priority>

Normal

Interactive

3

Message privacy:

0

3

Restricted

Confidential

Secret

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 177

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Message reply option:

No

Call Back Number

<length>

Syntax:

Message text

Command syntax:

AT+CMGR=<index>

Response syntax: +CMGR :<stat> [,<oa>], <scts>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority>, <privacy>, <reply>

[,<cbn>], <length> <CR><LF> <data> (for SMS-DELIVER only)

+CMGR: <stat> [,<da>], <dt>, <lang>, <encod>, <priority>, <privacy>, <reply>, <cbn>],

<length> <CR><LF> <data> (for SMS-SUBMIT only)

+CMGR: <stat>,<mr>,<scts>,<dt>,<st> (for SMS-STATUS-REPORT only)

Command Possible Responses

“MT”,1

Note: New message received

AT+CMGR=1

Note: Read the message

+CMGR: “REC UNREAD”,”8585551212”, ”98/10/01,18 :22

:11+00”,1,2,0,0,0,”8585550000”,9<CR><LF>

AT+CMGR=1

Note: Read the message again

ABCdefGHI

OK

+CMGR: “REC READ”,”8585551212”, ”98/10/01,18 :22

:11”,1,2,0,0,0,”8585550000”,9<CR><LF>

ABCdefGHI

OK

Note: Message is read now

AT+CMGR=2

Note: Read at a wrong index

AT+CPMS=”SR”;+CNMI=,,,2

Note: Reset to text mode, set read memory to “SR”, and allow storage of further SMS

Status Report into “SR” memory

AT+CMSS=3

Note: Send an SMS previously stored

+CMS ERROR: 321

Note: Error : invalid index

+CPMS:0,10,0,10

OK

+CMSS: 160

OK

AT+CMGR=1

Note: Read the SMS Status Report

Note: New SMS Status Report stored in “SR” memory at index

1

+CMGR: “READ”,160, “8585551212”,129,”01/05/31,15:15:09”,

“01/05/31,15:15:09”,0

OK

List Message +CMGL

Description: This command allows the application to read stored messages, by indicating the type of the message to read. The messages are read from the memory selected by the +CPMS command.

Values: <index> Place of storage in memory.

<stat>

Possible Values

“UREAD”

“READ”

“USENT”

Status of Messages in Memory received unread messages received read messages stored unsent messages

“SENT”

“ALL” stored sent messages all messages

Note:

For SMS Status Reports, only “ALL” and “READ” values of the <stat> parameter will list messages; other values will only return OK.

Origination/destination address value in string format. <od/da> will be displayed only if the message <privacy> value is 0 (Normal).

First Octet, coded like SMS-SUBMIT first octet in document [4], default value is 17 for SMS-

SUBMIT

Message Reference

<dt>

[01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour] )

<st>

Language

<encod>

Length of the text message (in bytes).

<data>

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 178

Syntax

:

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Command syntax:

AT+CMGL=<stat>

Response syntax: +CMGL : <index>,<stat>,<da/oa>,<lang>, <encod>,<length><CR><LF><data> (for

SMS-DELIVER and SMS-SUBMIT

, may be followed by other <CR><LF>+CMGL:<index>…)

+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<fo>,<mr>,<scts>,<dt>,<st> (for SMS-STATUS-REPORT only, may be followed by other <CR><LF>+CMGL:<index>…)

Command Possible Responses

AT+CMGL=“UREAD”

Note: List unread messages in text mode

AT+CMGL=”READ”

Note: List read messages in text mode

AT+CMGL=”SENT”

Note: List stored and sent messages in text mode

+CMGL: 1,”REC

UNREAD”,”8585551212”,1,2,15

<CR><LF>Unread message!

+CMGL: 3,”REC UNREAD”, “8585551212”, 1,2,5<CR><LF>Hello

OK

Another message unread!

Note: 2 messages are unread, these messages will then have their status changed to “REC READ” (+CSDH:0)

+CMGL: 2,”REC READ”,”8585551212”,1,2,9

<CR><LF>

Keep cool

OK

OK

Note: No message found

Send Message +CMGS

Description: The <da> field is the address of the terminal to which the message is sent. To send the text message, type

<ctrl-Z> (0x1A) as the final character of the message. This command can be aborted using the <ESC>

(0x1B) character while entering the message text.

The <length> parameter is optional, it is used to set the length of the text string. When <length> is specified, the CMGS command will only process the number of bytes specified by <length> regardless of whether it

Values Note: The <priority>, <privacy>, <reply option>, and <cbn> parameters are optional.

Defaults are used when parameters are not specified.

Values: <da> Destination address value in string format.

<length>

Message priority:

0 (Default)

1

2

Emergency

0 (Default)

1 Restricted

2

Secret

0

Message reply option:

No Acknowledge (Default)

1

<cbn>

Syntax: Command syntax: text <ctrl-Z / ESC>

Command

AT+CMGS=<da> [,<length>] [,<priority>] [,<privacy>] [,<reply>] [,<cbn>] <CR> entered

Possible Responses

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”<cr>

Please call me soon, Fred. <ctrl-Z>

Note: Send a message

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”,12 <cr>

Please call.<ctrl-Z>

Note: Send 12 byte message

AT+CMGS=”8585551212”,,2,1,1,”5550000” <cr>

Please call ASAP<ctrl-Z>

Note: Send a message with the specified priority, privacy, reply option and call back number. Notice length field is omitted.

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

+CMGS:<mr>

OK

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 179

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Write Message to Memory +CMGW

Description:

This command stores a message in memory (SMS-SUBMIT). The memory location <index> is returned (no choice possible as with phonebooks +CPBW). A text or Unicode message is entered as described for the

Send Message +CMGS command.

Values Notes: The <length> parameter is optional, it is used to set the length of the text string. When <length> is specified, the CMGW command will only process the number of bytes specified by <length> regardless of whether it contains <ctrl-Z>, <ESC>, or <backspace> characters.

Defaults are used when parameters are not specified.

Values:

The <priority>, <privacy>, <reply option>, and <cbn> parameters are optional.

<oa/da>

Origination/destination address value in string format.

Length of the text message (in bytes).

<priority>

0 (Default)

1

2

Emergency

0 (Default)

Restricted

Confidential

0

1

<cbn>

Syntax:

Message reply option:

No Acknowledge (Default)

Command syntax: AT+CMGS= <oa/da> [,<length>] [,<priority>] [,<privacy>] [,<reply>] [,<cbn>] <CR> entered text

<ctrl-Z / ESC>

Response syntax: +CMGW: <index> or +CMS ERROR: <err> if writing fails

Command Possible Responses

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”<CR>

Hello how are you ?<ctrl-Z>

Note: Write a message

+CMGW: 4

OK

Note: Message stored in index 4

AT+CMGW=”8587777777”,6<CR>

¥IÅàø?<ctrl-Z>

Note: Write a message with specified length of 6 bytes

AT+CMGW=”8585551212”,,2,1,1,”5550000”

Please call ASAP<ctrl-Z>

Note: Write message with the specified priority, privacy, reply option & call back number. Note length field is omitted.

Service Programming Code +WSPC

+CMGW: <index>

OK

Note: Message stored in <index>

+CMGW: 5

OK

Note: Message stored in index 5

Description: This command allows for entry of the service programming code (either MSL or OTKSL). Upon successful entry of this code, all other service provisioning AT commands may be used. If this code is not properly entered prior to attempting other provisioning AT commands, all provisioning commands will return ERROR.

If the OTKSL is used to enter provisioning mode, only the +WIMI, +WMDN, and +WCMT commands will be

Values: allowed. All other commands will return ERROR.

This command supports fifteen attempts to enter the correct service programming code. If fifteen incorrect attempts are performed, the ME will report a message and go into offline mode.

Once the correct SPC code is entered, the modem transitions to the Service Programming state. This state is not exited until a commit is done (+WCMT). While in the Service Programming state, subsequent validations of the SPC code are ignored until the Service Programming state is reset.

<lock type>

0

Syntax:

<code>

Six character programming code.

Command syntax:

AT+WSPC=<lock type>,<code>

Command

AT+WSPC?

Note: Service programming code request

AT+WSPC=?

AT+WSPC=1,111111

Note: Enter service programming code 111111

AT+WSPC=1,000000

Note: Enter service programming code 000000

Possible Responses

ERROR

Note: Invalid request

ERROR Note: Invalid request

ERROR

Note: Code invalid

OK

Note: Code valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 180

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Verizon® System Selection +WVSS

Description:

This command is used to set the system selection and is persistent on reset. The values that are available

Values: with the +WVSS command are dependent upon the currently loaded PRL.

<pref>

Preferred only systems:

Home Only - Service on home systems

1 systems:

0

Syntax:

Automatic-A - Roaming allowed on affiliated systems and any A band system

3

Command Syntax: +WVSS: <pref>

Command

AT+WVSS=?

Note: Show supported parameters

AT+WVSS?

Note: Get current setting

AT+WVSS=0

Note: Set home only

Possible Responses

+WVSS: (0-3)

OK

+WVSS: 1

OK

OK

Note: Home only mode set.

AT+WVSS=3

Note: Set automatic-B mode

ERROR

Note: Automatic-B mode not allowed in preferred only service.

Initial Programming Required +WOT0

Description:

This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that initial device programming is required.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WOT0: “Initial programming required!”

Possible Responses

+WOT0: “Initial programming required!”

Programming In Progress +WOT1

Description

: This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that device programming is in

Syntax: progress.

Response Syntax:

+WOT1: “Programming in progress”

Possible Responses

+WOT1: “Programming in progress”

Programming Successful +WOT2

Description: This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that device programming has

Syntax: completed successfully. This response will be accompanied by three quick audio tones from the speaker.

Response Syntax:

+WOT2: “Programming Successful”

Possible Responses

+WOT2: “Programming Successful”

Programming Unsuccessful +WOT3

Description: This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that device programming has completed unsuccessfully. This response will be accompanied by three quick audio tones from the speaker.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WOT3: “Programming Unsuccessful”

Possible Responses

+WOT3: “Programming Unsuccessful”

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 181

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Commit Successful +WOTC

Description:

This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that the programmed parameters have

Syntax: be successfully committed to NVRAM.

Response Syntax:

+WOTC: “Commit Successful”

Possible Responses

+WOTC: “Commit Successful”

SPL Unlocked +WOTS

Description: This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that the Software Provisioning Lock is

Syntax: in the unlocked state.

Response Syntax: +WOTS: “SPL unlocked”

Possible Responses

+WOTS: “SPL unlocked”

NAM Download OK +WOTN

Description: This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that the NAM download has completed successfully.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WOTN: “NAM Download OK”

Possible Responses

+WOTN: “NAM Download OK”

MDM Download OK +WOTM

Description:

This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that the MDM download has completed

Syntax: successfully.

Response Syntax:

+WOTM: “MDM Download OK”

Possible Responses

+WOTM: “MDM Download OK”

MSI Download OK +WOTI

Description:

This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that the IMSI download has completed

Syntax: successfully.

Response Syntax:

+WOTI: “IMSI Download OK”

Possible Responses

+WOTI: “IMSI Download OK”

PRL Download OK +WOTP

Description: This Over-The-Air Service Provisioning (OTASP) response indicates that the PRL download has completed successfully.

Syntax: Response Syntax: +WOTP: “PRL Download OK”

Possible Responses

+WOTP: “PRL Download OK”

Excess SPC Failures +WLCK

Description: This response indicates that 15 failed attempts have been made to enter the service programming code. If the modem is not in emergency mode, any active call will be terminated and the modem will go into offline

Note:

Syntax: mode.

A successfully entered service programming code grants access to modem configuration data.

Response Syntax:

Command

+WLCK: “Excess SPC failures!”

Possible Responses

AT+WSPC=0,123456

Note: 15 th attempt to enter the SPC.

+WLCK: “Excess SPC failures!”

Note: Modem now in offline mode.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 182

Chapter 22 – Verizon® Specific AT Commands

Position Determination Lock Level +WPLCK

Description:

This command specifies and returns the position determination lock setting. If the lock is set to ‘lock all’, then only E911-related position determination events are allowed and all other position determination requests are denied.

Values: <level>

0

Lock mobile initiated location services

2

Syntax:

Lock all

Command syntax:

AT+WPLCK=<level>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WPLCK=?

Note: Display valid parameter range

AT+WPLCK?

Note: Request current setting type

AT+WPLCK=3

Note: Select lock all

+WPLCK: (0-3)

OK

+WPLCK: 0

OK

OK

Note: Command successful

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 183

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT

Commands

This chapter details AT commands that are Sprint® specific. The command presented in this chapter should replace the corresponding general commands in the main document.

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS

Description:

This response indicates an SMS status report has been received and according to the message storage preferences (+CNMI), is to be directly displayed. +CDS is also used in the data compression functionality as an active command. Refer to Chapter 16 for an explanation of +CDS usage for data compression.

For Sprint®, the +CDS response has a secondary format that is used to indicate that a SMS message was delivered to the recipient (SMS message delivery ACK on). This form of the +CDS message is not stored in

NV memory. In the case of delivery acknowledgement, the +CNMI setting will not have an effect and delivery acknowledgements will always be reported with the +CDS response.

Values: <ind>

0

Message type indicator

Status report

1 MO delivery acknowledge message

<mr>

Message Reference

<ra> Recipient Address

<tora>

Type-of-Address of <ra>

<scts>

Service Center Time Stamp in string format : “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz”

(Year/Month/Day,Hour:Min:Seconds±TimeZone)

<dt>

Discharge Time in string format: “yy/MM/dd,hh :mm :ss±zz” (Year [00-99], Month

[01-12], Day [01-31], Hour, Minute, Second and Time Zone [quarters of an hour])

<st>

Status of a SMS-STATUS-REPORT (See Chapter 19)

Message reference. The Id of the sent message.

“<date>,<time>”

Syntax: Response Syntax:

+CDS: <ind>, <mr>, [<ra>], [<tora>], <scts>, <dt>, <st> (Text mode)

+CDS: <ind>, <msg id>,”<date>,<time>”,<delivery ack body>

Example Result

+CDS: 0, 2, 116, ”3146290800”, 129, “98/10/01,12 :30 :07+04”, “98/10/01 12 :30 :08+04”, 0

Note: SMS status report received

+CDS: 1, 3, "03/09/11,14 :52 :53", Message to 8582431438 delivered

Note: SMS acknowledge report received. "Message to 8582431438 delivered" is the ack message body.

Set Phone Functionality +CFUN

Description:

This command selects the mobile station’s level of functionality. AT+CFUN=0 is equivalent to AT+CPOF

The AT+CFUN=1 (by default, AT+CFUN will act the same as AT+CFUN=1) command restarts the entire

CDMA stack and CDMA functionality: a complete software reset is performed. In addition, the OK

Values: response will be sent at the last baud rate defined by the +IPR command.

If an emergency call is made in OFFLINE mode, the modem will reset and immediately after boot, originate the emergency call. The functionality of +WSOS is unchanged.

<functionality level>

Syntax:

Set the phone to OFFLINE mode.

1

Command syntax:

AT+CFUN=<functionality level>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CFUN?

Note: Ask for current functionality level

AT+CFUN=0

Note: Set phone offline

AT+CFUN=1

Note: Set phone ONLINE. A software reset is performed.

+CFUN: 1

OK

Note: Full functionality

OK

Note: Command valid

Note: Command valid

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 184

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

Signal Quality +CSQ

Description: This command will return the raw RSSI data, raw Ec/Io, and the channel frame error rate.

Values: <raw rssi> valid value range in units of -dBm

255

<raw Ec/lo>

255

<fer>

Syntax:

Traffic channel error rate

255

Command syntax: AT+CSQ

Command Possible Responses

AT+CSQ +CSQ: <raw rssi>,<raw Ec/Io>,<fer>

OK Note: <raw rssi>, <raw Ec/lo>, and <fer> as defined above

Facility Lock +CLCK

Description:

This command is used by the application to lock, unlock, or interrogate an ME or network facility <fac>.

When changing a lock state, a password value must be included in the command even though passwords are not currently enforced for these facilities. Any 4-digit sequence can be entered for the password value.

Values:

This command is also used to allow control of the call barring supplementary service. Barring calls or querying the status of call barring is possible for Data and Voice Calls, except Emergency Voice Calls.

“AO”

<mode>

BAOC (Bar Outgoing Calls)

0

1

Allow all outgoing calls

Allow outgoing calls only for phonebook entries (use ATD> command) and emergency voice calls

Allow emergency voice calls only

2

9 Query status

“AI”

<mode>

0

Allow all incoming calls

1

2

Allow incoming calls only for phonebook entries (match number in phonebook) and emergency voice calls

Allow emergency voice calls only

9 Query status

Note:

Setting this facility to 0 will force the “AO” facility to 0.

“PB”

<mode>

0

1

Allow all outgoing calls

Allow outgoing calls only for phonebook entries

9 Query status

Note:

Setting this facility to 0 will force the “AO” facility to 0.

“DT”

<mode>

0

1

Allow data calls

Barr data calls

9 Query status

<passwd>

Use any four digit value. (e.g. 1234)

Syntax (for Facility Lock):

Command syntax:

AT+CLCK= <fac>,<mode>[,<passwd>]

Response syntax: +CLCK: <status>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CLCK?

Note: Get facility lock status

AT+CLCK=”AO”,1,1234

Note: Bar Outgoing Calls

AT+CLCK=”AI”,1,1234

Note: Bar Incoming Calls

AT+CLCK=”AO”,9

Note: Query outgoing call barring status

+CLCK:(“AO”,1),(“AI”,1),(“PB”,1),(“DT”,1)

OK

Note: Outgoing call barring is enabled, Incoming call barring is enabled, match string from phonebook is enabled, Data calls are not allowed

OK

Note: Outgoing calls are barred

OK

Note: Incoming calls are barred

+CLCK: 1

OK

Note: Outgoing calls are barred

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 185

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

Mobile Directory Number +WMDN

Description:

This command is used to enter a new mobile directory number. Valid numbers are between 10 and 15 digits in length. For support of Wireless Number Portability, changes to the MDN will ALWAYS update the IMSI_M portion (least significant 10 digits) of the IMSI. Changes to the MDN will also automatically update the

Access Overload Class values unless specifically modified using the +WAOC command. The new IMSI_M and Access Overload Class values will not be visible in the WIMI and WAOC commands until after the changes are committed with the WCMT command.

The security PIN (WPIN) is automatically updated using the following logic whenever the +WMDN command is used to change the mobile directory number (MDN).

If (Security PIN = Last 4 digits of MDNold) Then

Set Security PIN = Last 4 digits of MDNnew

Else

Don't Change Security PIN

EndIf

Example 1:

Example 2:

Current PIN = 1234

Current MDN = 5551234 (last 4 digits are the same as PIN digits)

If MDN is set to 5556789, then PIN changes to 6789.

Current PIN = 3456

Current MDN = 5551234 (last 4 digits and the PIN digits are different)

If MDN is set to 5556789, then PIN remains 3456.

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+WMDN=<number>

Command

AT+WMDN?

Note: Get current mobile directory number

AT+WMDN=8585551212

Note: Set mobile directory number to 8585551212

Possible Responses

+WMDN: 8581111111

OK

OK

Serving System +CSS

Description:

The numeric parameter is used to query the serving system.

Values: <Class>

No service

800 MHz

900 MHz

<Band>

Cellular 800

PA – PF PCS 1900

Z

Note For the <Band> parameter, the value will be two letters for PCS. The first will be 'P' and the second will be the block ('A' - 'F').

<SID>

No service

1 – 32767

The mobile station is registered with the system indicated.

99999

IS-95

IS-95A

TSB74

N/A

IS-95B

IS-2000

IS-2000A

J-STD-008C

N/A

N/A

N/A

IS-95B

IS-2000

IS-2000A

<CHANNEL>

0 – Max RF Channel Number

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 186

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

Syntax: Command syntax:

AT+CSS Returns: <Class>,<Band>,<SID>,<BS_P_REV>,<CHANNEL>

Command Possible Responses

AT+CSS?

Note: Display the current setting

AT+CSS=?

Note: Display the range of setting

+CSS: 2, A, 4145, 6, 334

OK

Note: Command is valid

+CSS:

OK

Note: Command is valid however range display is not supported for this command due to carrier-specific requirements.

Packet Zone Identifier +PZID

Description: This is a read-only command that displays the Packet Zone Id for the mobile IP.

Values:

Numeric value in range 0 - 255

Syntax: Command syntax : AT+PZID

Command Possible Responses

AT+PZID

Note: Display the packet zone ID.

+PZID: 1

OK

Boot URL +WBURL

Description: This command is used to read and write the boot URL value. This value is required for IOTA connections.

Values: <string>

128 character maximum length string value.

Syntax: http://hcmci.iota.spcsdns.net:8080/ciip

Command syntax:

AT+WBURL=<string>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WBURL?

Note: Display the current boot URL value. http://hcmci.iota.spcsdns.net:8080/ciip

OK

AT+WBURL=http://hcmci.iota.spcsdns.net/ciip

Note: Set the boot URL value.

AT+WBURL=””

Note: Set invalid URL value.

OK

Note: New value set.

+CERROR: BAD REQUEST

Note: Error message displayed.

Trusted Domain +WTDMN

Description:

This command is used to read and write the trusted domain value. This value is required for IOTA

Values:

Syntax: connections and is used to verify the trusted server connection.

<string>

32 character maximum length string value. Default: https:.iota.spcsdns.net

Command syntax:

Command

AT+WTDMN=<string>

Possible Responses

AT+WTDMN?

Note: Display the current trusted domain value.

AT+WTDMN=https:.iota.spcsdns.net

Note: Set the trusted domain value.

AT+ WTDMN =””

Note: Set invalid URL value. https:.iota.spcsdns.com

OK

OK

Note: New value set.

+CERROR: BAD REQUEST

Note: Error message displayed.

Proxy Address +WDPXY

Description:

This command is used to read and write the proxy server address. The proxy server address is required for

Values:

Syntax:

IOTA connections.

<string>

32 character maximum length string value in URL format.

68.28.31.1

Command syntax: AT+WDPXY=<address>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WDPXY?

Note: Display the current proxy server address value.

AT+WDPXY=68.28.31.1

Note: Set the proxy server address value.

AT+ WDPXY =””

Note: Set invalid address value.

68.28.31.2

OK

OK

Note: New value set.

+CERROR: BAD REQUEST

Note: Error message displayed.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 187

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

WIOTA Connection Control +WIOTA

Description:

This command is to start an IOTA session.

Values: 0 Reserved.

1

Configure for Sprint commercial network.

3

Reserved.

5

Syntax: Command syntax:

Command

AT+WIOTA=<value>

AT+WIOTA=?

Note: Display available command options.

AT+WIOTA=1

Note: Start IOTA session.

AT+WIOTA?

Note: Display last used option.

Possible responses

+WIOTA: (0-5)

OK

OK

Note: Session started.

+WIOTA: 1

OK

Sprint® System Selection +WSSS

Description:

This command is used to set the system selection and is persistent on reset. The values that are available with the +WSSS command are dependent upon the currently loaded PRL.

A few seconds of delay should occur before issuing subsequent AT commands to allow time for the module to reacquire the network.

Values: <pref>

Preferred

0 systems:

Home Only - Modem will operate on Sprint® PCS only.

Syntax:

Analog only - Roaming rate applies.

Command syntax:

+WSSS: <pref>

Command Possible Responses

AT+WSSS=?

Note: Show supported parameters

AT+WSSS?

Note: Get current setting

AT+WSSS=0

Note: Set home only

+WSSS: (0-3)

OK

+WSSS: 1

OK

OK

Note: Home only mode set.

IOTA Error +WOAE

Description: This response indicates that an IOTA failure has occurred. Refer to Sprint® document SEBU 3G NAI dual launch v131 sec 1.2 for additional details.

Syntax: Response Syntax : +WOAE: “IOTA error 1012”

Possible Responses

+WOAE: “IOTA error 1012”

Preparing Data Services +WOAP

Description: This response indicates that IOTA provisioning is in progress.

Syntax: Response Syntax:

+WOAP: “Preparing Data Services”

Possible Responses

+WOAP: “Preparing Data Services”

Please Retry +WOAR

Description: This response indicates that the previous attempt to start a data session should be retried. When a data session is started without a valid profile, IOTA provisioning is initiated. Upon completion of profile

Syntax: provisioning, this response is displayed.

Response Syntax:

+WOAR: “Please Retry”

Possible Responses

+WOAR: “Please Retry”

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 188

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

Display PRI Checksum +WSUM

Description:

This command is used to display the PRI checksum value. This checksum value is calculated and programmed into the modem at the time of manufacture. The checksum value is not updated or changed if a user modification is made to any of the PRI settings.

Syntax: Command syntax: +WSUM?

Command

AT+WSUM?

Note: Display checksum value.

Possible Responses

+WSUM: 0004DDCF

OK

Note: The displayed value is a eight digit hexadecimal number.

Reset MIN and MDN to Factory Defaults +WRMM

Description: This command is used to reset MIN and MDN to their factory default values. The service programming code must be successfully entered using the +WSPC command prior to using the +WRMM command. The

Syntax: modem must be manually reset or power cycled following the use of the +WRMM command.

Command syntax:

+WRMM

Command Possible Responses

AT+WRMM

Note: Reset MIN and MDN to factory defaults.

OK

Note: Command successful.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 189

Chapter 23 – Sprint® Specific AT Commands

IOTA Feature Application Note

Description:

This application note provides information on the use of the IOTA feature. This feature is available for use in

Q2438 Sprint editions version WZ2.03S or higher. Use the command AT+CGMR to verify the software release identification data prior to performing any IOTA provisioning. Also ensure that the module has been provisioned with valid ESN and A-key.

Configuration Parameters:

IOTA configuration parameters are used to help launch an IOTA session on a Sprint commercial network or

Sprint STIC lab network.

Commercial Network Defaults:

In a Sprint commercial network, the default values provisioned the module are sufficient to initiate an IOTA session. These values can also be set using the command AT+WIOTA=2.

Parameter Value

Boot URL http://hcmci.iota.spcsdns.net:8080/ciip

Proxy

Trusted Domain

Primary Home Agent

Secondary Home Agent

68.28.31.1 https:.iota.spcsdns.net

68.28.15.12

68.28.31.12

STIC Lab Network:

In a STIC lab network environment, the configuration should be changed by using the command

AT+WIOTA=3. This command configures the following module parameter values.

Parameter

Boot URL

Proxy

Value http://10.30.141.20:8080/ciip

10.30.141.20

Trusted Domain

Primary Home Agent

Secondary Home Agent https:.pcslab.com

208.4.125.30

208.4.125.30

Manual Configuration:

In some cases, it may be necessary to manually set some or all of the configuration parameters using the associated individual AT command. The following table summarizes these AT commands. Refer to the appropriate section of this manual for further usage details for each command.

Parameter

Data Profile Index

Boot URL

Check Current Setting

AT$QCMIPP?

AT+WBURL?

Command Example

AT$QCMIPP=0 (Set data profile index=0)

AT+WBURL=http://10.30.141.20:8080/ciip

Proxy

Trusted Domain

AT+WDPXY?

AT+WTDMN?

AT+WDPXY=10.30.141.20

AT+WTDMN=https:.pcslab.com

Primary Home Agent AT$QCMIPPHA? AT$QCMIPPHA=208.4.125.30

Secondary Home Agent AT$QCMIPSHA? AT$QCMIPSHA=208.4.125.30

Client Initiated IOTA Provisioning (CIIP):

There are two ways to start Client Initiated IOTA Provisioning. A network account that supports both voice and data service options is required.

1. Issue the command: AT+WIOTA=1

2. If no device data profile is present, initiate a data call using dial-up.

Network Initiated IOTA Provisioning (NIIP):

No user action is necessary to start Network Initiated IOTA Provisioning. The network will send a trigger SMS message to the module to start NIIP.

IOTA Provisioning Results:

After the IOTA session is launched, the unsolicited response +WOAP: "Preparing Data Services" will be displayed. This response indicates that the IOTA provisioning session is in progress.

After about 4 minutes, the unsolicited response +WOAR: "Please Retry" will be displayed. This response indicates that the

IOTA provisioning session has successfully completed and that 1xData calls can now be made.

If the IOTA provisioning session fails, the unsolicited response +WOEA: "IOTA error 1012" will be displayed. Verify that configuration parameter values have been properly entered and that appropriate PRI data is being used.

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 190

Index

Index

$

$QCCAV Answer Incoming Voice Call ......................... 125

$QCCLR Clear Mobile Error Log .................................. 124

$QCDMR Set DM Baud Rate ....................................... 125

$QCIPD Dump IP Protocol Statistics ............................ 123

$QCIPR Reset IP Protocol Statistics ............................ 123

$QCMDR Set Medium Data Rate ................................ 126

$QCMIP R-SCH IP Selection ....................................... 127

$QCMIPEP Current Active Profile ................................ 128

$QCMIPGETP Return Profile Information .................... 129

$QCMIPHA Set Home HA IP Address ......................... 132

$QCMIPMASPI Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active

Profile ........................................................................ 131

$QCMIPMASS MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

................................................................................... 130

$QCMIPMASSX MN-AAA Shared Secrets in HEX Active

Profile ........................................................................ 130

$QCMIPMHSPI Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active

Profile ........................................................................ 131

$QCMIPMHSS MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

................................................................................... 130

$QCMIPMHSSX MN-HA Shared Secret in HEX Active

Profile ........................................................................ 131

$QCMIPNAI Set NAI for Active Profile ......................... 129

$QCMIPP MIP Selection .............................................. 128

$QCMIPPHA Set Primary HA IP Address .................... 132

$QCMIPRT Set Reverse Tunneling ............................. 129

$QCMIPSHA Set Secondary HA IP Address ............... 132

$QCMIPT RFC2002bis Selection ................................. 128

$QCMTOM Originate M-to-M Packet Data Call ........... 122

$QCPKND Automatic Packet Detection ....................... 125

$QCPPPD Dump PPP Protocol Statistics .................... 122

$QCPPPR Reset PPP Protocol Statistics .................... 123

$QCPREV Protocol Revision in Use ............................ 121

$QCQNC Quick Net Connect ....................................... 121

$QCRL3D Dump RLP 3 Protocol Statistics .................. 126

$QCRL3R Reset RLP 3 Protocol Statistics .................. 126

$QCRLPD Dump RLP Protocol Statistics .................... 122

$QCRLPR Reset RLP Protocol Statistics ..................... 122

$QCSCRM SCRM’ing Selection .................................. 126

$QCSO Set Data Service Option ................................. 124

$QCTCPD Dump TCP Protocol Statistics .................... 124

$QCTCPR Reset TCP Protocol Statistics .................... 124

$QCTRTL R-SCH Throttling Selection ......................... 127

$QCUDPD Dump UDP Protocol Statistics ................... 123

$QCUDPR Reset UDP Protocol Statistics ................... 123

$QCVAD Pre-arrangement Setting .............................. 125

$QDMG Transition to Diagnostics Monitor ................... 121

%

%Dn Automatic Dialing with DTR .................................... 24

&

&C Data Carrier Detect Signal ....................................... 59

&D Data Terminal Ready Signal .................................... 60

&F Restore Factory Setting ............................................ 62

&S Data Set Ready Signal ............................................. 60

&T Audio Loopback ........................................................ 61

&V Display Configuration ............................................... 61

&W Save Configuration .................................................. 62

+

+ WSID SID and NID.................................................... 101

+ADC Analog Digital Converters Measurements ........... 77

+CAD Query Service .................................................... 115

+CBC Battery Charge Status ....................................... 117

+CBIP Base Station IP Address ................................... 118

+CBM Cell Broadcast Message .................................... 155

+CBMI Message Storage Preferences .......................... 155

+CCED Cell Environment & RxLev Indication ................ 75

+CCED Cell Environment Description ........................... 155

+CCFC Call Forwarding .................................................. 51

+CCID Card Identification .............................................. 38

+CCLK Clock Management ............................................. 17

+CCWA Call-waiting ..................................................... 156

+CDR U m

Interface Data Compression Report ............ 116

+CDS SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed

.......................................................................... 175, 184

+CDS U m

Interface Data Compression ........................ 116

+CDS and +CMGR Codes for SNS Status report ......... 148

+CDS SMS Status Report ............................................. 156

+CDSI SMS Status Report Stored in Memory ............... 156

+CDV Dial Command for Voice Calls ........................... 120

+CEER Extended Error Report ....................................... 22

+CFG Configuration String ........................................... 115

+CFUN Set Phone Functionality .................................. 184

+CFUN Set Phone Functionality ..................................... 16

+CGMR Request Revision Identification ......................... 14

+CGSN Electronic Serial Number .................................. 14

+CHV Hang-up Voice Call ............................................ 119

+CICB Incoming Call Bearer ........................................... 25

+CIMI Request IMSI ........................................................ 15

+CKEV Key Press or Release ....................................... 156

+CKPD Keypad Control .................................................. 17

+CLCC List Current Call State ........................................ 54

+CLCK Facility Lock ............................................... 37, 185

+CLED LED Indicator Configuration .............................. 87

+CLIP Calling Line ID Presentation ................................ 52

+CLIP Caller ID ............................................................. 157

+CLIR Calling Line ID Restriction .................................... 52

+CMEE Report Mobile Equipment Errors ....................... 16

+CMER Mobile Equipment Event Reporting .................. 77

+CMGD Delete Message ................................................ 47

+CMGL List Message................................................... 178

+CMGL List Message ..................................................... 44

+CMGR Read Message ......................................... 43, 177

+CMGS Send Message ......................................... 45, 179

+CMGW Write Message to Memory ...................... 46, 180

+CMIP Mobile Station IP Address ................................ 117

+CMSS Send Message from Storage ............................. 47

+CMT Incoming Message Directly Displayed ............... 175

+CMT Incoming Message Displayed ............................ 157

+CMTI Location of Stored Message .............................. 157

+CMUT Microphone Mute Control ................................. 27

+CMUX Select Multiplex Option ................................... 119

+CNMA New Message Acknowledgement ...................... 40

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 191

Index

+CNMI New Message Indication .................................... 42

+CNUM Subscriber Number ............................................ 18

+COPS Mode Preference .............................................. 29

+COPS Mode Preferences ............................................ 158

+CPAS Phone Activity Status .......................................... 16

+CPBF Find Phonebook Entries .................................... 64

+CPBP Phonebook Search ............................................ 66

+CPBR Phonebook Read .............................................. 66

+CPBS Phonebook Memory Storage Selection ............. 63

+CPBU Phonebook Locations ........................................ 64

+CPBW Write Phonebook Entry ..................................... 65

+CPHS CPHS Command ............................................... 83

+CPIN Enter PIN ............................................................ 35

+CPIN2 Enter PIN2 ......................................................... 36

+CPINC PIN Remaining Attempt Number ...................... 36

+CPMS Preferred Message Storage ............................... 41

+CPOF Phone Offline ..................................................... 16

+CPWD Change Password ............................................ 38

+CQD Inactivity Timer .................................................. 117

+CRC Cellular Result Codes .......................................... 56

+CREG Network Registration & Roaming ...................... 31

+CREG Registration & Roaming ................................... 158

+CRING Incoming call ................................................... 158

+CRM Set Rm Interface Protocol ................................. 116

+CRMP Ring Melody Playback ....................................... 17

+CRSL Ringer Sound Level ........................................... 18

+CSCB Select Broadcast Messages .............................. 48

+CSCS Select TE Character Set ..................................... 15

+CSDH Show Text Mode Parameters ............................. 41

+CSMS Select Message Service ................................... 40

+CSNS Single Numbering Scheme ................................. 25

+CSQ Signal Quality .................................................... 185

+CSQ RxLev Indication ................................................. 159

+CSQ Signal Quality ....................................................... 29

+CSS Serving System .......................................... 118, 186

+CSTA Select Type of Address ....................................... 18

+CTA U Packet Data Inactivity Timer ......................... 120 m

+CXT Cellular Extension .............................................. 115

+DPRL Download PRL Status ....................................... 167

+DPRL..Download PRL ................................................. 105

+DR Data Compression V.42 bis Report ........................ 57

+EB Error Control Operation ........................................ 109

+ECHO Echo Cancellation .............................................. 27

+EFCS Numberic Parameter Control ........................... 109

+ER Error Control Reporting ........................................ 109

+ES Error Control Selection ......................................... 110

+ETBM Error Control Selection .................................... 111

+FCLASS Select Mode .................................................. 55

+GCAP Capabilities List .................................................. 15

+GMI Request Manufacturer Identification ................... 111

+GMM Request Manufacture Identification .................. 111

+GMR Request Revision Identification ......................... 112

+GOI Request Global Object ID ................................... 112

+GSN Request Product Serial Number ID ................... 112

+ICF DTE-DCE Character Framing ................................ 58

+IFC Local Flow Control ................................................. 59

+ILRR DTE-DCE Local Rate Reporting ........................ 56

+IPR Fixed DTE Rate ..................................................... 58

+MA Modulation Automode .......................................... 113

+MR Modulation Reporting........................................... 113

+MS Modulation Selection ........................................... 113

+MV18R V.18 Reporting Control .................................. 114

+MV18S V.18 Selection ............................................... 114

+PZID Packet Zone Identifier ....................................... 187

+RING Incoming Call .................................................... 159

+SIDET Side Tone Modification ...................................... 28

+SPEAKER Speaker & Microphone Selection ............... 27

+STCR Unsolicited Result SIM ...................................... 96

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K)

+STGI SIM ToolKit Get Information ............................... 93

+STGR SIM ToolKit Give Response .............................. 96

+STIN SIM ToolKit Indication ......................................... 92

+STSF SIM ToolKit Set Facilities ................................... 91

+VGR Volume Gain Control ............................................ 26

+VGT Microphone Gain .................................................. 26

+VIP Initialize Voice Parameters ..................................... 28

+VTD DTMF Signals ...................................................... 23

+VTS DTMF Signals ...................................................... 23

+W32K 32kHz Sleep Mode ............................................ 81

+WAIP Avoid Phonebook Initialization ........................... 67

+WANS Call Answered ................................................. 159

+WAOC Access Overload Class .................................. 101

+WBGP Primary Browser Gateway ............................. 102

+WBGS Secondary Browser Gateway ......................... 102

+WBND Band Preference .............................................. 30

+WBURL Boot URL ..................................................... 187

+WCCS Custom Character Set Tables .......................... 83

+WCDM Change Default Melody ................................... 82

+WCDP Change Default Player ..................................... 84

+WCMT Commit Changes ........................................... 104

+WCNM Read Current NAM .......................................... 32

+WCNT Call Connected ................................................ 160

+WCRX Configure Receive Data Mode ....................... 138

+WCSK Close Socket .................................................. 135

+WDCP Delete Calls from Phonebook........................... 67

+WDNS DNS Lookup Indication .................................. 142

+WDNS IP Address Lookup ......................................... 139

+WDOR Dormant Mode Status Change ...................... 142

+WDPXY Proxy Address .............................................. 187

+WDTMF Play DTMF Tone ............................................ 79

+WEND Call Ended ...................................................... 160

+WERI Enhanced Roaming Indication ......................... 176

+WFDM Force Dormant Mode ..................................... 138

+WFNM Feature Notification Message ......................... 160

+WFSH Send Flash to Base Station .............................. 53

+WFSH Flash Indication ............................................... 161

+WGMI Manufacturer Identification ................................ 74

+WGMM Request Model ID ........................................... 74

+WGSS Display Connection Status ............................. 137

+WHWV Hardware Version ............................................ 79

+WIMI Set IMSI ............................................................ 100

+WIND General Indicator .............................................. 161

+WIOR Read GPIO Value .............................................. 78

+WIOTA WIOTA Connection Control ........................... 188

+WIOW Write GPIO Value ............................................. 78

+WIPC Display IP Address .......................................... 139

+WLCK Excess SPC Failures ...................................... 182

+WMBP Minute Alert ...................................................... 87

+WMDN Mobile Directory Number ....................... 100, 186

+WMGF SMS Message Storage Full ........................... 164

+WMGO Message Overwriting ....................................... 49

+WMPC IP Server Address ............................................ 73

+WMSC Message Status Modification ............................ 48

+WNAM Change NAM Selection ................................... 32

+WNAM Current NAM Change ..................................... 163

+WOAE IOTA Error ...................................................... 188

+WOAP Preparing Data Services ................................ 188

+WOAR Please Retry .................................................. 188

+WORG Call Originated ................................................ 162

+WOSK Open Socket .................................................. 134

+WOT0 Initial Programming Required ......................... 181

+WOT1 Programming in Progress ............................... 181

+WOT2 Programming Successful ................................ 181

+WOT3 Programming Unsuccessful ............................ 181

+WOTC Commit Successful ........................................ 182

+WOTI MSI Download OK ........................................... 182

+WOTM MDM Download OK ....................................... 182

192

Index

+WOTN NAM Download OK ........................................ 182

+WOTP PRL Download OK ......................................... 182

+WOTS SPL Unlocked ................................................. 182

+WPAD Keypad Functionality ........................................ 88

+WPCC Primary CDMA Channels ............................... 102

+WPDCT gpsOne Session Consent .............................. 73

+WPDDD Position Determination Data Download ......... 69

+WPDER gpsOne Error Result Code ........................... 146

+WPDER Position Determination Error ......................... 166

+WPDES Position Determination End Session .............. 72

+WPDFR Position Determination Fix Rate ..................... 70

+WPDIP Position Determination IP Address .................. 71

+WPDOM Position Determination Operating Mode ....... 69

+WPDPL Position Determination Privacy Level ............. 70

+WPDPT Position Determination Port ID ....................... 71

+WPDS Packet Dial String ........................................... 102

+WPDSS Position Determination Start Session ............. 72

+WPDSS Position Determination Start Session Result . 165

+WPDST Position Determination Session Type ............. 68

+WPIN Security PIN ....................................................... 86

+WPLCK Position Determination Lock Level ............... 183

+WPPP PPP Session Status ........................................ 139

+WPPP Start/End PPP Connection ............................. 134

+WPPRV Position Determination NV Privacy Level ....... 70

+WPRL PRL Version ...................................................... 86

+WPRV Set Voice Privacy Level .................................... 85

+WPRV Call Privacy Indication ..................................... 162

+WPTLM Position Determination Transportation Setting

..................................................................................... 71

+WPUST gpsOne Session Prompt ............................... 167

+WRIM Ring Indicator Mode .......................................... 81

+WRMM Reset MIN and MDN to Factory Defaults ...... 189

+WRMP Roam Preference ............................................. 31

+WRMW Extended Roam Indication .............................. 34

+WROM Roaming Indication ........................................ 176

+WROM Roaming Status .............................................. 162

+WRST Reset Modem ................................................... 84

+WSCC Secondary CDMA Channels .......................... 103

+WSCI Slot Cycle Index ............................................... 101

+WSCL SMS Language and Encoding .......................... 50

+WSDS Stop DTMF Tone ............................................... 23

+WSDT Start DTMF Tone ............................................... 23

+WSKE Socket Open/Close Error ................................ 140

+WSKS Socket State Change ...................................... 140

+WSNR SID/NID Entries .............................................. 104

+WSOM Service Option Management ......................... 103

+WSOS Emergency Mode ..................................... 33, 177

+WSOS Emergency Mode ............................................ 163

+WSPC Service Programming Code ................... 100, 180

+WSPS Power Save ..................................................... 164

+WSRE Socket Data Error ........................................... 141

+WSRX Read Receive Data ........................................ 136

+WSRX Received Data ................................................ 141

+WSSS Sprint® System Selection ............................... 188

+WSST Set Standard Tones .......................................... 85

+WSSW Software Version ............................................. 82

+WSTE Socket Data Transmission Error ..................... 141

+WSTM Timestamp of MT SMS ..................................... 50

+WSTR Status Request ................................................. 80

+WSTX Socket Data Transmission Status ................... 140

+WSTX Transmit Socket Data ..................................... 135

+WSUM Display PRI Checksum .................................. 189

+WSVG Select Voice Gain ............................................. 80

+WTDMN Trusted Domain ........................................... 187

+WTMO Configure Socket Transmit Timeout............... 137

+WTMR View Modem Timers ......................................... 19

+WTONE Play Tone ....................................................... 78

+WTTY TTY Mode ......................................................... 28

+WUSS Change SMS Status .......................................... 49

+WVMI Voice Mail Indicator .......................................... 164

+WVSS Verizon® System Selection ............................ 181

2

2G ................................................................................... 10

3

3G ................................................................................... 10

A

A Answer ........................................................................ 22

A/ Repeat Last Command ............................................... 15

Access Overload Class +WAOC .................................. 101

AFLT ............................................................................... 10

AMPS Operation ........................................................... 149

Analog Digital Converters Measurements +ADC .......... 77

Answer A ........................................................................ 22

Answer Incoming Voice Call $QCCAV ......................... 125

AT Attention .................................................................... 14

Attention AT .................................................................... 14

Audio Feedback Level ..................................................... 28

Audio Loopback &T ........................................................ 61

Automatic Answer S0. .................................................... 24

Automatic Dialing with DTR %Dn ................................... 24

Automatic Packet Detection $QCPKND ....................... 125

Avoid Phonebook Initialization +WAIP ........................... 67

B

Back to Online Mode O .................................................. 60

Band Preference +WBND .............................................. 30

Base Station IP Address +CBIP ................................... 118

Battery Charge Status +CBC ....................................... 117

Boot URL +WBURL ..................................................... 187

Burst DTMF Tones .......................................................... 23

C

Call ................................................................................ 162

Call Answered +WANS ................................................ 159

Call Connected +WCNT ............................................... 160

Call Ended +WEND ..................................................... 160

Call Forwarding +CCFC ................................................. 51

Call Originated +WORG ............................................... 162

Caller ID +CLIP ............................................................ 157

Calling Line ID Presentation +CLIP ................................ 52

Calling Line ID Restriction +CLIR ................................... 52

Call-waiting +CCWA..................................................... 156

Capabilities List +GCAP .................................................. 15

Card Identification +CCID .............................................. 38

CBM ................................................................................ 10

CDMA ............................................................................. 10 cdma2000 ....................................................................... 10 cdmaONE ....................................................................... 10

Cell Broadcast Message +CBM ................................... 155

Cell Environment & RxLev Indication +CCED ................ 75

Cell Environment Description +CCED .......................... 155

Cellular Extension +CXT .............................................. 115

Cellular Result Codes +CRC .......................................... 56

Change Default Player +WCDP ..................................... 84

Change NAM Selection +WNAM ................................... 32

Change Password +CPWD ............................................ 38

Change SMS Status +WUSS ......................................... 49

Clear Mobile Error Log $QCCLR .................................. 124

Clock Management +CCLK ............................................ 17

Close Socket +WCSK .................................................. 135

Codes for SNS Status report ......................................... 148

Command Lines .............................................................. 13

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 193

Index

Commands Over DM Port (MuxLite) ............................. 153

Commit Changes +WCMT ........................................... 104

Commit Successful +WOTC ......................................... 182

Configuration String +CFG ........................................... 115

Configure Receive Data Mode +WCRS ....................... 138

Configure Socket Transmit Timeout +WTMO ............... 137

Continuous DTMF Tone .................................................. 23

CPHS Feature +CPHS ................................................... 83

Current Active Profile $QCMIPEP ................................ 128

Current Call State +CLCC .............................................. 54

Current NAM Change +WNAM .................................... 163

Custom Character Set Tables +WCCS .......................... 83

D

D Dial Command ............................................................. 20

Data Carrier Detect Signal &C ....................................... 59

Data Commands ............................................................. 55

Data Compression V.42 bis Report +DR ........................ 57

Data Compression V.42bis +DS ..................................... 57

Data Compression V.42bis +DS ...................................... 57

Data Set Ready (DSR) Signal &S .................................. 60

Data Terminal Ready Signal &D .................................... 60

DCE ................................................................................. 10

DCE Response Format V ............................................... 61

Default Melody Change +WCDM ................................... 82

Delete Calls from Phonebook +WDCP ........................... 67

Delete Message +CMGD ............................................... 47

Dial Command D ............................................................. 20

Dial Command for Voice Calls +CDV ........................... 120

Display Configuration &V ............................................... 61

Display Connection Status +WGSS ............................. 137

Display IP Address +WIPC........................................... 139

Display PRI Checksum +WSUM .................................. 189

DL Redial Last Telephone Number ................................. 24

DNS Lookup Indication +WDNS ................................... 142

Dormant Mode Status Change +WDOR ...................... 142

Download PRL +DPRL .................................................. 105

Download PRL Status +DPRL ....................................... 167

DTE ................................................................................. 10

DTE-DCE Character Framing +ICF ................................ 58

DTMF .............................................................................. 10

DTMF signals +VTD ....................................................... 23

DTMF Signals +VTS ...................................................... 23

Dump IP Protocol Statistics $QCIPD ............................ 123

Dump PPP Protocol Statistics $QCPPPD .................... 122

Dump RLP 3 Protocol Statistics $QCRL3D .................. 126

Dump RLP Protocol Statistics $QCRLPD .................... 122

Dump TCP Protocol Statistics $QCTCPD .................... 124

Dump UDP Protocol Statistics $QCUDPD ................... 123

E

E Echo ............................................................................ 61

Echo E ............................................................................ 61

Echo Cancellation +ECHO ............................................. 27

Electronic Serial Number +CGSN .................................. 14

Emergency Mode +WSOS ............................. 33, 163, 177

Enhanced Roaming Indication +WERI ......................... 176

Error Control Operation +EB ........................................ 109

Error Control Reporting +ER ........................................ 109

Error Control Selection +ES ......................................... 110

Error Control Selection +ETBM .................................... 111

Error Control Selective Repeat +ESR .......................... 110

ESR Error Control Selective Repeat ............................ 110

Examples of General AT Command Usage .................. 168

Excess SPC Failures +WLCK ...................................... 182

Extended AT Commands .............................................. 107

Extended Error Report +CEER ...................................... 22

Extended Error Report (+CEER) Call Processing Codes

.................................................................................. 144

Extended Roam Indicators +WRMW ............................. 34

F

Facility Lock +CLCK ............................................... 37, 185

Feature Notification Message +WFNM ........................ 160

Final Result Codes ........................................................ 145

Find Phonebook Entries +CPBF .................................... 64

Fixed DTE Rate +IPR..................................................... 58

Flash Indication +WFSH .............................................. 161

Flash to Base Station +WFSH ....................................... 53

Force Dormant Mode +WFDM ..................................... 138

G

General Indicator +WIND ............................................. 161

GPS AT Commands ........................................................ 68 gpsOne Error Result Code +WPDER........................... 146 gpsOne Session Consent +WPDCT .............................. 73 gpsOne Session Prompt +WPUST ............................... 167 gpsOne Session Prompt Input +WPDUC ....................... 73

H

H Hang Up ...................................................................... 21

Handset Path .................................................................. 10

Hang Up H ..................................................................... 21

Hang-up Voice Call +CHV ............................................ 119

Hardware Version +WHWV ............................................ 79

Headset Path .................................................................. 10

I

I Request Identification Information ................................ 62

IMSI ................................................................................. 10

Inactivity Timer +CQD .................................................. 117

Incoming call +CRING.................................................. 158

Incoming Call +RING ................................................... 159

Incoming Call Bearer +CICB .......................................... 25

Incoming Message Directly Displayed +CMT ............... 175

Incoming Message Displayed +CMT ........................... 157

Initial Programming Required +WOT0 ......................... 181

Initialize Voice Parameters +VIP .................................... 28

Intermediate Result Codes ............................................ 145

International Mobile Subscriber Identity .......................... 15

IOTA ................................................................................ 10

IOTA Error +WOAE ...................................................... 188

IOTA Feature Application Note ..................................... 190

IP Address Lookup +WDNS ......................................... 139

IP Server Address +WMPC ............................................ 73

IS-2000 ........................................................................... 10

IS-707 ............................................................................. 10

IS707.3 .......................................................................... 107

IS-95 ............................................................................... 10

IS-95A ............................................................................. 10

IS-95B ............................................................................. 10

IWF ................................................................................. 10

K

Key Press or Release +CKEV ...................................... 156

Keypad Control +CKPD ................................................. 17

Keypad Functionality +WPAD ........................................ 88

L

LAPM .............................................................................. 10

LED Indicator Configuration +CLED .............................. 87

List Message +CMGL............................................. 44, 178

Local Flow Contro +IFC ................................................. 59

Local Rate Reporting +ILRR .......................................... 56

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 194

Index

Location of Stored Message +CMTI ............................. 157

M

Manufacturer Identification +WGMI ................................ 74

MCC ................................................................................ 10

MDM Download OK +WOTM ....................................... 182

MDN ................................................................................ 11

Message Overwriting +WMGO ....................................... 49

Message Service Failure Result Code .......................... 144

Message Status Modification +WMSC ........................... 48

Message Storage Preferences +CBMI ......................... 155

Microphone Gain +VGT ................................................. 26

Microphone Mute Control +CMUT .................................. 27

MIN .................................................................................. 11

Minute Alert +WMBP ...................................................... 87

MIP Selection $QCMIPP .............................................. 128

MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile $QCMIPMASS

................................................................................... 130

MN-AAA Shared Secrets in HEX Active Profile

$QCMIPMASSX ........................................................ 130

MNC ................................................................................ 11

MN-HA Shared Secret in HEX Active Profile

$QCMIPMHSSX ........................................................ 131

MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile $QCMIPMHSS

................................................................................... 130

MO .................................................................................. 11

Mobile Directory Number +WMDN ....................... 100, 186

Mobile Equipment Event Reporting +CMER .................. 77

Mobile Station IP Address +CMIP ................................ 117

Mode Preference +COPS............................................... 29

Mode Preferences +COPS ........................................... 158

Modulation Automode +MA .......................................... 113

Modulation Reporting +MR........................................... 113

Modulation Selection +MS............................................ 113

MS ................................................................................... 11

MS Error Result Code Table ......................................... 143

MSI Download OK +WOTI ........................................... 182

MSL ............................................................................... 100

MSM ................................................................................ 11

MT ................................................................................... 11

N

Personal Identification Number ....................................... 35

Phone Activity Status +CPAS ......................................... 16

Phone Offline +CPOF ..................................................... 16

Phonebook Commands ................................................... 63

Phonebook Locations +CPBU ........................................ 64

Phonebook Memory Storage Selection +CPBS ............. 63

Phonebook Search +CPBP ............................................ 66

Phonebook UCS2 Unicode ........................................... 152

Phoneboook Read +CPBR ............................................ 66

PIN +CPIN ..................................................................... 35

PIN Remaining Attempt Number +CPINC ...................... 36

PIN2 +CPIN2 ................................................................. 36

Play DTMF Tone +WDTMF ............................................ 79

Play Tone +WTONE ...................................................... 78

Please Retry +WOAR .................................................. 188

PN Offset ........................................................................ 11

Position Determination Data Download +WPDDD ......... 69

Position Determination End Session +WPDES .............. 72

Position Determination Error +WPDER ......................... 166

Position Determination Fix Rate +WPDFR ..................... 70

Position Determination Lock Level +WPLCK ............... 183

Position Determination NV Privacy Level +WPPRV ....... 70

Position Determination Operating Mode +WPDOM ....... 69

Position Determination Privacy Level +WPDPL ............. 70

Position Determination Session Type +WPDST ............ 68

Position Determination Start Session +WPDSS ............. 72

Position Determination Start Session Result +WPDSS. 165

Position Determination Transportation Setting +WPTLM

.................................................................................... 71

Power Save +WSPS .................................................... 164

PPP Session Status +WPPP ....................................... 139

Pre-arrangement Setting $QCVAD .............................. 125

Preferred Message Storage +CPMS .............................. 41

Preparing Data Services +WOAP ................................ 188

P-REV ............................................................................. 11

PRI .................................................................................. 11

Primary Browser Gateway +WBGP .............................. 102

Primary CDMA Channels +WPCC ............................... 102

PRL ................................................................................. 11

PRL Download OK +WOTP ......................................... 182

PRL Version +WPRL...................................................... 86

Programming in Progress +WOT1 ............................... 181

Programming Successful +WOT2 ................................ 181

Programming Unsuccessful +WOT3 ............................ 181

Protocol Revision in Use $QCPREV ............................ 121

Provisioning for CDMA .................................................... 99

Proxy Address +WDPXY .............................................. 187

PSTN .............................................................................. 11

Pulse Dialing P ............................................................. 108

NAM ................................................................................ 11

NAM Download OK +WOTN ........................................ 182

Network Registration & Roaming Status +CREG ........... 31

New Message Acknowledgement +CNMA ..................... 40

New Message Indication +CNMI .................................... 42

NID .................................................................................. 11

Numeric Parameter Control +EFCS ............................. 109

NV-RAM .......................................................................... 11

Q

O

O Back to Online Mode .................................................. 60

Open Socket +WOSK .................................................. 134

Originate M-to-M Packet Data Call $QCMTOM ........... 122

OTAPA ............................................................................ 11

OTASP ............................................................................ 11

OTKSL .......................................................................... 100

P

P Select Pulse Dialing .................................................. 108

Packet Dial String +WPDS ........................................... 102

Packet Zone Identifier +PZID ....................................... 187

Parameters Storage ...................................................... 147

Passwords ....................................................................... 35

PD ................................................................................... 11

PDU ................................................................................. 11

Q Result Code Suppression ........................................... 60

Query Service +CAD .................................................... 115

Quick Net Connect $QCQNC ....................................... 121

R

Read Current NAM +WCNM .......................................... 32

Read GPIO Value +WIOR .............................................. 78

Read Message +CMGR ......................................... 43, 177

Read Receive Data +WSRX ........................................ 136

Received Socket Data +WSRX .................................... 141

Redial Last Telephone Number DL ................................ 24

Reference Information ................................................... 143

Registration & Roaming +CREG .................................. 158

Remote Async X .......................................................... 107

Remote disconnection ..................................................... 22

Repeat last command A/ ................................................. 15

Report Mobile Equipment Errors +CMEE ....................... 16

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 195

Index

Request Global Object ID +GOI ................................... 112

Request Identification Information I ................................ 62

Request IMSI +CIMI ....................................................... 15

Request Manufacture Identification +GMM .................. 111

Request Manufacturer Identification +GMI ................... 111

Request Model ID +WGMM ........................................... 74

Request Product Serial Number ID +GSN ................... 112

Request Revision Identification +GMR ......................... 112

Request Revision Identification +CGMR ......................... 14

Reset Default Z0 .......................................................... 107

Reset IP Protocol Statistics $QCIPR ............................ 123

Reset MIN and MDN to Factory Defaults +WRMM ...... 189

Reset Modem +WRST ................................................... 84

Reset PPP Protocol Statistics $QCPPPR .................... 123

Reset RLP 3 Protocol Statistics $QCRL3R .................. 126

Reset RLP Protocol Statistics $QCRLPR ..................... 122

Reset TCP Protocol Statistics $QCTCPR .................... 124

Rest UDP Protocol Statistics $QCUDPR ..................... 123

Restore Factory Setting &F ............................................ 62

Result Code Suppression ................................................ 13

Result Code Suppression Q ........................................... 60

Return Profile Information $QCMIPGETP .................... 129

RF ................................................................................... 11

RFC2002bis Selection $QCMIPT ................................. 128

Ring Indicator Mode +WRIM .......................................... 81

Ring Melody Playback +CRMP ...................................... 17

Ringer Sound Level +CRSL ........................................... 18

Roam Preference +WRMP ............................................. 31

Roaming Indication +WROM ........................................ 176

Roaming Status +WROM ............................................. 162

R-SCH IP Selection $QCMIP ....................................... 127

R-SCH Throttling Selection $QCTRTL ......................... 127

RSSI ................................................................................ 11

R-UIM .............................................................................. 11

RxLev Indication +CSQ ................................................ 159

S

S S-Registers ............................................................... 108

S0 Automatic Answer ...................................................... 24

Save Configuration &W .................................................. 62

SCRM’ing Selection $QCSCRM .................................. 126

Secondary Browser Gateway +WBGS ......................... 102

Secondary CDMA Channels +WSCC .......................... 103

Security PIN +WPIN ....................................................... 86

Select Broadcast Messages +CSCB .............................. 48

Select Message Service +CSMS ................................... 40

Select Mode +FCLASS .................................................. 55

Select Multiplex Option +CMUX ................................... 119

Select TE Character set +CSCS ..................................... 15

Select Tone Dialing T ................................................... 107

Select Type of Address +CSTA ...................................... 18

Select Voice Gain +WSVG ............................................. 80

Send Message +CMGS ......................................... 45, 179

Send Message from Storage +CMSS ............................ 47

Service Option Management +WSOM ......................... 103

Service Programming Code +WSPC ................... 100, 180

Service Programming Example ..................................... 106

Serving System +CSS .......................................... 118, 186

Set Data Service Option $QCSO ................................. 124

Set DM Baud Rate $QCDMR ....................................... 125

Set Home HA IP Address $QCMIPHA ......................... 132

Set IMSI +WIMI ............................................................ 100

Set Medium Data Rate $QCMDR ................................ 126

Set MN-AAA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

$QCMIPMASPI .......................................................... 131

Set MN-HA Shared Secrets in Active Profile

$QCMIPMHSPI.......................................................... 131

Set NAI for Active Profile $QCMIPNAI ......................... 129

Set Phone Functionality +CFUN .................................. 184

Set Phone Functionality +CFUN ..................................... 16

Set Position Determination IP Address +WPDIP ........... 71

Set Position Determination Port ID +WPDPT ................. 71

Set Primary HA IP Address $QCMIPPHA .................... 132

Set Reverse Tunneling $QCMIPRT ............................. 129

Set Rm Interface Protocol +CRM ................................. 116

Set Secondary HA IP Address $QCMIPSHA ............... 132

Set Standard Tones +WSST .......................................... 85

Short Messages Commands ........................................... 39

Show Text Mode Parameters +CSDH ........................... 41

SID .................................................................................. 11

SID and NID +WSID .................................................... 101

SID/NID List Entries +WSNR ....................................... 104

Side Tone Modification +SIDET ..................................... 28

Signal Quality +CSQ .............................................. 29, 185

SIM .................................................................................. 11

SIM Application ToolKit ................................................... 89

SIM Card ......................................................................... 35

SIM ToolKit ..................................................................... 89

SIM ToolKit Facilities +STSF ......................................... 91

SIM ToolKit Get Information STGI .................................. 93

SIM ToolKit Give Response +STGR .............................. 96

SIM ToolKit Indications +STIN ....................................... 92

SIM Unsolicited Result +STCR ...................................... 96

Single Numbering Scheme +CSNS ............................... 25

Sleep Mode 32kHz +W32K ........................................... 81

Slot Cycle Index +WSCI ............................................... 101

SMS ................................................................................ 11

SMS Language and Encoding +WSCL .......................... 50

SMS Message Storage Full +WMGF ........................... 164

SMS Status Report +CDS ............................................ 156

SMS Status Report Indication Directly Displayed +CDS

.......................................................................... 175, 184

SMS Status Report Stored in Memory +CDSI .............. 156

Socket Data Error +WSRE ........................................... 141

Socket Data Transmission Error +WSTE ..................... 141

Socket Data Transmission Status +WSTX ................... 140

Socket Open/Close Error +WSKE ................................ 140

Socket State Change +WSKS ...................................... 140

Software Version +WSSW ............................................. 82

Speaker & Microphone Selection +SPEAKER. .............. 27

Specific Error Result Codes .......................................... 144

SPL Unlocked +WOTS ................................................. 182

Sprint® Specific AT Commands .................................... 184

Sprint® System Selection +WSSS ............................... 188

S-Registers S ............................................................... 108

SREJ ............................................................................... 11

Start DTMF Tone +WSDT .............................................. 23

Start/End PPP Connection +WPPP ............................. 134

Status Request +WSTR ................................................. 80

Stop DTMF Tone +WSDS .............................................. 23

Subscriber Number +CNUM .......................................... 18

Supplementary Services Commands .............................. 51

T

T Select Tone Dialing ................................................... 107

TA/TE .............................................................................. 11

TCP App DNS Server Codes ........................................ 150

TCP App PPP Network Codes ...................................... 150

TCP App Restricted AT Commands .............................. 151

TCP App Socket Error Codes ....................................... 150

TCP App Socket Status Events..................................... 150

TCP/IP App AT Commands .......................................... 133

Timestamp of MT SMS +WSTM .................................... 50

TON/NP .......................................................................... 12

Traffic channel............................................................... 160

Transition to Diagnostics Monitor $QDMG .................. 121

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 196

Transmit Socket Data +WSTX ..................................... 135

Trusted Domain +WTDMN ........................................... 187

TTY Mode +WTTY ......................................................... 28

U

U m

Interface Data Compression +CDS ........................ 116

U m

Interface Data Compression Report +CDR ............. 116

U m

Packet Data Inactivity Timer +CTA ......................... 120

Unicode ........................................................................... 39

Unsolicited AT Codes .................................................... 155

V

V DCE Response Format ............................................... 61

V.18 Reporting Control +MV18R .................................. 114

V.18 Selection +MV18S ............................................... 114

V.42 ............................................................................... 109

V24-V25 .......................................................................... 12

V42 .................................................................................. 12

Verizon® Specific AT Commands ................................. 175

Index

Verizon® System Selection +WVSS ............................ 181

View Modem Timers +WTMR ........................................ 19

Voice Mail Indicator +WVMI ......................................... 164

Voice Privacy Level +WPRV .......................................... 85

Volume Gain Control +VGR ........................................... 26

W

WIOTA Connection Control +WIOTA ........................... 188

Write GPIO Value +WIOW ............................................. 78

Write Message to Memory +CMGW ...................... 46, 180

Write Phonebook Entry +CPBW .................................... 65

X

X Remote Async .......................................................... 107

Z

Z0 Reset Default .......................................................... 107

Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. CDMA AT Commands Reference Guide (PN S000294K) 197

advertisement

Related manuals

advertisement

Table of contents